RELEASE_NOTES revision 64562
1			SENDMAIL RELEASE NOTES
2      $Id: RELEASE_NOTES,v 8.561.2.5.2.80 2000/07/19 20:40:57 gshapiro Exp $
3
4
5This listing shows the version of the sendmail binary, the version
6of the sendmail configuration files, the date of release, and a
7summary of the changes in that release.
8
98.11.0/8.11.0	2000/07/19
10	SECURITY: If sendmail is installed as a non-root set-user-ID binary
11		(not the normal case), some operating systems will still
12		keep a saved-uid of the effective-uid when sendmail tries
13		to drop all of its privileges.  If sendmail needs to drop
14		these privileges and the operating system doesn't set the
15		saved-uid as well, exit with an error.  Problem noted by
16		Kari Hurtta of the Finnish Meteorological Institute.
17	SECURITY: sendmail depends on snprintf() NUL terminating the string
18		it populates.  It is possible that some broken
19		implementations of snprintf() exist that do not do this.
20		Systems in this category should compile with
21		-DSNPRINTF_IS_BROKEN=1.  Use test/t_snprintf.c to test your
22		system and report broken implementations to
23		sendmail-bugs@sendmail.org and your OS vendor.  Problem
24		noted by Slawomir Piotrowski of TELSAT GP.
25	Support SMTP Service Extension for Secure SMTP (RFC 2487) (STARTTLS).
26		Implementation influenced by the example programs of
27		OpenSSL and the work of Lutz Jaenicke of TU Cottbus.
28	Add new STARTTLS related options CACERTPath, CACERTFile,
29		ClientCertFile, ClientKeyFile, DHParameters, RandFile,
30		ServerCertFile, and ServerKeyFile.  These are documented in
31		cf/README and doc/op/op.*.
32	New STARTTLS related macros: ${cert_issuer}, ${cert_subject},
33		${tls_version}, ${cipher}, ${cipher_bits}, ${verify},
34		${server_name}, and ${server_addr}.  These are documented
35		in cf/README and doc/op/op.*.
36	Add support for the Entropy Gathering Daemon (EGD) for better
37		random data.
38	New DontBlameSendmail option InsufficientEntropy for systems which
39		don't properly seed the PRNG for OpenSSL but want to
40		try to use STARTTLS despite the security problems.
41	Support the security layer in SMTP AUTH for mechanisms which
42		support encryption.  Based on code contributed by Tim
43		Martin of CMU.
44	Add new macro ${auth_ssf} to reflect the SMTP AUTH security
45		strength factor.
46	LDAP's -1 (single match only) flag was not honored if the -z
47		(delimiter) flag was not given.  Problem noted by ST Wong of
48		the Chinese University of Hong Kong.  Fix from Mark Adamson
49		of CMU.
50	Add more protection from accidentally tripping OpenLDAP 1.X's
51		ld_errno == LDAP_DECODING_ERROR hack on ldap_next_attribute().
52		Suggested by Kurt Zeilenga of OpenLDAP.
53	Fix the default family selection for DaemonPortOptions.  As
54		documented, unless a family is specified in a
55		DaemonPortOptions option, "inet" is the default.  It is
56		also the default if no DaemonPortOptions value is set.
57		Therefore, IPv6 users should configure additional sockets
58		by adding DaemonPortOptions settings with Family=inet6 if
59		they wish to also listen on IPv6 interfaces.  Problem noted
60		by Jun-ichiro itojun Hagino of the KAME Project.
61	Set ${if_family} when setting ${if_addr} and ${if_name} to reflect
62		the interface information for an outgoing connection.
63		Not doing so was creating a mismatch between the socket
64		family and address used in subsequent connections if the
65		M=b modifier was set in DaemonPortOptions.  Problem noted
66		by John Beck of Sun Microsystems.
67	If DaemonPortOptions modifier M=b is used, determine the socket
68		family based on the IP address.  ${if_family} is no longer
69		persistent (i.e., saved in qf files).  Patch from John Beck
70		of Sun Microsystems.
71	sendmail 8.10 and 8.11 reused the ${if_addr} and ${if_family}
72		macros for both the incoming interface address/family and
73		the outgoing interface address/family.  In order for M=b
74		modifier in DaemonPortOptions to work properly, preserve
75		the incoming information in the queue file for later
76		delivery attempts.
77	Use SMTP error code and enhanced status code from check_relay in
78		responses to commands.  Problem noted by Jeff Wasilko of
79		smoe.org.
80	Add more vigilance in checking for putc() errors on output streams
81		to protect from a bug in Solaris 2.6's putc().  Problem
82		noted by Graeme Hewson of Oracle.
83	The LDAP map -n option (return attribute names only) wasn't working.
84		Problem noted by Ajay Matia.
85	Under certain circumstances, an address could be listed as deferred
86		but would be bounced back to the sender as failed to be
87		delivered when it really should have been queued.  Problem
88		noted by Allan E Johannesen of Worcester Polytechnic Institute.
89	Prevent a segmentation fault in a child SMTP process from getting
90		the SMTP transaction out of sync.  Problem noted by Per
91		Hedeland of Ericsson.
92	Turn off RES_DEBUG if SFIO is defined unless SFIO_STDIO_COMPAT
93		is defined to avoid a core dump due to incompatibilities
94		between sfio and stdio.  Problem noted by Neil Rickert
95		of Northern Illinois University.
96	Don't log useless envelope ID on initial connection log.  Problem
97		noted by Kari Hurtta of the Finnish Meteorological Institute.
98	Convert the free disk space shown in a control socket status query
99		to kilobyte units.
100	If TryNullMXList is True and there is a temporary DNS failure
101		looking up the hostname, requeue the message for a later
102		attempt.  Problem noted by Ari Heikkinen of Pohjois-Savo
103		Polytechnic.
104	Under the proper circumstances, failed connections would be recorded
105		as "Bad file number" instead of "Connection failed" in the
106		queue file and persistent host status.  Problem noted by
107		Graeme Hewson of Oracle.
108	Avoid getting into an endless loop if a non-hoststat directory exists
109		within the hoststatus directory (e.g., lost+found).
110		Patch from Valdis Kletnieks of Virginia Tech.
111	Make sure Timeout.queuereturn=now returns a bounce message to the
112		sender.  Problem noted by Per Hedeland of Ericsson.
113	If a message data file can't be opened at delivery time, panic and
114		abort the attempt instead of delivering a message that
115		states "<<< No Message Collected >>>".
116	Fixup the GID checking code from 8.10.2 as it was overly
117		restrictive.  Problem noted by Mark G. Thomas of Mark
118		G. Thomas Consulting.
119	Preserve source port number instead of replacing it with the ident
120		port number (113).
121	Document the queue status characters in the mailq man page.
122		Suggested by Ulrich Windl of the Universitat Regensburg.
123	Process queued items in which none of the recipient addresses have
124		host portions (or there are no recipients).  Problem noted
125		by Valdis Kletnieks of Virginia Tech.
126	If a cached LDAP connection is used for multiple maps, make sure
127		only the first to open the connection is allowed to close
128		it so a later map close doesn't break the connection for
129		other maps.  Problem noted by Wolfgang Hottgenroth of UUNET.
130	Netscape's LDAP libraries do not support Kerberos V4
131		authentication.  Patch from Rainer Schoepf of the
132		University of Mainz.
133	Provide workaround for inconsistent handling of data passed
134		via callbacks to Cyrus SASL prior to version 1.5.23.
135	Mention ENHANCEDSTATUSCODES in the SMTP HELP helpfile.  Omission
136		noted by Ulrich Windl of the Universitat Regensburg.
137	Portability:
138		Add the ability to read IPv6 interface addresses into class
139			'w' under FreeBSD (and possibly others).  From Jun
140			Kuriyama of IMG SRC, Inc. and the FreeBSD Project.
141		Replace code for finding the number of CPUs on HPUX.
142		NCRUNIX MP-RAS 3.02 SO_REUSEADDR socket option does not
143			work properly causing problems if the accept()
144			fails and the socket needs to be reopened.  Patch
145			from Tom Moore of NCR.
146		NetBSD uses a .0 extension of formatted man pages.  From
147			Andrew Brown of Graffiti World Wide, Inc.
148		Return to using the IPv6 AI_DEFAULT flag instead of AI_V4MAPPED
149			for calls to getipnodebyname().  The Linux
150			implementation is broken so AI_ADDRCONFIG is stripped
151			under Linux.  From John Beck of Sun Microsystems and
152			John Kennedy of Cal State University, Chico.
153	CONFIG: Catch invalid addresses containing a ',' at the wrong place.
154		Patch from Neil Rickert of Northern Illinois University.
155	CONFIG: New variables for the new sendmail options:
156		confCACERT_PATH			CACERTPath
157		confCACERT			CACERTFile
158		confCLIENT_CERT			ClientCertFile
159		confCLIENT_KEY			ClientKeyFile
160		confDH_PARAMETERS		DHParameters
161		confRAND_FILE			RandFile
162		confSERVER_CERT			ServerCertFile
163		confSERVER_KEY			ServerKeyFile
164	CONFIG: Provide basic rulesets for TLS policy control and add new
165		tags to the access database to support these policies.  See
166		cf/README for more information.
167	CONFIG: Add TLS information to the Received: header.
168	CONFIG: Call tls_client ruleset from check_mail in case it wasn't
169		called due to a STARTTLS command.
170	CONFIG: If TLS_PERM_ERR is defined, TLS related errors are permanent
171		instead of temporary.
172	CONFIG: FEATURE(`relay_hosts_only') didn't work in combination with
173		the access map and relaying to a domain without using a To:
174		tag.  Problem noted by Mark G. Thomas of Mark G. Thomas
175		Consulting.
176	CONFIG: Set confEBINDIR to /usr/sbin to match the devtools entry in
177		OSTYPE(`linux') and OSTYPE(`mklinux').  From Tim Pierce of
178		RootsWeb.com.
179	CONFIG: Make sure FEATURE(`nullclient') doesn't use aliasing and
180		forwarding to make it as close to the old behavior as
181		possible.  Problem noted by George W. Baltz of the
182		University of Maryland.
183	CONFIG: Added OSTYPE(`darwin') for Mac OS X and Darwin users.  From
184		Wilfredo Sanchez of Apple Computer, Inc.
185	CONFIG: Changed the map names used by FEATURE(`ldap_routing') from
186		ldap_mailhost and ldap_mailroutingaddress to ldapmh and
187		ldapmra as underscores in map names cause problems if
188		underscore is in OperatorChars.  Problem noted by Bob Zeitz
189		of the University of Alberta.
190	CONFIG: Apply blacklist_recipients also to hosts in class {w}.
191		Patch from Michael Tratz of Esosoft Corporation.
192	CONFIG: Use A=TCP ... instead of A=IPC ... in SMTP mailers.
193	CONTRIB: Add link_hash.sh to create symbolic links to the hash
194		of X.509 certificates.
195	CONTRIB: passwd-to-alias.pl:  More protection from special characters;
196		treat special shells as root aliases; skip entries where the
197		GECOS full name and username match.  From Ulrich Windl of the
198		Universitat Regensburg.
199	CONTRIB: qtool.pl: Add missing last_modified_time method and fix a
200		typo.  Patch from Graeme Hewson of Oracle.
201	CONTRIB: re-mqueue.pl: Improve handling of a race between re-mqueue
202		and sendmail.  Patch from Graeme Hewson of Oracle.
203	CONTRIB: re-mqueue.pl: Don't exit(0) at end so can be called as
204		subroutine Patch from Graeme Hewson of Oracle.
205	CONTRIB: Add movemail.pl (move old mail messages between queues by
206		calling re-mqueue.pl) and movemail.conf (configuration
207		script for movemail.pl).  From Graeme Hewson of Oracle.
208	CONTRIB: Add cidrexpand (expands CIDR blocks as a preprocessor to
209		makemap).  From Derek J. Balling of Yahoo,Inc.
210	DEVTOOLS: INSTALL_RAWMAN installation option mistakenly applied any
211		extension modifications (e.g., MAN8EXT) to the installation
212		target.  Patch from James Ralston of Carnegie Mellon
213		University.
214	DEVTOOLS: Add support for SunOS 5.9.
215	DEVTOOLS: New option confLN contains the command used to create
216		links.
217	LIBSMDB: Berkeley DB 2.X and 3.X errors might be lost and not
218		reported.
219	MAIL.LOCAL: DG/UX portability.  Problem noted by Tim Boyer of
220		Denman Tire Corporation.
221	MAIL.LOCAL: Prevent a possible DoS attack when compiled with
222		-DCONTENTLENGTH.  Based on patch from 3APA3A@SECURITY.NNOV.RU.
223	MAILSTATS: Fix usage statement (-p and -o are optional).
224	MAKEMAP: Change man page layout as workaround for problem with nroff
225		and -man on Solaris 7.  Patch from Larry Williamson.
226	RMAIL: AIX 4.3 has snprintf().  Problem noted by David Hayes of
227		Black Diamond Equipment, Limited.
228	RMAIL: Prevent a segmentation fault if the incoming message does not
229		have a From line.
230	VACATION: Read all of the headers before deciding whether or not
231		to respond instead of stopping after finding recipient.
232	Added Files:
233		cf/ostype/darwin.m4
234		contrib/cidrexpand
235		contrib/link_hash.sh
236		contrib/movemail.conf
237		contrib/movemail.pl
238		devtools/OS/SunOS.5.9
239		test/t_snprintf.c
240
2418.10.2/8.10.2	2000/06/07
242	SECURITY: Work around broken Linux setuid() implementation.
243		On Linux, a normal user process has the ability to subvert
244		the setuid() call such that it is impossible for a root
245		process to drop its privileges.  Problem noted by Wojciech
246		Purczynski of elzabsoft.pl.
247	SECURITY: Add more vigilance around set*uid(), setgid(), setgroups(),
248		initgroups(), and chroot() calls.
249	Added Files:
250		test/t_setuid.c
251
2528.10.1/8.10.1	2000/04/06
253	SECURITY: Limit the choice of outgoing (client-side) SMTP
254		Authentication mechanisms to those specified in
255		AuthMechanisms to prevent information leakage.  We do not
256		recommend use of PLAIN for outgoing mail as it sends the
257		password in clear text to possibly untrusted servers.  See
258		cf/README's DefaultAuthInfo section for additional information.
259	Copy the ident argument for openlog() to avoid problems on some
260		OSs.  Based on patch from Rob Bajorek from Webhelp.com.
261	Avoid bogus error message when reporting an alias line as too long.
262	Avoid bogus socket error message if sendmail.cf version level is
263		greater than sendmail binary supported version.  Patch
264		from John Beck of Sun Microsystems.
265	Prevent a malformed ruleset (missing right hand side) from causing
266		a segmentation fault when using address test mode.  Based on
267		patch from John Beck of Sun Microsystems.
268	Prevent memory leak from use of NIS maps and yp_match(3).  Problem
269		noted by Gil Kloepfer of the University of Texas at Austin.
270	Fix queue file permission checks to allow for TrustedUser ownership.
271	Change logging of errors from the trust_auth ruleset to LogLevel 10
272		or higher.
273	Avoid simple password cracking attacks against SMTP AUTH by using
274		exponential delay after too many tries within one connection.
275	Encode an initial empty AUTH challenge as '=', not as empty string.
276	Avoid segmentation fault on EX_SOFTWARE internal error logs.
277		Problem noted by Allan E Johannesen of Worcester
278		Polytechnic Institute.
279	Ensure that a header check which resolves to $#discard actually
280		discards the message.
281	Emit missing value warnings for aliases with no right hand side
282		when newaliases is run instead of only when delivery is
283		attempted to the alias.
284	Remove AuthOptions missing value warning for consistency with other
285		flag options.
286	Portability:
287		SECURITY: Specify a run-time shared library search path for
288			AIX 4.X instead of using the dangerous AIX 4.X
289			linker semantics.  AIX 4.X users should consult
290			sendmail/README for further information.  Problem
291			noted by Valdis Kletnieks of Virginia Tech.
292		Avoid use of strerror(3) call.  Problem noted by Charles
293			Levert of Ecole Polytechnique de Montreal.
294		DGUX requires -lsocket -lnsl and has a non-standard install
295			program.  From Tim Boyer of Denman Tire Corporation.
296		HPUX 11.0 has a broken res_search() function.
297		Updates to devtools/OS/NeXT.3.X, NeXT.4.X, and NEXTSTEP.4.X
298			from J. P. McCann of E I A.
299		Digital UNIX/Compaq Tru64 5.0 now includes snprintf(3).
300			Problem noted by Michael Long of Info Avenue Internet
301			Services, LLC.
302		Modern (post-199912) OpenBSD versions include working
303			strlc{at,py}(3) functions.  From Todd C. Miller of
304			Courtesan Consulting.
305		SINIX doesn't have random(3).  From Gerald Rinske of
306			Siemens Business Services.
307	CONFIG: Change error message about unresolvable sender domain to
308		include the sender address.  Proposed by Wolfgang Rupprecht
309		of WSRCC.
310	CONFIG: Fix usenet mailer calls.
311	CONFIG: If RELAY_MAILER_FLAGS is not defined, use SMTP_MAILER_FLAGS
312		to be backward compatible with 8.9.
313	CONFIG: Change handling of default case @domain for virtusertable
314		to allow for +*@domain to deal with +detail.
315	CONTRIB: Remove converting.sun.configs -- it is obsolete.
316	DEVTOOLS: confUBINMODE was being ignored.  Fix from KITAZIMA, Tuneki
317		of NEC.
318	DEVTOOLS: Add to NCR platform list and include the architecture
319		(i486).  From Tom J. Moore of NCR.
320	DEVTOOLS: SECURITY: Change method of linking with sendmail utility
321		libraries to work around the AIX 4.X and SunOS 4.X linker's
322		overloaded -L option.  Problem noted by Valdis Kletnieks of
323		Virginia Tech.
324	DEVTOOLS: configure.sh was overriding the user's choice for
325		confNROFF.  Problem noted by Glenn A. Malling of Syracuse
326		University.
327	DEVTOOLS: New variables conf_prog_LIB_POST and confBLDVARIANT added
328		for other internal projects but included in the open source
329		release.
330	LIBSMDB: Check for ".db" instead of simply "db" at the end of the
331		map name to determine whether or not to add the extension.
332		This fixes makemap when building the userdb file.  Problem
333		noted by Andrew J Cole of the University of Leeds.
334	LIBSMDB: Allow a database to be opened for updating and created if
335		it doesn't already exist.  Problem noted by Rand Wacker of
336		Sendmail.
337	LIBSMDB: If type is SMDB_TYPE_DEFAULT and both NEWDB and NDBM are
338		available, fall back to NDBM if NEWDB open fails.  This
339		fixes praliases.  Patch	from John Beck of Sun Microsystems.
340	LIBSMUTIL: safefile()'s SFF_NOTEXCL check was being misinterpreted
341		as SFF_NOWRFILES.
342	OP.ME: Clarify some issues regarding mailer flags.  Suggested by
343		Martin Mokrejs of The Charles University and Neil Rickert of
344		Northern Illinois University.
345	PRALIASES: Restore 8.9.X functionality of being able to search for
346		particular keys in a database by specifying the keys on the
347		command line.  Man page updated accordingly.  Patch from
348		John Beck of Sun Microsystems.
349	VACATION: SunOS 4.X portability from Charles Levert of Ecole
350		Polytechnique de Montreal.
351	VACATION: Fix -t option which is ignored but available for
352		compatibility with Sun's version, based on patch from
353		Volker Dobler of Infratest Burke.
354	Added Files:
355		devtools/M4/UNIX/smlib.m4
356		devtools/OS/OSF1.V5.0
357	Deleted Files:
358		contrib/converting.sun.configs
359	Deleted Directories (already done in 8.10.0 but not listed):
360		doc/intro
361		doc/usenix
362		doc/changes
363
3648.10.0/8.10.0	2000/03/01
365	    *************************************************************
366	    * The engineering department at Sendmail, Inc. has suffered *
367	    * the tragic loss of a key member of our engineering team.  *
368	    * Julie Van Bourg was the Vice President of Engineering     *
369	    * at Sendmail, Inc. during the development and deployment   *
370	    * of this release.  It was her vision, dedication, and      *
371	    * support that has made this release a success.  Julie died *
372	    * on October 26, 1999 of cancer.  We have lost a leader, a  *
373	    * coach, and a friend.                                      *
374	    *                                                           *
375	    * This release is dedicated to her memory and to the joy,   *
376	    * strength, ideals, and hope that she brought to all of us. *
377	    * Julie, we miss you!                                       *
378	    *************************************************************
379	SECURITY: The safe file checks now back track through symbolic
380		links to make sure the files can't be compromised due
381		to poor permissions on the parent directories of the
382		symbolic link target.
383	SECURITY: Only root, TrustedUser, and users in class t can rebuild
384		the alias map.  Problem noted by Michal Zalewski of the
385		"Internet for Schools" project (IdS).
386	SECURITY: There is a potential for a denial of service attack if
387		the AutoRebuildAliases option is set as a user can kill the
388		sendmail process while it is rebuilding the aliases file
389		(leaving it in an inconsistent state).  This option and
390		its use is deprecated and will be removed from a future
391		version of sendmail.
392	SECURITY: Make sure all file descriptors (besides stdin, stdout, and
393		stderr) are closed before restarting sendmail.  Problem noted
394		by Michal Zalewski of the "Internet for Schools" project
395		(IdS).
396	Begin using /etc/mail/ for sendmail related files.  This affects
397		a large number of files.  See cf/README for more details.
398	The directory structure of the distribution has changed slightly
399		for easier code sharing among the programs.
400	Support SMTP AUTH (see RFC 2554).  New macros for this purpose
401		are ${auth_authen}, ${auth_type}, and ${auth_author}
402		which hold the client's authentication credentials,
403		the mechanism used for authentication, and the
404		authorization identity (i.e., the AUTH= parameter if
405		supplied).  Based on code contributed by Tim Martin of CMU.
406	On systems which use the Torek stdio library (all of the BSD
407		distributions), use memory-buffered files to reduce
408		file system overhead by not creating temporary files on
409		disk.  Contributed by Exactis.com, Inc.
410	New option DataFileBufferSize to control the maximum size of a
411		memory-buffered data (df) file before a disk-based file is
412		used.  Contributed by Exactis.com, Inc.
413	New option XscriptFileBufferSize to control the maximum size of a
414		memory-buffered transcript (xf) file before a disk-based
415		file is used.  Contributed by Exactis.com, Inc.
416	sendmail implements RFC 2476 (Message Submission), e.g., it can
417		now listen on several different ports.  Use:
418		O DaemonPortOptions=Name=MSA, Port=587, M=E
419		to run a Message Submission Agent (MSA); this is turned
420		on by default in m4-generated .cf files; it can be turned
421		off with FEATURE(`no_default_msa').
422	The 'XUSR' SMTP command is deprecated.  Mail user agents should
423		begin using RFC 2476 Message Submission for initial user
424		message submission.  XUSR may disappear from a future release.
425	The new '-G' (relay (gateway) submission) command line option
426		indicates that the message being submitted from the command
427		line is for relaying, not initial submission.  This means
428		the message will be rejected if the addresses are not fully
429		qualified and no canonicalization will be done.  Future
430		releases may even reject improperly formed messages.
431	The '-U' (initial user submission) command line option is
432		deprecated and may be removed from a future release.
433		Mail user agents should begin using '-G' to indicate that
434		this is a relay submission (the inverse of -U).
435	The next release of sendmail will assume that any message submitted
436		from the command line is an initial user submission and act
437		accordingly.
438	If sendmail doesn't have enough privileges to run a .forward
439		program or deliver to file as the owner of that file, the
440		address is marked as unsafe.  This means if RunAsUser is
441		set, users won't be able to use programs or delivery to
442		files in their .forward files.  Administrators can override
443		this by setting the DontBlameSendmail option to the new
444		setting NonRootSafeAddr.
445	Allow group or world writable directories if the sticky bit is set
446		on the directory and DontBlameSendmail is set to
447		TrustStickyBit.  Based on patch from Chris Metcalf of
448		InCert Software.
449	Prevent logging of unsafe directory paths for non-existent forward
450		files if the new DontWarnForwardFileInUnsafeDirPath bit is
451		set in the DontBlameSendmail option.  Requested by many.
452	New Timeout.control option to limit the total time spent satisfying
453		a control socket request.
454	New Timeout.resolver options for controlling BIND resolver
455		settings:
456		Timeout.resolver.retrans
457			Sets the resolver's retransmission time interval (in
458			seconds).  Sets both Timeout.resolver.retrans.first
459			and Timeout.resolver.retrans.normal.
460		Timeout.resolver.retrans.first
461			Sets the resolver's retransmission time interval (in
462			seconds) for the first attempt to deliver a message.
463		Timeout.resolver.retrans.normal
464			Sets the resolver's retransmission time interval (in
465			seconds) for all resolver lookups except the first
466			delivery attempt.
467		Timeout.resolver.retry
468			Sets the number of times to retransmit a resolver
469			query.  Sets both Timeout.resolver.retry.first
470			and Timeout.resolver.retry.normal.
471		Timeout.resolver.retry.first
472			Sets the number of times to retransmit a resolver
473			query for the first attempt to deliver a message.
474		Timeout.resolver.retry.normal
475			Sets the number of times to retransmit a resolver
476			query for all resolver lookups except the first
477			delivery attempt.
478		Contributed by Exactis.com, Inc.
479	Support multiple queue directories.  To use multiple queues, supply
480		a QueueDirectory option value ending with an asterisk.  For
481		example, /var/spool/mqueue/q* will use all of the
482		directories or symbolic links to directories beginning with
483		'q' in /var/spool/mqueue as queue directories.  Keep in
484		mind, the queue directory structure should not be changed
485		while sendmail is running.  Queue runs create a separate
486		process for running each queue unless the verbose flag is
487		given on a non-daemon queue run.  New items are randomly
488		assigned to a queue.  Contributed by Exactis.com, Inc.
489	Support different directories for qf, df, and xf queue files; if
490		subdirectories or symbolic links to directories of those names
491		exist in the queue directories, they are used for the
492		corresponding queue files.  Keep in mind, the queue
493		directory structure should not be changed while sendmail is
494		running.  Proposed by Mathias Koerber of Singapore
495		Telecommunications Ltd.
496	New queue file naming system which uses a filename guaranteed to be
497		unique for 60 years.  This allows queue IDs to be assigned
498		without fancy file system locking.  Queued items can be
499		moved between queues easily.  Contributed by Exactis.com,
500		Inc.
501	Messages which are undeliverable due to temporary address failures
502		(e.g., DNS failure) will now go to the FallBackMX host, if
503		set.  Contributed by Exactis.com, Inc.
504	New command line option '-L tag' which sets the identifier used for
505		syslog.  Contributed by Exactis.com, Inc.
506	QueueSortOrder=Filename will sort the queue by filename.  This
507		avoids opening and reading each queue file when preparing
508		to run the queue.  Contributed by Exactis.com, Inc.
509	Shared memory counters and microtimers functionality has been
510		donated by Exactis.com, Inc.
511	The SCCS ID tags have been replaced with RCS ID tags.
512	Allow trusted users (those on a T line or in $=t) to set the
513		QueueDirectory (Q) option without an X-Authentication-Warning:
514		being added.  Suggested by Michael K. Sanders.
515	IPv6 support based on patches from John Kennedy of Cal State
516		University, Chico, Motonori Nakamura of Kyoto University,
517		and John Beck of Sun Microsystems.
518	In low-disk space situations, where sendmail would previously refuse
519		connections, still accept them, but only allow ETRN commands.
520		Suggested by Mathias Koerber of Singapore Telecommunications
521		Ltd.
522	The [IPC] builtin mailer now allows delivery to a UNIX domain socket
523		on systems which support them.  This can be used with LMTP
524		local delivery agents which listen on a named socket.  An
525		example mailer might be:
526			Mexecmail, P=[IPC], F=lsDFMmnqSXzA5@/:|, E=\r\n,
527				S=10, R=20/40, T=DNS/RFC822/X-Unix,
528				A=FILE /var/run/lmtpd
529		Code contributed by Lyndon Nerenberg of Messaging Direct.
530	The [TCP] builtin mailer name is now deprecated.  Use [IPC]
531		instead.
532	The first mailer argument in the [IPC] mailer is now checked for a
533		legitimate value.  Possible values are TCP (for TCP/IP
534		connections), IPC (which will be deprecated in a future
535		version), and FILE (for UNIX domain socket delivery).
536	PrivacyOptions=goaway no longer includes the noetrn and the noreceipts
537		flags.
538	PrivacyOptions=nobodyreturn instructs sendmail not to include the
539		body of the original message on delivery status
540		notifications.
541	Don't announce DSN if PrivacyOptions=noreceipts is set.  Problem noted
542		by Dan Bernstein, fix from Robert Harker of Harker Systems.
543	Accept the SMTP RSET command even when rejecting commands due to TCP
544		Wrappers or the check_relay ruleset.  Problem noted by
545		Steve Schweinhart of America Online.
546	Warn if OperatorChars is set multiple times.  OperatorChars should
547		not be set after rulesets are defined.  Suggested by
548		Mitchell Blank Jr of Exec-PC.
549	Do not report temporary failure on delivery to files.  In
550		interactive delivery mode, this would result in two SMTP
551		responses after the DATA command.  Problem noted by
552		Nik Conwell of Boston University.
553	Check file close when mailing to files.  Problem noted by Nik
554		Conwell of Boston University.
555	Avoid a segmentation fault when using the LDAP map.  Patch from
556		Curtis W. Hillegas of Princeton University.
557	Always bind to the LDAP server regardless of whether you are using
558		ldap_open() or ldap_init().  Fix from Raj Kunjithapadam of
559		@Home Network.
560	New ruleset trust_auth to determine whether a given AUTH=
561		parameter of the MAIL command should be trusted.  See SMTP
562		AUTH, cf/README, and doc/op/op.ps.
563	Allow new named config file rules check_vrfy, check_expn, and
564		check_etrn for VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands, respectively,
565		similar to check_rcpt etc.
566	Introduce new macros ${rcpt_mailer}, ${rcpt_host}, ${rcpt_addr},
567		${mail_mailer}, ${mail_host}, ${mail_addr} that hold
568		the results of parsing the RCPT and MAIL arguments, i.e.
569		the resolved triplet from $#mailer $@host $:addr.
570		From Kari Hurtta of the Finnish Meteorological Institute.
571	New macro ${client_resolve} which holds the result of the resolve
572		call for ${client_name}: OK, FAIL, FORGED, TEMP.  Proposed
573		by Kari Hurtta of the Finnish Meteorological Institute.
574	New macros ${dsn_notify}, ${dsn_envid}, and ${dsn_ret} that hold
575		the corresponding DSN parameter values.  Proposed by
576		Mathias Herberts.
577	New macro ${msg_size} which holds the value of the SIZE= parameter,
578		i.e., usually the size of the message (in an ESMTP dialogue),
579		before the message has been collected, thereafter it holds
580		the message size as computed by sendmail (and can be used
581		in check_compat).
582	The macro ${deliveryMode} now specifies the current delivery mode
583		sendmail is using instead of the value of the DeliveryMode
584		option.
585	New macro ${ntries} holds the number of delivery attempts.
586	Drop explicit From: if same as what would be generated only if it is
587		a local address.  From Motonori Nakamura of Kyoto University.
588	Write pid to file also if sendmail only processes the queue.
589		Proposed by Roy J. Mongiovi of Georgia Tech.
590	Log "low on disk space" only when necessary.
591	New macro ${load_avg} can be used to check the current load average.
592		Suggested by Scott Gifford of The Internet Ramp.
593	Return-Receipt-To: header implies DSN request if option RrtImpliesDsn
594		is set.
595	Flag -S for maps to specify the character which is substituted
596		for spaces (instead of the default given by O BlankSub).
597	Flag -D for maps: perform no lookup in deferred delivery mode.
598		This flag is set by default for the host map.  Based on a
599		proposal from Ian MacPhedran of the University of Saskatchewan.
600	Open maps only on demand, not at startup.
601	Log warning about unsupported IP address families.
602	New option MaxHeadersLength allows to specify a maximum length
603		of the sum of all headers.  This can be used to prevent
604		a denial-of-service attack.
605	New option MaxMimeHeaderLength which limits the size of MIME
606		headers and parameters within those headers.  This option
607		is intended to protect mail user agents from buffer
608		overflow attacks.
609	Added option MaxAliasRecursion to specify the maximum depth of
610		alias recursion.
611	New flag F=6 for mailers to strip headers to seven bit.
612	Map type syslog to log the key via syslogd.
613	Entries in the alias file can be continued by putting a backslash
614		directly before the newline.
615	New option DeadLetterDrop to define the location of the system-wide
616		dead.letter file, formerly hardcoded to
617		/usr/tmp/dead.letter.  If this option is not set (the
618		default), sendmail will not attempt to save to a
619		system-wide dead.letter file if it can not bounce the mail
620		to the user nor postmaster.  Instead, it will rename the qf
621		file as it has in the past when the dead.letter file
622		could not be opened.
623	New option PidFile to define the location of the pid file.  The
624		value of this option is macro expanded.
625	New option ProcessTitlePrefix specifies a prefix string for the
626		process title shown in 'ps' listings.
627	New macros for use with the PidFile and ProcessTitlePrefix options
628		(along with the already existing macros):
629		${daemon_info}      Daemon information, e.g.
630		                    SMTP+queueing@00:30:00
631		${daemon_addr}	    Daemon address, e.g., 0.0.0.0
632		${daemon_family}    Daemon family, e.g., inet, inet6, etc.
633		${daemon_name}      Daemon name, e.g., MSA.
634		${daemon_port}	    Daemon port, e.g., 25
635		${queue_interval}   Queue run interval, e.g., 00:30:00
636	New macros especially for virtual hosting:
637		${if_name}	hostname of interface of incoming connection.
638		${if_addr}	address of interface of incoming connection.
639		The latter is only set if the interface does not belong to the
640		loopback net.
641	If a message being accepted via a method other than SMTP and
642		would be rejected by a header check, do not send the message.
643		Suggested by Phil Homewood of Mincom Pty Ltd.
644	Don't strip comments for header checks if $>+ is used instead of $>.
645		Provide header value as quoted string in the macro
646		${currHeader} (possibly truncated to MAXNAME).  Suggested by
647		Jan Krueger of Unix-AG of University of Hannover.
648		The length of the header value is stored in ${hdrlen}.
649	H*: allows to specify a default ruleset for header checks.  This
650		ruleset will only be called if the individual header does
651		not have its own ruleset assigned.  Suggested by Jan
652		Krueger of Unix-AG of University of Hannover.
653		The name of the header field stored in ${hdr_name}.
654	Comments (i.e., text within parentheses) in rulesets are not
655		removed if the config file version is greater than or equal
656		to 9.  For example, "R$+ ( 1 )		$@ 1" matches the
657		input "token (1)" but does not match "token".
658	Avoid removing the Content-Transfer-Encoding MIME header on
659		MIME messages.  Problem noted by Sigurbjorn B. Larusson of
660		Multimedia Consumer Services.  Fix from Per Hedeland of
661		Ericsson.
662	Avoid duplicate Content-Transfer-Encoding MIME header on
663		messages with 8-bit text in headers.  Problem noted by
664		Per Steinar Iversen of Oslo College.  Fix from Per Hedeland
665		of Ericsson.
666	Avoid keeping maps locked longer than necessary when re-opening a
667		modified database map file.  Problem noted by Chris Adams
668		of Renaissance Internet Services.
669	Resolving to the $#error mailer with a temporary failure code (e.g.,
670		$#error $@ tempfail $: "400 Temporary failure") will now
671		queue up the message instead of bouncing it.
672	Be more liberal in acceptable responses to an SMTP RSET command as
673		standard does not provide any indication of what to do when
674		something other than 250 is received.  Based on a patch
675		from Steve Schweinhart of America Online.
676	New option TrustedUser allows to specify a user who can own
677		important files instead of root.  This requires HASFCHOWN.
678	Fix USERDB conditional so compiling with NEWDB or HESIOD and
679		setting USERDB=0 works.  Fix from Jorg Zanger of Schock.
680	Fix another instance (similar to one in 8.9.3) of a network failure
681		being mis-logged as "Illegal Seek" instead of whatever
682		really went wrong.  From John Beck of Sun Microsystems.
683	$? tests also whether the macro is non-null.
684	Print an error message if a mailer definition contains an invalid
685		equate name.
686	New mailer equate /= to specify a directory to chroot() into before
687		executing the mailer program.  Suggested by Igor Vinokurov.
688	New mailer equate W= to specify the maximum time to wait for the
689		mailer to return after sending all data to it.
690	Only free memory from the process list when adding a new process
691		into a previously filled slot.  Previously, the memory was
692		freed at removal time.  Since removal can happen in a
693		signal handler, this may leave the memory map in an
694		inconsistent state.  Problem noted by Jeff A. Earickson and
695		David Cooley of Colby College.
696	When using the UserDB @hostname catch-all, do not try to lookup
697		local users in the passwd file.  The UserDB code has
698		already decided the message will be passed to another host
699		for processing.  Fix from Tony Landells of Burdett
700		Buckeridge Young Limited.
701	Support LDAP authorization via either a file containing the
702		password or Kerberos V4 using the new map options
703		'-ddistinguished_name', '-Mmethod', and '-Pfilename'.  The
704		distinguished_name is who to login as.  The method can be
705		one of LDAP_AUTH_NONE, LDAP_AUTH_SIMPLE, or
706		LDAP_AUTH_KRBV4.  The filename is the file containing the
707		secret key for LDAP_AUTH_SIMPLE or the name of the Kerberos
708		ticket file for LDAP_AUTH_KRBV4.  Patch from Booker Bense
709		of Stanford University.
710	The ldapx map has been renamed to ldap.  The use of ldapx is
711		deprecated and will be removed in a future version.
712	If the result of an LDAP search returns a multi-valued attribute
713		and the map has the column delimiter set, it turns that
714		response into a delimiter separated string.  The LDAP map
715		will traverse multiple entries as well.  LDAP alias maps
716		automatically set the column delimiter to the comma.
717		Based on patch from Booker Bense of Stanford University and
718		idea from Philip A. Prindeville of Mirapoint, Inc.
719	Support return of multiple values for a single LDAP lookup.  The
720		values to be returned should be in a comma separated string.
721		For example, `-v "email,emailother"'.  Patch from
722		Curtis W. Hillegas of Princeton University.
723	Allow the use of LDAP for alias maps.
724	If no LDAP attributes are specified in an LDAP map declaration, all
725		attributes found in the match will be returned.
726	Prevent commas in quoted strings in the AliasFile value from
727		breaking up a single entry into multiple entries.  This is
728		needed for LDAP alias file specifications to allow for
729		comma separated key and value strings.
730	Keep connections to LDAP server open instead of opening and closing
731		for each lookup.  To reduce overhead, sendmail will cache
732		connections such that multiple maps which use the same
733		host, port, bind DN, and authentication will only result in
734		a single connection to that host.
735	Put timeout in the proper place for USE_LDAP_INIT.
736	Be more careful about checking for errors and freeing memory on
737		LDAP lookups.
738	Use asynchronous LDAP searches to save memory and network
739		resources.
740	Do not copy LDAP query results if the map's match only flag is set.
741	Increase portability to the Netscape LDAP libraries.
742	Change the parsing of the LDAP filter specification.  '%s' is still
743		replaced with the literal contents of the map lookup key --
744		note that this means a lookup can be done using the LDAP
745		special characters.  The new '%0' token can be used instead
746		of '%s' to encode the key buffer according to RFC 2254.
747		For example, if the LDAP map specification contains '-k
748		"(user=%s)"' and a lookup is done on "*", this would be
749		equivalent to '-k "(user=*)"' -- matching ANY record with a
750		user attribute.  Instead, if the LDAP map specification
751		contains '-k "(user=%0)"' and a lookup is done on "*", this
752		would be equivalent to '-k "(user=\2A)"' -- matching a user
753		with the name "*".
754	New LDAP map flags: "-1" requires a single match to be returned, if
755		more than one is returned, it is equivalent to no records
756		being found; "-r never|always|search|find" sets the LDAP
757		alias dereference option; "-Z size" limits the number of
758		matches to return.
759	New option LDAPDefaultSpec allows a default map specification for
760		LDAP maps.  The value should only contain LDAP specific
761		settings such as "-h host -p port -d bindDN", etc.  The
762		settings will be used for all LDAP maps unless they are
763		specified in the individual map specification ('K'
764		command).  This option should be set before any LDAP maps
765		are defined.
766	Prevent an NDBM alias file opening loop when the NDBM open
767		continually fails.  Fix from Roy J. Mongiovi of Georgia
768		Tech.
769	Reduce memory utilization for smaller symbol table entries.  In
770		particular, class entries get much smaller, which can be
771		important if you have large classes.
772	On network-related temporary failures, record the hostname which
773		gave error in the queued status message.  Requested by
774		Ulrich Windl of the Universitat Regensburg.
775	Add new F=% mailer flag to allow for a store and forward
776		configuration.  Mailers which have this flag will not attempt
777		delivery on initial recipient of a message or on queue runs
778		unless the queued message is selected using one of the
779		-qI/-qR/-qS queue run modifiers or an ETRN request.  Code
780		provided by Philip Guenther of Gustavus Adolphus College.
781	New option ControlSocketName which, when set, creates a daemon
782		control socket.  This socket allows an external program to
783		control and query status from the running sendmail daemon
784		via a named socket, similar to the ctlinnd interface to the
785		INN news server.  Access to this interface is controlled by
786		the UNIX file permissions on the named socket on most UNIX
787		systems (see sendmail/README for more information).  An
788		example control program is provided as contrib/smcontrol.pl.
789	Change the default values of QueueLA from 8 to (8 * numproc) and
790		RefuseLA from 12 to (12 * numproc) where numproc is the
791		number of processors online on the system (if that can be
792		determined).  For single processor machines, this change
793		has no effect.
794	Don't return body of message to postmaster on "Too many hops" bounces.
795		Based on fix from Motonori Nakamura of Kyoto University.
796	Give more detailed DSN descriptions for some cases.  Patch from
797		Motonori Nakamura of Kyoto University.
798	Logging of alias, forward file, and UserDB expansion now happens
799		at LogLevel 11 or higher instead of 10 or higher.
800	Logging of an envelope's complete delivery (the "done" message) now
801		happens at LogLevel 10 or higher instead of 11 or higher.
802	Logging of TCP/IP or UNIX standard input connections now happens at
803		LogLevel 10 or higher.  Previously, only TCP/IP connections
804		were logged, and on at LogLevel 12 or higher.  Setting
805		LogLevel to 10 will now assist users in tracking frequent
806		connection-based denial of service attacks.
807	Log basic information about authenticated connections at LogLevel
808		10 or higher.
809	Log SMTP Authentication mechanism and author when logging the sender
810		information (from= syslog line).
811	Log the DSN code for each recipient if one is available as a new
812		equate (dsn=).
813	Macro expand PostmasterCopy and DoubleBounceAddress options.
814	New "ph" map for performing ph queries in rulesets.  More
815		information is available at
816		http://www-wsg.cso.uiuc.edu/sendmail/patches/.
817		Contributed by Mark Roth of the University of Illinois at
818		Urbana-Champaign.
819	Detect temporary lookup failures in the host map if looking up a
820		bracketed IP address.  Problem noted by Kari Hurtta of the
821		Finnish Meteorological Institute.
822	Do not report a Remote-MTA on local deliveries.  Problem noted by
823		Kari Hurtta of the Finnish Meteorological Institute.
824	When a forward file points to an alias which runs a program, run
825		the program as the default user and the default group, not
826		the forward file user.  This change also assures the
827		:include: directives in aliases are also processed using
828		the default user and group.  Problem noted by Sergiu
829		Popovici of DNT Romania.
830	Prevent attempts to save a dead.letter file for a user with
831		no home directory (/no/such/directory).  Problem noted by
832		Michael Brown of Finnigan FT/MS.
833	Include message delay and number of tries when logging that a
834		message has been completely delivered (LogLevel of 10 or
835		above).  Suggested by Nick Hilliard of Ireland Online.
836	Log the sender of a message even if none of the recipients were
837		accepted.  If some of the recipients were rejected, it is
838		helpful to know the sender of the message.
839	Check the root directory (/) when checking a path for safety.
840		Problem noted by John Beck of Sun Microsystems.
841	Prevent multiple responses to the DATA command if DeliveryMode is
842		interactive and delivering to an alias which resolves to
843		multiple files.
844	Macros in the helpfile are expanded if the helpfile version is 2 or
845		greater (see below); the help function doesn't print the
846		version of sendmail any longer, instead it is placed in
847		the helpfile ($v).  Suggested by Chuck Foster of UUNET
848		PIPEX.  Additionally, comment lines (starting with #) are
849		skipped and a version line (#vers) is introduced.  The
850		helpfile version for 8.10.0 is 2, if no version or an older
851		version is found, a warning is logged.  The '#vers'
852		directive should be placed at the top of the help file.
853	Use fsync() when delivering to a file to guarantee the delivery to
854		disk succeeded.  Suggested by Nick Christenson.
855	If delivery to a file is unsuccessful, truncate the file back to its
856		length before the attempt.
857	If a forward points to a filename for delivery, change to the
858		user's uid before checking permissions on the file.  This
859		allows delivery to files on NFS mounted directories where
860		root is remapped to nobody.  Problem noted by Harald
861		Daeubler of Universitaet Ulm.
862	purgestat and sendmail -bH purge only expired (Timeout.hoststatus)
863		host status files, not all files.
864	Any macros stored in the class $={persistentMacros} will be saved
865		in the queue file for the message and set when delivery
866		is attempted on the queued item.  Suggested by Kyle Jones of
867		Wonderworks Inc.
868	Add support for storing information between rulesets using the new
869		macro map class.  This can be used to store information
870		between queue runs as well using $={persistentMacros}.
871		Based on an idea from Jan Krueger of Unix-AG of University
872		of Hannover.
873	New map class arith to allow for computations in rules.  The
874		operation (+, -, *, /, l (for less than), and =) is given
875		as key.  The two operands are specified as arguments; the
876		lookup returns the result of the computation.  For example,
877		"$(arith l $@ 4 $@ 2 $)" will return "FALSE" and
878		"$(arith + $@ 4 $@ 2 $)" will return "6".
879	Add new syntax for header declarations which decide whether to
880		include the header based on a macro rather than a mailer
881		flag:
882			H?${MyMacro}?X-My-Header: ${MyMacro}
883		This should be used along with $={persistentMacros}.
884		It can be used for adding headers to a message based on
885		the results of check_* and header check rulesets.
886	Allow new named config file rule check_eoh which is called after
887		all of the headers have been collected.  The input to the
888		ruleset the number of headers and the size of all of the
889		headers in bytes separated by $|.  This ruleset along with
890		the macro storage map can be used to correlate information
891		gathered between headers and to check for missing headers.
892		See cf/README or doc/op/op.ps for an example.
893	Change the default for the MeToo option to True to correspond
894		to the clarification in the DRUMS SMTP Update spec.  This
895		option is deprecated and will be removed from a future
896		version.
897	Change the sendmail binary default for SendMimeErrors to True.
898	Change the sendmail binary default for SuperSafe to True.
899	Display ruleset names in debug and address test mode output
900		if referencing a named ruleset.
901	New mailer equate m= which will limit the number of messages
902		delivered per connection on an SMTP or LMTP mailer.
903	Improve QueueSortOrder=Host by reversing the hostname before
904		using it to sort.  Now all the same domains are really run
905		through the queue together.  If they have the same MX host,
906		then they will have a much better opportunity to use the
907		connection cache if available.  This should be a reasonable
908		performance improvement.  Patch from Randall Winchester of
909		the University of Maryland.
910	If a message is rejected by a header check ruleset, log who would
911		have received the message if it had not been rejected.
912	New "now" value for Timeout.queuereturn to bounce entries from the
913		queue immediately.  No delivery attempt is made.
914	Increase sleeping time exponentially after too many "bad" commands
915		up to 4 minutes delay (compare MAX{BAD,NOOP,HELO,VRFY,ETRN}-
916		COMMANDS).
917	New option ClientPortOptions similar to DaemonPortOptions
918		but for outgoing connections.
919	New suboptions for DaemonPortOptions: Name (a name used for
920		error messages and logging) and Modifiers, i.e.
921			a	require authentication
922			b	bind to interface through which mail has
923				been received
924			c	perform hostname canonification
925			f	require fully qualified hostname
926			h	use name of interface for outgoing HELO
927				command
928			C	don't perform hostname canonification
929			E	disallow ETRN (see RFC 2476)
930	New suboption for ClientPortOptions: Modifiers, i.e.
931			h	use name of interface for HELO command
932	The version number for queue files (qf) has been incremented to 4.
933	Log unacceptable HELO/EHLO domain name attempts if LogLevel is set
934		to 10 or higher.  Suggested by Rick Troxel of the National
935		Institutes of Health.
936	If a mailer dies, print the status in decimal instead of octal
937		format.  Suggested by Michael Shapiro of Sun Microsystems.
938	Limit the length of all MX records considered for delivery to 8k.
939	Move message priority from sender to recipient logging.  Suggested by
940		Ulrich Windl of the Universitat Regensburg.
941	Add support for Berkeley DB 3.X.
942	Add fix for Berkeley DB 2.X fcntl() locking race condition.
943		Requires a post-2.7.5 version of Berkeley DB.
944	Support writing traffic log (sendmail -X option) to a FIFO.
945		Patch submitted by Rick Heaton of Network Associates, Inc.
946	Do not ignore Timeout settings in the .cf file when a Timeout
947		sub-options is set on the command line.  Problem noted by
948		Graeme Hewson of Oracle.
949	Randomize equal preference MX records each time delivery is
950		attempted via a new connection to a host instead of once per
951		session.  Suggested by Scott Salvidio of Compaq.
952	Implement enhanced status codes as defined by RFC 2034.
953	Add [hostname] to class w for the names of all interfaces unless
954		DontProbeInterfaces is set. This is useful for sending mails
955		to hosts which have dynamically assigned names.
956	If a message is bounced due to bad MIME conformance, avoid bouncing
957		the bounce for the same reason.  If the body is not 8-bit
958		clean, and EightBitMode isn't set to pass8, the body will
959		not be included in the bounce.  Problem noted by Valdis
960		Kletnieks of Virginia Tech.
961	The timeout for sending a message via SMTP has been changed from
962		'${msgsize} / 16 + (${nrcpts} * 300)' to a timeout which
963		simply checks for progress on sending data every 5 minutes.
964		This will detect the inability to send information quicker
965		and reduce the number of processes simply waiting to
966		timeout.
967	Prevent a segmentation fault on systems which give a partial filled
968		interface address structure when loading the system network
969		interface addresses.  Fix from Reinier Bezuidenhout of
970		Nanoteq.
971	Add a compile-time configuration macro, MAXINTERFACES, which
972		indicates the number of interfaces to read when probing
973		for hostnames and IP addresses for class w ($=w).  The
974		default value is 512.  Based on idea from Reinier
975		Bezuidenhout of Nanoteq.
976	If the RefuseLA option is set to 0, do not reject connections based
977		on load average.
978	Allow ruleset 0 to have a name.  Problem noted by Neil Rickert of
979		Northern Illinois University.
980	Expand the Return-Path: header at delivery time, after "owner-"
981		envelope splitting has occurred.
982	Don't try to sort the queue if there are no entries. Patch from
983		Luke Mewburn from RMIT University.
984	Add a "/quit" command to address test mode.
985	Include the proper sender in the UNIX "From " line and Return-Path:
986		header when undeliverable mail is saved to ~/dead.letter.
987		Problem noted by Kari Hurtta of the Finnish Meteorological
988		Institute.
989	The contents of a class can now be copied to another class using
990		the syntax: "C{Dest} $={Source}".  This would copy all of
991		the items in class $={Source} into the class $={Dest}.
992	Include original envelope's error transcript in bounces created for
993		split (owner-) envelopes to see the original errors when
994		the recipients were added.  Based on fix from Motonori
995		Nakamura of Kyoto University.
996	Show reason for permanent delivery errors directly after the
997		addresses.  From Motonori Nakamura of Kyoto University.
998	Prevent a segmentation fault when bouncing a split-envelope
999		message.  Patch from Motonori Nakamura of Kyoto University.
1000	If the specification for the queue run interval (-q###) has a
1001		syntax error, consider the error fatal and exit.
1002	Pay attention to CheckpointInterval during LMTP delivery.  Problem
1003		noted by Motonori Nakamura of Kyoto University.
1004	On operating systems which have setlogin(2), use it to set the
1005		login name to the RunAsUserName when starting as a daemon.
1006		This is for delivery to programs which use getlogin().
1007		Based on fix from Motonori Nakamura of Kyoto University.
1008	Differentiate between "command not implemented" and "command
1009		unrecognized" in the SMTP dialogue.
1010	Strip returns from forward and include files.  Problem noted by
1011		Allan E Johannesen of Worcester Polytechnic Institute.
1012	Prevent a core dump when using 'sendmail -bv' on an address which
1013		resolves to the $#error mailer with a temporary failure.
1014		Based on fix from Neil Rickert of Northern Illinois
1015		University.
1016	Prevent multiple deliveries of a message with a "non-local alias"
1017		pointing to a local user, if canonicalization fails
1018		the message was requeued *and* delivered to the alias.
1019	If an invalid ruleset is declared, the ruleset name could be
1020		ignored and its rules added to S0.  Instead, ignore the
1021		ruleset lines as well.
1022	Avoid incorrect Final-Recipient, Action, and X-Actual-Recipient
1023		success DSN fields as well as duplicate entries for a
1024		single address due to S5 and UserDB processing.  Problems
1025		noted by Kari Hurtta of the Finnish Meteorological
1026		Institute.
1027	Turn off timeouts when exiting sendmail due to an interrupt signal
1028		to prevent the timeout from firing during the exit process.
1029		Problem noted by Michael Shapiro of Sun Microsystems.
1030	Do not append @MyHostName to non-RFC822 addresses output by the EXPN
1031		command or on Final-Recipient: and X-Actual-Recipient: DSN
1032		headers.  Non-RFC822 addresses include deliveries to
1033		programs, file, DECnet, etc.
1034	Fix logic for determining if a local user is using -f or -bs to
1035		spoof their return address.  Based on idea from Neil Rickert
1036		of Northern Illinois University and patch from Per Hedeland
1037		of Ericsson.
1038	Report the proper UID in the bounce message if an :include: file is
1039		owned by a uid that doesn't map to a username and the
1040		:include: file contains delivery to a file or program.
1041		Problem noted by John Beck of Sun Microsystems.
1042	Avoid the attempt of trying to send a second SMTP QUIT command if
1043		the remote server responds to the first QUIT with a 4xx
1044		response code and drops the connection.  This behavior was
1045		noted by Ulrich Windl of the Universitat Regensburg when
1046		sendmail was talking to the Mercury 1.43 MTA.
1047	If a hostname lookup times out and ServiceSwitchFile is set but the
1048		file is not present, the lookup failure would be marked as
1049		a permanent failure instead of a temporary failure.  Fix
1050		from Russell King of the ARM Linux Project.
1051	Handle aliases or forwards which deliver to programs using tabs
1052		instead of spaces between arguments.  Problem noted by Randy
1053		Wormser.  Fix from Neil Rickert of Northern Illinois
1054		University.
1055	Allow MaxRecipientsPerMessage option to be set on the command line
1056		by normal users (e.g., sendmail won't drop its root
1057		privileges) to allow overrides for message submission via
1058		'sendmail -bs'.
1059	Set the names for help file and statistics file to "helpfile" and
1060		"statistics", respectively, if no parameters are given for
1061		them in the .cf file.
1062	Avoid bogus 'errbody: I/O Error -7' log messages when sending
1063		success DSN messages for messages relayed to non-DSN aware
1064		systems.  Problem noted by Juergen Georgi of RUS University
1065		of Stuttgart and Kyle Tucker of Parexel International.
1066	Prevent +detail information from interfering with local delivery to
1067		multiple users in the same transaction (F=m).
1068	Add H_FORCE flag for the X-Authentication-Warning: header, so it
1069		will be added even if one already exists.  Problem noted
1070		by Michal Zalewski of Marchew Industries.
1071	Stop processing SMTP commands if the SMTP connection is dropped.
1072		This prevents a remote system from flooding the connection
1073		with commands and then disconnecting.  Previously, the
1074		server would process all of the buffered commands.  Problem
1075		noted by Michal Zalewski of Marchew Industries.
1076	Properly process user-supplied headers beginning with '?'.  Problem
1077		noted by Michal Zalewski of Marchew Industries.
1078	If multiple header checks resolve to the $#error mailer, use the
1079		last permanent (5XX) failure if any exist.  Otherwise, use
1080		the last temporary (4XX) failure.
1081	RFC 1891 requires "hexchar" in a "xtext" to be upper case.  Patch
1082		from Ronald F. Guilmette of Infinite Monkeys & Co.
1083	Timeout.ident now defaults to 5 seconds instead of 30 seconds to
1084		prevent the now common delays associated with mailing to a
1085		site which drops IDENT packets.  Suggested by many.
1086	Persistent host status data is not reloaded disk when current data
1087		is available in the in-memory cache.  Problem noted by Per
1088		Hedeland of Ericsson.
1089	mailq displays unprintable characters in addresses as their octal
1090		representation and a leading backslash.  This avoids problems
1091		with "unprintable" characters.  Problem noted by Michal
1092		Zalewski of the "Internet for Schools" project (IdS).
1093	The mail line length limit (L= equate) was adding the '!' indicator
1094		one character past the limit.  This would cause subsequent
1095		hops to break the line again.  The '!' is now placed in
1096		the last column of the limit if the line needs to be broken.
1097		Problem noted by Joe Pruett of Q7 Enterprises.  Based on fix
1098		from Per Hedeland of Ericsson.
1099	If a resolver ANY query is larger than the UDP packet size, the
1100		resolver will fall back to TCP.  However, some
1101		misconfigured firewalls black 53/TCP so the ANY lookup
1102		fails whereas an MX or A record might succeed.  Therefore,
1103		don't fail on ANY queries.
1104	If an SMTP recipient is rejected due to syntax errors in the
1105		address, do not send an empty postmaster notification DSN
1106		to the postmaster.  Problem noted by Neil Rickert of
1107		Northern Illinois University.
1108	Allow '_' and '.' in map names when parsing a sequence map
1109		specification.  Patch from William Setzer of North Carolina
1110		State University.
1111	Fix hostname in logging of read timeouts for the QUIT command on
1112		cached connections.  Problem noted by Neil Rickert of
1113		Northern Illinois University.
1114	Use a more descriptive entry to log "null" connections, i.e.,
1115		"host did not issue MAIL/EXPN/VRFY/ETRN during connection".
1116	Fix a file descriptor leak in ONEX mode.
1117	Portability:
1118		Reverse signal handling logic such that sigaction(2) with
1119			the SA_RESTART flag is the preferred method and the
1120			other signal methods are only tried if SA_RESTART
1121			is not available.  Problem noted by Allan E
1122			Johannesen of Worcester Polytechnic Institute.
1123		AIX 4.x supports the sa_len member of struct sockaddr.
1124			This allows network interface probing to work
1125			properly.  Fix from David Bronder of the
1126			University of Iowa.
1127		AIX 4.3 has snprintf() support.
1128		Use "PPC" as the architecture name when building under
1129			AIX.  This will be reflected in the obj.* directory
1130			name.
1131		Apple Darwin support based on Apple Rhapsody port.
1132		Fixed AIX 'make depend' method from Valdis Kletnieks of
1133			Virginia Tech.
1134		Digital UNIX has uname(2).
1135		GNU Hurd updates from Mark Kettenis of the University of
1136			Amsterdam.
1137		Improved HPUX 11.0 portability.
1138		Properly determine the number of CPUs on FreeBSD 2.X,
1139			FreeBSD 3.X, HP/UX 10.X and HP/UX 11.X.
1140		Remove special IRIX ABI cases from Build script and the OS
1141			files.  Use the standard 'cc' options used by SGI
1142			in building the operating system.  Users can
1143			override the defaults by setting confCC and
1144			confLIBSEARCHPATH appropriately.
1145		IRIX nsd map support from Bob Mende of SGI.
1146		Minor devtools fixes for IRIX from Bob Mende of SGI.
1147		Linux patch for IP_SRCROUTE support from Joerg Dorchain
1148			of MW EDV & ELECTRONIC.
1149		Linux now uses /usr/sbin for confEBINDIR in the build
1150			system.  From MATSUURA Takanori of Osaka University.
1151		Remove special treatment for Linux PPC in the build
1152			system.  From MATSUURA Takanori of Osaka University.
1153		Motorolla UNIX SYSTEM V/88 Release 4.0 support from
1154			Sergey Rusanov of the Republic of Udmurtia.
1155		NCR MP-RAS 3.x includes regular expression support.  From
1156			Tom J. Moore of NCR.
1157		NEC EWS-UX/V series settings for _PATH_VENDOR_CF and
1158			_PATH_SENDMAILPID from Oota Toshiya of
1159			NEC Computers Group Planning Division.
1160		Minor NetBSD owner/group tweaks from Ayamura Kikuchi, M.D.
1161		NEWS-OS 6.X listed SYSLOG_BUFSIZE as 256 in confENVDEF and
1162			1024 in conf.h.  Since confENVDEF would be used,
1163			use that value in conf.h.
1164		Use NeXT's NETINFO to get domain name.  From Gerd Knops of
1165			BITart Consulting.
1166		Use NeXT's NETINFO for alias and hostname resolution if
1167			AUTO_NETINFO_ALIASES and AUTO_NETINFO_HOSTS are
1168			defined.  Patch from Wilfredo Sanchez of Apple
1169			Computer, Inc.
1170		NeXT portability tweaks.  Problems reported by Dragan
1171			Milicic of the University of Utah and J. P. McCann
1172			of E I A.
1173		New compile flag FAST_PID_RECYCLE: set this if your system
1174			can reuse the same PID in the same second.
1175		New compile flag HASFCHOWN: set this if your OS has
1176			fchown(2).
1177		New compile flag HASRANDOM: set this to 0 if your OS does
1178			not have random(3).  rand() will be used instead.
1179		New compile flag HASSRANDOMDEV: set this if your OS has
1180			srandomdev(3).
1181		New compile flag HASSETLOGIN: set this if your OS has
1182			setlogin(2).
1183		Replace SINIX and ReliantUNIX support with version
1184			specific SINIX files.  From Gerald Rinske of
1185			Siemens Business Services.
1186		Use the 60-second load average instead of the 5 second load
1187			average on Compaq Tru64 UNIX (formerly Digital
1188			UNIX).  From Chris Teakle of the University of Qld.
1189		Use ANSI C by default for Compaq Tru64 UNIX.  Suggested by
1190			Randall Winchester of Swales Aerospace.
1191		Correct setgroups() prototype for Compaq Tru64 UNIX.
1192			Problem noted by Randall Winchester of Swales
1193			Aerospace.
1194		Hitachi 3050R/3050RX and 3500 Workstations running
1195			HI-UX/WE2 4.02, 6.10 and 7.10 from Motonori
1196			NAKAMURA of Kyoto University.
1197		New compile flag NO_GETSERVBYNAME: set this to disable
1198			use of getservbyname() on systems which can
1199			not lookup a service by name over NIS, such as
1200			HI-UX.  Patch from Motonori NAKAMURA of Kyoto
1201			University.
1202		Use devtools/bin/install.sh on SCO 5.x.  Problem noted
1203			by Sun Wenbing of the China Engineering and
1204			Technology Information Network.
1205		make depend didn't work properly on UNIXWARE 4.2.  Problem
1206			noted by Ariel Malik of Netology, Ltd.
1207		Use /usr/lbin as confEBINDIR for Compaq Tru64 (Digital UNIX).
1208		Set confSTDIO_TYPE to torek for BSD-OS, FreeBSD, NetBSD,
1209			and OpenBSD.
1210		A recent Compaq Ultrix 4.5 Y2K patch has broken detection
1211			of local_hostname_length().  See sendmail/README
1212			for more details.  Problem noted by Allan E
1213			Johannesen of Worcester Polytechnic Institute.
1214	CONFIG: Begin using /etc/mail/ for sendmail related files.  This
1215		affects a large number of files.  See cf/README for more
1216		details.
1217	CONFIG: New macro MAIL_SETTINGS_DIR contains the path (including
1218		trailing slash) for the mail settings directory.
1219	CONFIG: Increment version number of config file to 9.
1220	CONFIG: OSTYPE(`bsdi1.0') and OSTYPE(`bsdi2.0') have been
1221		deprecated and may be removed from a future release.
1222		BSD/OS users should begin using OSTYPE(`bsdi').
1223	CONFIG: OpenBSD 2.4 installs mail.local non-setuid root.  This
1224		requires a new OSTYPE(`openbsd').  From Todd C. Miller of
1225		Courtesan Consulting.
1226	CONFIG: New OSTYPE(`hpux11') for HP/UX 11.X.
1227	CONFIG: A syntax error in check_mail would cause fake top-level
1228		domains (.BITNET, .DECNET, .FAX, .USENET, and .UUCP) to
1229		be improperly rejected as unresolvable.
1230	CONFIG: New FEATURE(`dnsbl') takes up to two arguments (name of
1231		DNS server, rejection message) and can be included
1232		multiple times.
1233	CONFIG: New FEATURE(`relay_mail_from') allows relaying if the
1234		mail sender is listed as RELAY in the access map (and tagged
1235		with From:).
1236	CONFIG: Optional tagging of LHS in the access map (Connect:,
1237		From:, To:) to enable finer control.
1238	CONFIG: New FEATURE(`ldap_routing') implements LDAP address
1239		routing.  See cf/README for a complete description of the
1240		new functionality.
1241	CONFIG: New variables for the new sendmail options:
1242		confAUTH_MECHANISMS		AuthMechanisms
1243		confAUTH_OPTIONS		AuthOptions
1244		confCLIENT_OPTIONS		ClientPortOptions
1245		confCONTROL_SOCKET_NAME		ControlSocketName
1246		confDEAD_LETTER_DROP		DeadLetterDrop
1247		confDEF_AUTH_INFO		DefaultAuthInfo
1248		confDF_BUFFER_SIZE		DataFileBufferSize
1249		confLDAP_DEFAULT_SPEC		LDAPDefaultSpec
1250		confMAX_ALIAS_RECURSION		MaxAliasRecursion
1251		confMAX_HEADERS_LENGTH		MaxHeadersLength
1252		confMAX_MIME_HEADER_LENGTH	MaxMimeHeaderLength
1253		confPID_FILE			PidFile
1254		confPROCESS_TITLE_PREFIX	ProcessTitlePrefix
1255		confRRT_IMPLIES_DSN		RrtImpliesDsn
1256		confTO_CONTROL			Timeout.control
1257		confTO_RESOLVER_RETRANS		Timeout.resolver.retrans
1258		confTO_RESOLVER_RETRANS_FIRST	Timeout.resolver.retrans.first
1259		confTO_RESOLVER_RETRANS_NORMAL	Timeout.resolver.retrans.normal
1260		confTO_RESOLVER_RETRY		Timeout.resolver.retry
1261		confTO_RESOLVER_RETRY_FIRST	Timeout.resolver.retry.first
1262		confTO_RESOLVER_RETRY_NORMAL	Timeout.resolver.retry.normal
1263		confTRUSTED_USER		TrustedUser
1264		confXF_BUFFER_SIZE		XscriptFileBufferSize
1265	CONFIG: confDAEMON_OPTIONS has been replaced by DAEMON_OPTIONS(),
1266		which takes the options as argument and can be used
1267		multiple times; see cf/README for details.
1268	CONFIG: Add a fifth mailer definition to MAILER(`smtp') called
1269		"dsmtp".  This mail provides on-demand delivery using the
1270		F=% mailer flag described above.  The "dsmtp" mailer
1271		definition uses the new DSMTP_MAILER_ARGS which defaults
1272		to "IPC $h".
1273	CONFIG: New variables LOCAL_MAILER_MAXMSGS, SMTP_MAILER_MAXMSGS,
1274		and RELAY_MAILER_MAXMSGS for setting the m= equate for the
1275		local, smtp, and relay mailers respectively.
1276	CONFIG: New variable LOCAL_MAILER_DSN_DIAGNOSTIC_CODE for setting
1277		the DSN Diagnostic-Code type for the local mailer.  The
1278		value should be changed with care.
1279	CONFIG: FEATURE(`local_lmtp') now sets the DSN Diagnostic-Code type
1280		for the local mailer to the proper value of "SMTP".
1281	CONFIG: All included maps are no longer optional by default; if
1282		there there is a problem with a map, sendmail will
1283		complain.
1284	CONFIG: Removed root from class E; use EXPOSED_USER(`root')
1285		to get the old behavior.  Suggested by Joe Pruett
1286		of Q7 Enterprises.
1287	CONFIG: MASQUERADE_EXCEPTION() defines hosts/subdomains which
1288		will not be masqueraded.  Proposed by Arne Wichmann
1289		of MPI Saarbruecken, Griff Miller of PGS Tensor,
1290		Jayme Cox of Broderbund Software Inc.
1291	CONFIG: A list of exceptions for FEATURE(`nocanonify') can be
1292		specified by CANONIFY_DOMAIN or CANONIFY_DOMAIN_FILE,
1293		i.e., a list of domains which are passed to $[ ... $]
1294		for canonification. Based on an idea from Neil Rickert
1295		of Northern Illinois University.
1296	CONFIG: If `canonify_hosts' is specified as parameter for
1297		FEATURE(`nocanonify') then addresses which have only
1298		a hostname, e.g., <user@host>, will be canonified.
1299	CONFIG: If FEATURE(`nocanonify') is turned on, a trailing dot is
1300		nevertheless added to addresses with more than one component
1301		in it.
1302	CONFIG: Canonification is no longer attempted for any host or domain
1303		in class 'P' ($=P).
1304	CONFIG: New class for matching virtusertable entries $={VirtHost} that
1305		can be populated by VIRTUSER_DOMAIN or VIRTUSER_DOMAIN_FILE.
1306		FEATURE(`virtuser_entire_domain') can be used to apply this
1307		class also to entire subdomains.  Hosts in this class are
1308		treated as canonical in SCanonify2, i.e., a trailing dot
1309		is added.
1310	CONFIG: If VIRTUSER_DOMAIN() or VIRTUSER_DOMAIN_FILE() are used,
1311		include $={VirtHost} in $=R (hosts allowed to relay).
1312	CONFIG: FEATURE(`generics_entire_domain') can be used to apply the
1313		genericstable also to subdomains of $=G.
1314	CONFIG: Pass "+detail" as %2 for virtusertable lookups.
1315		Patch from Noam Freedman from University of Chicago.
1316	CONFIG: Pass "+detail" as %1 for genericstable lookups.  Suggested
1317		by Raymond S Brand of rsbx.net.
1318	CONFIG: Allow @domain in genericstable to override masquerading.
1319		Suggested by Owen Duffy from Owen Duffy & Associates.
1320	CONFIG: LOCAL_DOMAIN() adds entries to class w.  Suggested by Steve
1321		Hubert of University of Washington.
1322	CONFIG: OSTYPE(`gnuhurd') has been replaced by OSTYPE(`gnu') as
1323		GNU is now the canonical system name.  From Mark
1324		Kettenis of the University of Amsterdam.
1325	CONFIG: OSTYPE(`unixware7') updates from Larry Rosenman.
1326	CONFIG: Do not include '=' in option expansion if there is no value
1327		associated with the option.  From Andrew Brown of
1328		Graffiti World Wide, Inc.
1329	CONFIG: Add MAILER(`qpage') to define a new pager mailer.  Contributed
1330		by Philip A. Prindeville of Enteka Enterprise Technology
1331		Services.
1332	CONFIG: MAILER(`cyrus') was not preserving case for mail folder
1333		names.  Problem noted by Randall Winchester of Swales
1334		Aerospace.
1335	CONFIG: RELAY_MAILER_FLAGS can be used to define additional flags
1336		for the relay mailer.  Suggested by Doug Hughes of Auburn
1337		University and Brian Candler.
1338	CONFIG: LOCAL_MAILER_FLAGS now includes 'P' (Add Return-Path:
1339		header) by default.  Suggested by Per Hedeland of Ericsson.
1340	CONFIG: Use SMART_HOST for bracketed addresses, e.g., user@[host].
1341		Suggested by Kari Hurtta of the Finnish Meteorological
1342		Institute.
1343	CONFIG: New macro MODIFY_MAILER_FLAGS to tweak *_MAILER_FLAGS;
1344		i.e., to set, add, or delete flags.
1345	CONFIG: If SMTP AUTH is used then relaying is allowed for any user
1346		who authenticated via a "trusted" mechanism, i.e., one that
1347		is defined via TRUST_AUTH_MECH(`list of mechanisms').
1348	CONFIG: FEATURE(`delay_checks') delays check_mail and check_relay
1349		after check_rcpt and allows for exceptions from the checks.
1350	CONFIG: Map declarations have been moved into their associated
1351		feature files to allow greater flexibility in use of
1352		sequence maps.  Suggested by Per Hedeland of Ericsson.
1353	CONFIG: New macro LOCAL_MAILER_EOL to override the default end of
1354		line string for the local mailer.  Requested by Il Oh of
1355		Willamette Industries, Inc.
1356	CONFIG: Route addresses are stripped, i.e., <@a,@b,@c:user@d> is
1357		converted to <user@d>
1358	CONFIG: Reject bogus return address of <@@hostname>, generated by
1359		Sun's older, broken configuration files.
1360	CONFIG: FEATURE(`nullclient') now provides the full rulesets of a
1361		normal configuration, allowing anti-spam checks to be
1362		performed.
1363	CONFIG: Don't return a permanent error (Relaying denied) if
1364		${client_name} can't be resolved just temporarily.
1365		Suggested by Kari Hurtta of the Finnish Meteorological
1366		Institute.
1367	CONFIG: Change numbered rulesets into named (which still can
1368		be accessed by their numbers).
1369	CONFIG: FEATURE(`nouucp') takes one parameter: reject or nospecial
1370		which describes whether to disallow "!" in the local part
1371		of an address.
1372	CONFIG: Call Local_localaddr from localaddr (S5) which can be used
1373		to rewrite an address from a mailer which has the F=5 flag
1374		set.  If the ruleset returns a mailer, the appropriate
1375		action is taken, otherwise the returned tokens are ignored.
1376	CONFIG: cf/ostype/solaris.m4 has been renamed to solaris2.pre5.m4
1377		and cf/ostype/solaris2.m4 is now a copy of solaris2.ml.m4.
1378		The latter is kept around for backward compatibility.
1379	CONFIG: Allow ":D.S.N:" for mailer/virtusertable "error:" entries,
1380		where "D.S.N" is an RFC 1893 compliant error code.
1381	CONFIG: Use /usr/lbin as confEBINDIR for Compaq Tru64 (Digital UNIX).
1382	CONFIG: Remove second space between username and date in UNIX From_
1383		line.  Noted by Allan E Johannesen of Worcester Polytechnic
1384		Institute.
1385	CONFIG: Make sure all of the mailers have complete T= equates.
1386	CONFIG: Extend FEATURE(`local_procmail') so it can now take
1387		arguments overriding the mailer program, arguments, and
1388		mailer definition flags.  This makes it possible to use
1389		other programs such as maildrop for local delivery.
1390	CONFIG: Emit warning if FEATURE(`local_lmtp') or
1391		FEATURE(`local_procmail') is given after MAILER(`local').
1392		Patch from Richard A. Nelson of IBM.
1393	CONFIG: Add SMTP Authentication information to Received: header
1394		default value (confRECEIVED_HEADER).
1395	CONFIG: Remove `l' flag from USENET_MAILER_FLAGS as it is not a
1396		local mailer.  Problem noted by Per Hedeland of Ericsson.
1397	CONTRIB: Added bounce-resender.pl from Brian R. Gaeke of the
1398		University of California at Berkeley.
1399	CONTRIB: Added domainmap.m4 from Mark D. Roth of the University of
1400		Illinois at Urbana-Champaign.
1401	CONTRIB: etrn.pl now recognizes bogus host names.  Patch from
1402		Bruce Barnett of GE's R&D Lab.
1403	CONTRIB: Patches for re-mqueue.pl by Graeme Hewson of Oracle
1404		Corporation UK.
1405	CONTRIB: Added qtool.pl to assist in managing the queues.
1406	DEVTOOLS: Prevent user environment variables from interfering with
1407		the Build scripts.  Problem noted by Ezequiel H. Panepucci of
1408		Yale University.
1409	DEVTOOLS: 'Build -M' will display the obj.* directory which will
1410		be used for building.
1411	DEVTOOLS: 'Build -A' will display the architecture that would be
1412		used for a fresh build.
1413	DEVTOOLS: New variable confRANLIB, set automatically by configure.sh.
1414	DEVTOOLS: New variable confRANLIBOPTS for the options to send to
1415		ranlib.
1416	DEVTOOLS: 'Build -O <path>' will have the object files build in
1417		<path>/obj.*.  Suggested by Bryan Costales of Exactis.
1418	DEVTOOLS: New variable confNO_MAN_BUILD which will prevent the
1419		building of the man pages when defined.  Suggested by Bryan
1420		Costales.
1421	DEVTOOLS: New variables confNO_HELPFILE_INSTALL and
1422		confNO_STATISTICS_INSTALL which will prevent the
1423		installation of the sendmail helpfile and statistics file
1424		respectively.  Suggested by Bryan Costales.
1425	DEVTOOLS: Recognize ReliantUNIX as SINIX.  Patch from Gerald Rinske
1426		of Siemens Business Services.
1427	DEVTOOLS: New variable confSTDIO_TYPE which defines the type of
1428		stdio library.  The new buffered file I/O depends on the
1429		Torek stdio library.  This option can be either portable or
1430		torek.
1431	DEVTOOLS: New variables confSRCADD and confSMSRCADD which
1432		correspond to confOBJADD and confSMOBJADD respectively.
1433		They should contain the C source files for the object files
1434		listed in confOBJADD and confSMOBJADD.  These file names
1435		will be passed to the 'make depend' stage of compilation.
1436	DEVTOOLS: New program specific variables for each of the programs
1437		in the sendmail distribution.  Each has the form
1438		`conf_prog_ENVDEF', for example, `conf_sendmail_ENVDEF'.
1439		The new variables are conf_prog_ENVDEF, conf_prog_LIBS,
1440		conf_prog_SRCADD, and conf_prog_OBJADD.
1441	DEVTOOLS: Build system redesign.  This should have little affect on
1442		building the distribution, but documentation on the changes
1443		are in devtools/README.
1444	DEVTOOLS: Don't allow 'Build -f file' if an object directory already
1445		exists.  Suggested by Valdis Kletnieks of Virginia Tech.
1446	DEVTOOLS: Rename confSRCDIR to confSMSRCDIR since it only identifies
1447		the path to the sendmail source directory.  confSRCDIR is a
1448		new variable which identifies the root of the source
1449		directories for all of the programs in the distribution.
1450	DEVTOOLS: confSRCDIR and confSMSRCDIR are now determined at Build
1451		time.  They can both still be overridden by setting the m4
1452		macro.
1453	DEVTOOLS: confSBINGRP now defaults to bin instead of kmem.
1454	DEVTOOLS: 'Build -Q prefix' uses devtools/Site/prefix.*.m4 for
1455		build configurations, and places objects in obj.prefix.*/.
1456		Complains as 'Build -f file' does for existing object
1457		directories.  Suggested by Tom Smith of Digital Equipment
1458		Corporation.
1459	DEVTOOLS: Setting confINSTALL_RAWMAN will install unformatted
1460		manual pages in the directory tree specified by
1461		confMANROOTMAN.
1462	DEVTOOLS: If formatting the manual pages fails, copy in the
1463		preformatted pages from the distribution.  The new variable
1464		confCOPY specifies the copying program.
1465	DEVTOOLS: Defining confFORCE_RMAIL will install rmail without
1466		question.  Suggested by Terry Lambert of Whistle
1467		Communications.
1468	DEVTOOLS: confSTFILE and confHFFILE can be used to change the names
1469		of the installed statistics and help files, respectively.
1470	DEVTOOLS: Remove spaces in `uname -r` output when determining
1471		operating system identity.  Problem noted by Erik
1472		Wachtenheim of Dartmouth College.
1473	DEVTOOLS: New variable confLIBSEARCHPATH to specify the paths that
1474		will be search for the libraries specified in confLIBSEARCH.
1475		Defaults to "/lib /usr/lib /usr/shlib".
1476	DEVTOOLS: New variables confSTRIP and confSTRIPOPTS for specifying
1477		how to strip binaries.  These are used by the new
1478		install-strip target.
1479	DEVTOOLS: New config file site.post.m4 which is included after
1480		the others (if it exists).
1481	DEVTOOLS: Change order of LIBS: first product specific libraries
1482		then the default ones.
1483	MAIL.LOCAL: Will not be installed setuid root.  To use mail.local
1484		as local delivery agent without LMTP mode, use
1485		MODIFY_MAILER_FLAGS(`LOCAL', `+S')
1486		to set the S flag.
1487	MAIL.LOCAL: Do not reject addresses which would otherwise be
1488		accepted by sendmail.  Suggested by Neil Rickert of
1489		Northern Illinois University.
1490	MAIL.LOCAL: New -7 option which causes LMTP mode not to advertise
1491		8BITMIME in the LHLO response.  Suggested by Kari Hurtta of
1492		the Finnish Meteorological Institute.
1493	MAIL.LOCAL: Add support for the maillock() routines by defining
1494		MAILLOCK when compiling.  Also requires linking with
1495		-lmail.  Patch from Neil Rickert of Northern Illinois
1496		University.
1497	MAIL.LOCAL: Create a Content-Length: header if CONTENTLENGTH is
1498		defined when compiling.  Automatically set for Solaris 2.3
1499		and later.  Patch from Neil Rickert of Northern Illinois
1500		University.
1501	MAIL.LOCAL: Move the initialization of the 'notifybiff' address
1502		structure to the beginning of the program.  This ensures that
1503		the getservbyname() is done before any seteuid to a possibly
1504		unauthenticated user.  If you are using NIS+ and secure RPC
1505		on a Solaris system, this avoids syslog messages such as,
1506		"authdes_refresh: keyserv(1m) is unable to encrypt session
1507		key."  Patch from Neil Rickert of Northern Illinois
1508		University.
1509	MAIL.LOCAL: Support group writable mail spool files when MAILGID is
1510		set to the gid to use (-DMAILGID=6) when compiling.
1511		Patch from Neil Rickert of Northern Illinois University.
1512	MAIL.LOCAL: When a mail message included lines longer than 2046
1513		characters (in LMTP mode), mail.local split the incoming
1514		line up into 2046-character output lines (excluding the
1515		newline).  If an input line was 2047 characters long
1516		(excluding CR-LF) and the last character was a '.',
1517		mail.local saw it as the end of input, transfered it to the
1518		user mailbox and tried to write an `ok' back to sendmail.
1519		If the message was much longer, both sendmail and
1520		mail.local would deadlock waiting for each other to read
1521		what they have written.  Problem noted by Peter Jeremy of
1522		Alcatel Australia Limited.
1523	MAIL.LOCAL: New option -b to return a permanent error instead of a
1524		temporary error if a mailbox exceeds quota.  Suggested by
1525		Neil Rickert of Northern Illinois University.
1526	MAIL.LOCAL: The creation of a lockfile is subject to a global
1527		timeout to avoid starvation.
1528	MAIL.LOCAL: Properly parse addresses with multiple quoted
1529		local-parts.  Problem noted by Ronald F. Guilmette of
1530		Infinite Monkeys & Co.
1531	MAIL.LOCAL: NCR MP/RAS 3.X portability from Tom J. Moore of NCR.
1532	MAILSTATS: New -p option to invoke program mode in which stats are
1533		printed in a machine readable fashion and the stats file
1534		is reset.  Patch from Kevin Hildebrand of the University
1535		of Maryland.
1536	MAKEMAP: If running as root, automatically change the ownership of
1537		generated maps to the TrustedUser as specified in the
1538		sendmail configuration file.
1539	MAKEMAP: New -C option to accept an alternate sendmail
1540		configuration file to use for finding the TrustedUser
1541		option.
1542	MAKEMAP: New -u option to dump (unmap) a database.  Based on
1543		code contributed by Roy Mongiovi of Georgia Tech.
1544	MAKEMAP: New -e option to allow empty values.  Suggested by Philip
1545		A. Prindeville of Enteka Enterprise Technology Services.
1546	MAKEMAP: Compile cleanly on 64-bit operating systems.  Problem
1547		noted by Gerald Rinske of Siemens Business Services.
1548	OP.ME: Correctly document interaction between F=S and U= mailer
1549		equates.  Problem noted by Bob Halley of Internet Engines.
1550	OP.ME: Fixup Timeout documentation.  From Graeme Hewson of Oracle
1551		Corporation UK.
1552	OP.ME: The Timeout [r] option was incorrectly listed as "safe"
1553		(e.g., sendmail would not drop root privileges if the
1554		option was specified on the command line).  Problem noted
1555		by Todd C. Miller of Courtesan Consulting.
1556	PRALIASES: Handle the hash and btree map specifications for
1557		Berkeley DB.  Patch from Brian J. Coan of the
1558		Institute for Global Communications.
1559	PRALIASES: Read the sendmail.cf file for the location(s) of the
1560		alias file(s) if the -f option is not used.  Patch from
1561		John Beck of Sun Microsystems.
1562	PRALIASES: New -C option to specify an alternate sendmail
1563		configuration file to use for finding alias file(s).  Patch
1564		from John Beck of Sun Microsystems.
1565	SMRSH: allow shell commands echo, exec, and exit.  Allow command
1566		lists using || and &&.  Based on patch from Brian J. Coan
1567		of the Institute for Global Communications.
1568	SMRSH: Update README for the new Build system.  From Tim Pierce
1569		of RootsWeb Genealogical Data Cooperative.
1570	VACATION: Added vacation auto-responder to sendmail distribution.
1571	LIBSMDB: Added abstracted database library.  Works with Berkeley
1572		DB 1.85, Berkeley DB 2.X, Berkeley DB 3.X, and NDBM.
1573	Changed Files:
1574		The Build script in the various program subdirectories are
1575			no longer symbolic links.  They are now scripts
1576			which execute the actual Build script in
1577			devtools/bin.
1578		All the manual pages are now written against -man and not
1579			-mandoc as they were previously.
1580		Add a simple Makefile to every directory so make instead
1581			of Build will work (unless parameters are
1582			required for Build).
1583	New Directories:
1584		devtools/M4/UNIX
1585		include
1586		libmilter
1587		libsmdb
1588		libsmutil
1589		vacation
1590	Renamed Directories:
1591		BuildTools => devtools
1592		src => sendmail
1593	Deleted Files:
1594		cf/m4/nullrelay.m4
1595		devtools/OS/Linux.ppc
1596		devtools/OS/ReliantUNIX
1597		devtools/OS/SINIX
1598		sendmail/ldap_map.h
1599	New Files:
1600		INSTALL
1601		PGPKEYS
1602		cf/cf/generic-linux.cf
1603		cf/cf/generic-linux.mc
1604		cf/feature/delay_checks.m4
1605		cf/feature/dnsbl.m4
1606		cf/feature/generics_entire_domain.m4
1607		cf/feature/no_default_msa.m4
1608		cf/feature/relay_mail_from.m4
1609		cf/feature/virtuser_entire_domain.m4
1610		cf/mailer/qpage.m4
1611		cf/ostype/bsdi.m4
1612		cf/ostype/hpux11.m4
1613		cf/ostype/openbsd.m4
1614		contrib/bounce-resender.pl
1615		contrib/domainmap.m4
1616		contrib/qtool.8
1617		contrib/qtool.pl
1618		devtools/M4/depend/AIX.m4
1619		devtools/M4/list.m4
1620		devtools/M4/string.m4
1621		devtools/M4/subst_ext.m4
1622		devtools/M4/switch.m4
1623		devtools/OS/Darwin
1624		devtools/OS/GNU
1625		devtools/OS/SINIX.5.43
1626		devtools/OS/SINIX.5.44
1627		devtools/OS/m88k
1628		devtools/bin/find_in_path.sh
1629		mail.local/Makefile
1630		mailstats/Makefile
1631		makemap/Makefile
1632		praliases/Makefile
1633		rmail/Makefile
1634		sendmail/Makefile
1635		sendmail/bf.h
1636		sendmail/bf_portable.c
1637		sendmail/bf_portable.h
1638		sendmail/bf_torek.c
1639		sendmail/bf_torek.h
1640		sendmail/shmticklib.c
1641		sendmail/statusd_shm.h
1642		sendmail/timers.c
1643		sendmail/timers.h
1644		smrsh/Makefile
1645		vacation/Makefile
1646	Renamed Files:
1647		cf/ostype/gnuhurd.m4 => cf/ostype/gnu.m4
1648		sendmail/cdefs.h => include/sendmail/cdefs.h
1649		sendmail/sendmail.hf => sendmail/helpfile
1650		sendmail/mailstats.h => include/sendmail/mailstats.h
1651		sendmail/pathnames.h => include/sendmail/pathnames.h
1652		sendmail/safefile.c => libsmutil/safefile.c
1653		sendmail/snprintf.c => libsmutil/snprintf.c
1654		sendmail/useful.h => include/sendmail/useful.h
1655		cf/ostype/solaris2.m4 => cf/ostype/solaris2.pre5.m4
1656	Copied Files:
1657		cf/ostype/solaris2.ml.m4 => cf/ostype/solaris2.m4
1658
16598.9.3/8.9.3	1999/02/04
1660	SECURITY: Limit message headers to a maximum of 32K bytes (total
1661		of all headers in a single message) to prevent a denial of
1662		service attack.  This limit will be configurable in 8.10.
1663		Problem noted by Michal Zalewski of the "Internet for
1664		Schools" project (IdS).
1665	Prevent segmentation fault on an LDAP lookup if the LDAP map
1666		was closed due to an earlier failure.  Problem noted by
1667		Jeff Wasilko of smoe.org.  Fix from Booker Bense of
1668		Stanford University and Per Hedeland of Ericsson.
1669	Preserve the order of the MIME headers in multipart messages
1670		when performing the MIME header length check.  This
1671		will allow PGP signatures to function properly.  Problem
1672		noted by Lars Hecking of University College, Cork, Ireland.
1673	If ruleset 5 rewrote the local address to an :include: directive,
1674		the delivery would fail with an "aliasing/forwarding loop
1675		broken" error.  Problem noted by Eric C Hagberg of Morgan
1676		Stanley.  Fix from Per Hedeland of Ericsson.
1677	Allow -T to work for bestmx maps.  Fix from Aaron Schrab of
1678		ExecPC Internet Systems.
1679	During the transfer of a message in an SMTP transaction, if a
1680		TCP timeout occurs, the message would be properly queued
1681		for later retry but the failure would be logged as
1682		"Illegal Seek" instead of a timeout.  Problem noted by
1683		Piotr Kucharski of the Warsaw School of Economics (SGH)
1684		and Carles Xavier Munyoz Baldo of CTV Internet.
1685	Prevent multiple deliveries on a self-referencing alias if the
1686		F=w mailer flag is not set.  Problem noted by Murray S.
1687		Kucherawy of Concentric Network Corporation and Per
1688		Hedeland of Ericsson.
1689	Do not strip empty headers but if there is no value and a
1690		default is defined in sendmail.cf, use the default.
1691		Problem noted by Philip Guenther of Gustavus Adolphus
1692		College and Christopher McCrory of Netus, Inc.
1693	Don't inherit information about the sender (notably the full name)
1694		in SMTP (-bs) mode, since this might be called from inetd.
1695	Accept any 3xx reply code in response to DATA command instead of
1696		requiring 354.  This change will match the wording to be
1697		published in the updated SMTP specification from the DRUMS
1698		group of the IETF.
1699	Portability:
1700		AIX 4.2.0 or 4.2.1 may become updated by the fileset
1701			bos.rte.net level 4.2.0.2.  This introduces the
1702			softlink /usr/lib/libbind.a which should
1703			not be used.  It conflicts with the resolver
1704			built into libc.a.  "bind" has been removed
1705			from the confLIBSEARCH BuildTools variable.
1706			Users who have installed BIND 8.X will have
1707			to add it back in their site.config.m4 file.
1708			Problem noted by Ole Holm Nielsen of the
1709			Technical University of Denmark.
1710		CRAY TS 10.0.x from Sven Nielsen of San Diego
1711			Supercomputer Center.
1712		Improved LDAP version 3 integration based on input
1713			from Kurt D. Zeilenga of the OpenLDAP Foundation,
1714			John Beck of Sun Microsystems, and Booker Bense
1715			of Stanford University.
1716		Linux doesn't have a standard way to get the timezone
1717			between different releases.  Back out the
1718			change in 8.9.2 and don't attempt to derive
1719			a timezone.  Problem reported by Igor S. Livshits
1720			of the University of Illinois at Urbana-Champaign
1721			and Michael Dickens of Tetranet Communications.
1722		Reliant UNIX, the new name for SINIX, from Gert-Jan Looy
1723			of Siemens/SNI.
1724		SunOS 5.8 from John Beck of Sun Microsystems.
1725	CONFIG: SCO UnixWare 2.1 and 7.0 need TZ to get the proper
1726		timezone.  Problem noted by Petr Lampa of Technical
1727		University of Brno.
1728	CONFIG: Handle <@bestmx-host:user@otherhost> addressing properly
1729		when using FEATURE(bestmx_is_local).  Patch from Neil W.
1730		Rickert of Northern Illinois University.
1731	CONFIG: Properly handle source routed and %-hack addresses on
1732		hosts which the mailertable remaps to local:.  Patch from
1733		Neil W. Rickert of Northern Illinois University.
1734	CONFIG: Internal fixup of mailertable local: map value.  Patch from
1735		Larry Parmelee of Cornell University.
1736	CONFIG: Only add back +detail from host portion of mailer triplet
1737		on local mailer triplets if it was originally +detail.
1738		Patch from Neil W. Rickert of Northern Illinois University.
1739	CONFIG: The bestmx_is_local checking done in check_rcpt would
1740		cause later checks to fail.  Patch from Paul J Murphy of
1741		MIDS Europe.
1742	New Files:
1743		BuildTools/OS/CRAYTS.10.0.x
1744		BuildTools/OS/ReliantUNIX
1745		BuildTools/OS/SunOS.5.8
1746
17478.9.2/8.9.2	1998/12/30
1748	SECURITY: Remove five second sleep on accepting daemon connections
1749		due to an accept() failure.  This sleep could be used
1750		for a denial of service attack.
1751	Do not silently ignore queue files with names which are too long.
1752		Patch from Bryan Costales of InfoBeat, Inc.
1753	Do not store failures closing an SMTP session in persistent
1754		host status.  Reported by Graeme Hewson of Oracle
1755		Corporation UK.
1756	Allow symbolic link forward files if they are in safe directories.
1757		Problem noted by Andreas Schott of the Max Planck Society.
1758	Missing columns in a text map could cause a segmentation fault.
1759		Fix from David Lee of the University of Durham.
1760	Note that for 8.9.X, PrivacyOptions=goaway also includes the
1761		noetrn flag.  This is scheduled to change in a future
1762		version of sendmail.  Problem noted by Theo Van Dinter of
1763		Chrysalis Symbolic Designa and Alan Brown of Manawatu
1764		Internet Services.
1765	When trying to do host canonification in a Wildcard MX
1766		environment, try an MX lookup of the hostname without the
1767		default domain appended.  Problem noted by Olaf Seibert of
1768		Polderland Language & Speech Technology.
1769	Reject SMTP RCPT To: commands with only comments (i.e.
1770		'RCPT TO: (comment)'.  Problem noted by Earle Ake of
1771		Hassler Communication Systems Technology, Inc.
1772	Handle any number of %s in the LDAP filter spec.  Patch from
1773		Per Hedeland of Ericsson.
1774	Clear ldapx open timeouts even if the map open failed to prevent
1775		a segmentation fault.  Patch from Wayne Knowles of the
1776		National Institute of Water & Atmospheric Research Ltd.
1777	Do not syslog envelope clone messages when using address
1778		verification (-bv).  Problem noted by Kari Hurtta of the
1779		Finnish Meteorological Institute.
1780	Continue to perform queue runs while in daemon mode even if the
1781		daemon is rejecting connections due to a disk full
1782		condition.  Problem noted by JR Oldroyd of TerraNet
1783		Internet Services.
1784	Include full filename on installation of the sendmail.hf file
1785		in case the $HFDIR directory does not exist.  Problem
1786		noted by Josef Svitak of Montana State University.
1787	Close all maps when exiting the process with one exception.
1788		Berkeley DB can use internal shared memory locking for
1789		its memory pool.  Closing a map opened by another process
1790		will interfere with the shared memory and locks of the
1791		parent process leaving things in a bad state.  For
1792		Berkeley DB, only close the map if the current process
1793		is also the one that opened the map, otherwise only close
1794		the map file descriptor.  Thanks to Yoseff Francus of
1795		Collective Technologies for volunteering his system for
1796		extended testing.
1797	Avoid null pointer dereference on XDEBUG output for SMTP reply
1798		failures.  Problem noted by Carlos Canau of EUnet Portugal.
1799	On mailq and hoststat listings being piped to another program, such
1800		as more, if the pipe closes (i.e., the user quits more),
1801		stop sending output and exit.  Patch from Allan E Johannesen
1802		of Worcester Polytechnic Institute.
1803	In accordance with the documentation, LDAP map lookup failures
1804		are now considered temporary failures instead of permanent
1805		failures unless the -t flag is used in the map definition.
1806		Problem noted by Booker Bense of Stanford University and
1807		Eric C. Hagberg of Morgan Stanley.
1808	Fix by one error reporting on long alias names.  Problem noted by
1809		H. Paul Hammann of the Missouri Research and Education
1810		Network.
1811	Fix DontBlameSendmail=IncludeFileInUnsafeDirPath behavior.  Problem
1812		noted by Barry S. Finkel of Argonne National Laboratory.
1813	When automatically converting from 8 bit to quoted printable MIME,
1814		be careful not to miss a multi-part boundary if that
1815		boundary is preceded by a boundary-like line.  Problem
1816		noted by Andreas Raschle of Ansid Inc.  Fix from
1817		Kari Hurtta of the Finnish Meteorological Institute.
1818	Avoid bogus reporting of "LMTP tobuf overflow" when the buffer
1819		has enough space for the additional address.  Problem
1820		noted by Steve Cliffe of the University of Wollongong.
1821	Fix DontBlameSendmail=FileDeliveryToSymlink behavior.  Problem
1822		noted by Alex Vorobiev of Swarthmore College.
1823	If the check_compat ruleset resolves to the $#discard mailer,
1824		discard the current recipient.  Unlike check_relay,
1825		check_mail, and check_rcpt, the entire envelope is not
1826		discarded.  Problem noted by RZ D. Rahlfs.  Fix from
1827		Claus Assmann of Christian-Albrechts-University of Kiel.
1828	Avoid segmentation fault when reading ServiceSwitchFile files with
1829		bogus formatting.  Patch from Kari Hurtta of the Finnish
1830		Meteorological Institute.
1831	Support Berkeley DB 2.6.4 API change.
1832	OP.ME: Pages weren't properly output on duplexed printers.  Fix
1833		from Matthew Black of CSU Long Beach.
1834	Portability:
1835		Apple Rhapsody from Wilfredo Sanchez of Apple Computer, Inc.
1836		Avoid a clash with IRIX 6.2 getopt.h and the UserDatabase
1837			option structure.  Problem noted by Ashley M.
1838			Kirchner of Photo Craft Laboratories, Inc.
1839		Break out IP address to hostname translation for
1840			reading network interface addresses into
1841			class 'w'.  Patch from John Kennedy of
1842			Cal State University, Chico.
1843		AIX 4.x use -qstrict with -O3 to prevent the optimized
1844			from changing the semantics of the compiled
1845			program.  From Simon Travaglia of the
1846			University of Waikato, New Zealand.
1847		FreeBSD 2.2.2 and later support setusercontext().  From
1848			Peter Wemm of DIALix.
1849		FreeBSD 3.x fix from Peter Wemm of DIALix.
1850		IRIX 5.x has a syslog buffer size of 512 bytes.  From
1851			Nao NINOMIYA of Utsunomiya University.
1852		IRIX 6.5 64-bit Build support.
1853		LDAP Version 3 support from John Beck and Ravi Iyer
1854			of Sun Microsystems.
1855		Linux does not implement seteuid() properly.  From
1856			John Kennedy of Cal State University, Chico.
1857		Linux timezone type was set improperly.  From Takeshi Itoh
1858			of Bits Co., Ltd.
1859		NCR MP-RAS 3.x needs -lresolv for confLIBS.  From
1860			Tom J. Moore of NCR.
1861		NeXT 4.x correction to man page path.  From J. P. McCann
1862			of E I A.
1863		System V Rel 5.x (a.k.a UnixWare7 w/o BSD-Compatibility Libs)
1864			from Paul Gampe of the Asia Pacific Network
1865			Information Center.
1866		ULTRIX now requires an optimization limit of 970 from
1867			Allan E Johannesen of Worcester Polytechnic
1868			Institute.
1869		Fix extern declaration for sm_dopr().  Fix from Henk
1870			van Oers of Algemeen Nederlands Persbureau.
1871	CONFIG: Catch @hostname,user@anotherhost.domain as relaying.
1872		Problem noted by Mark Rogov of AirMedia, Inc.  Fix from
1873		Claus Assmann of Christian-Albrechts-University of Kiel.
1874	CONFIG: Do not refer to http://maps.vix.com/ on RBL rejections as
1875		there are multiple RBL's available and the MAPS RBL may
1876		not be the one in use.  Suggested by Alan Brown of
1877		Manawatu Internet Services.
1878	CONFIG: Properly strip route addresses (i.e., @host1:user@host2)
1879		when stripping down a recipient address to check for
1880		relaying.  Patch from Claus Assmann of
1881		Christian-Albrechts-University of Kiel and Neil W Rickert
1882		of Northern Illinois University.
1883	CONFIG: Allow the access database to override RBL lookups.  Patch
1884		from Claus Assmann of Christian-Albrechts-University of
1885		Kiel.
1886	CONFIG: UnixWare 7 support from Phillip P. Porch of The Porch
1887		Dot Com.
1888	CONFIG: Fixed check for deferred delivery mode warning.  Patch
1889		from Claus Assmann of Christian-Albrechts-University of
1890		Kiel and Per Hedeland of Ericsson.
1891	CONFIG: If a recipient using % addressing is used, e.g.
1892		user%site@othersite, and othersite's MX records are now
1893		checked for local hosts if FEATURE(relay_based_on_MX) is
1894		used.  Problem noted by Alexander Litvin of Lucky Net Ltd.
1895		Patch from Alexander Litvin of Lucky Net Ltd and
1896		Claus Assmann of Christian-Albrechts-University of Kiel.
1897	MAIL.LOCAL: Prevent warning messages from appearing in the LMTP
1898		stream.  Do not allow more than one response per recipient.
1899	MAIL.LOCAL: Handle routed addresses properly when using LMTP.  Fix
1900		from John Beck of Sun Microsystems.
1901	MAIL.LOCAL: Properly check for CRLF when using LMTP.  Fix from
1902		John Beck of Sun Microsystems.
1903	MAIL.LOCAL: Substitute MAILER-DAEMON for the LMTP empty sender in
1904		the envelope From header.
1905	MAIL.LOCAL: Accept underscores in hostnames in LMTP mode.
1906		Problem noted by Glenn A. Malling of Syracuse University.
1907	MAILSTATS: Document msgsrej and msgsdis fields in the man page.
1908		Problem noted by Richard Wong of Princeton University.
1909	MAKEMAP: Build group list so group writable files are allowed with
1910		the -s flag.  Problem noted by Curt Sampson of Internet
1911		Portal Services, Inc.
1912	PRALIASES: Automatically handle alias files created without the
1913		NULL byte at the end of the key.  Patch from John Beck of
1914		Sun Microsystems.
1915	PRALIASES: Support Berkeley DB 2.6.4 API change.
1916	New Files:
1917		BuildTools/OS/IRIX64.6.5
1918		BuildTools/OS/UnixWare.5.i386
1919		cf/ostype/unixware7.m4
1920		contrib/smcontrol.pl
1921		src/control.c
1922
19238.9.1/8.9.1	1998/07/02
1924	If both an OS specific site configuration file and a generic
1925		site.config.m4 file existed, only the latter was used
1926		instead of both.  Problem noted by Geir Johannessen of
1927		the Norwegian University of Science and Technology.
1928	Fix segmentation fault while converting 8 bit to 7 bit MIME
1929		multipart messages by trying to write to an unopened
1930		file descriptor.  Fix from Kari Hurtta of the Finnish
1931		Meteorological Institute.
1932	Do not assume Message: and Text: headers indicate the end of
1933		the header area when parsing MIME headers.  Problem noted
1934		by Kari Hurtta of the Finnish Meteorological Institute.
1935	Setting the confMAN#SRC Build variable would only effect the
1936		installation commands.  The man pages would still be
1937		built with .0 extensions.  Problem noted by Bryan
1938		Costales of InfoBeat, Inc.
1939	Installation of manual pages didn't honor the DESTDIR environment
1940		variable.  Problem noted by Bryan Costales of InfoBeat, Inc.
1941	If the check_relay ruleset resolved to the discard mailer, messages
1942		were still delivered.  Problem noted by Mirek Luc of NASK.
1943	Mail delivery to files would fail with an Operating System Error
1944		if sendmail was not running as root, i.e., RunAsUser was set.
1945		Problem noted by Leonard N. Zubkoff of Dandelion Digital.
1946	Prevent MinQueueAge from interfering from queued items created
1947		in the future, i.e., if the system clock was set ahead
1948		and then back.  Problem noted by Michael Miller of the
1949		University of Natal, Pietermaritzburg.
1950	Do not advertise ETRN support in ESTMP EHLO reply if noetrn is
1951		set in the PrivacyOptions option.  Fix from Ted Rule of
1952		Flextech TV.
1953	Log invalid persistent host status file lines instead of
1954		bouncing the message.  Problem noted by David Lindes of
1955		DaveLtd Enterprises.
1956	Move creation of empty sendmail.st file from installation to
1957		compilation.  Installation may be done from a read-only
1958		mount.  Fix from Bryan Costales of InfoBeat, Inc. and Ric
1959		Anderson of the Oasis Research Center, Inc.
1960	Enforce the maximum number of User Database entries limit.  Problem
1961		noted by Gary Buchanan of Credence Systems Inc.
1962	Allow dead.letter files in root's home directory.  Problem noted
1963		by Anna Ullman of Sun Microsystems.
1964	Program deliveries in forward files could be marked unsafe if
1965		any directory listed in the ForwardPath option did not
1966		exist.  Problem noted by Jorg Bielak of Coastal Web Online.
1967	Do not trust the length of the address structure returned by
1968		gethostbyname().  Problem noted by Chris Evans of Oxford
1969		University.
1970	If the SIZE= MAIL From: ESMTP parameter is too large, use the
1971		5.3.4 DSN status code instead of 5.2.2.  Similarly, for
1972		non-local deliveries, if the message is larger than the
1973		mailer maximum message size, use 5.3.4 instead of 5.2.3.
1974		Suggested by Antony Bowesman of
1975		Fujitsu/TeaWARE Mail/MIME System.
1976	Portability:
1977		Fix the check for an IP address reverse lookup for
1978			use in $&{client_name} on 64 bit platforms.
1979			From Gilles Gallot of Institut for Development
1980			and Resources in Intensive Scientific computing.
1981		BSD-OS uses .0 for man page extensions.  From Jeff Polk
1982			of BSDI.
1983		DomainOS detection for Build.  Also, version 10.4 and later
1984			ship a unistd.h.  Fixes from Takanobu Ishimura of
1985			PICT Inc.
1986		NeXT 4.x uses /usr/lib/man/cat for its man pages.  From
1987			J. P. McCann of E I A.
1988		SCO 4.X and 5.X include NDBM support.  From Vlado Potisk
1989			of TEMPEST, Ltd.
1990	CONFIG: Do not pass spoofed PTR results through resolver for
1991		qualification.  Problem noted by Michiel Boland of
1992		Digital Valley Internet Professionals; fix from
1993		Kari Hurtta of the Finnish Meteorological Institute.
1994	CONFIG: Do not try to resolve non-DNS hostnames such as UUCP,
1995		BITNET, and DECNET addresses for resolvable senders.
1996		Problem noted by Alexander Litvin of Lucky Net Ltd.
1997	CONFIG: Work around Sun's broken configuration which sends bounce
1998		messages as coming from @@hostname instead of <>.  LMTP
1999		would not accept @@hostname.
2000	OP.ME: Corrections to complex sendmail startup script from Rick
2001		Troxel of the National Institutes of Health.
2002	RMAIL: Do not install rmail by default, require 'make force-install'
2003		as this rmail isn't the same as others.  Suggested by
2004		Kari Hurtta of the Finnish Meteorological Institute.
2005	New Files:
2006		BuildTools/OS/DomainOS.10.4
2007
20088.9.0/8.9.0	1998/05/19
2009	SECURITY: To prevent users from reading files not normally
2010		readable, sendmail will no longer open forward, :include:,
2011		class, ErrorHeader, or HelpFile files located in unsafe
2012		(i.e., group or world writable) directory paths.  Sites
2013		which need the ability to override security can use the
2014		DontBlameSendmail option.  See the README file for more
2015		information.
2016	SECURITY: Problems can occur on poorly managed systems, specifically,
2017		if maps or alias files are in world writable directories.
2018		This fixes the change added to 8.8.6 to prevent links in these
2019		world writable directories.
2020	SECURITY: Make sure ServiceSwitchFile option file is not a link if
2021		it is in a world writable directory.
2022	SECURITY: Never pass a tty to a mailer -- if a mailer can get at the
2023		tty it may be able to push bytes back to the senders input.
2024		Unfortunately this breaks -v mode.  Problem noted by
2025		Wietse Venema of the Global Security Analysis Lab at
2026		IBM T.J. Watson Research.
2027	SECURITY: Empty group list if DontInitGroups is set to true to
2028		prevent program deliveries from picking up extra group
2029		privileges.  Problem reported by Wolfgang Ley of DFN-CERT.
2030	SECURITY: The default value for DefaultUser is now set to the uid and
2031		gid of the first existing user mailnull, sendmail, or daemon
2032		that has a non-zero uid.  If none of these exist, sendmail
2033		reverts back to the old behavior of using uid 1 and gid 1.
2034		This is a security problem for Linux which has chosen that
2035		uid and gid for user bin instead of daemon.  If DefaultUser
2036		is set in the configuration file, that value overrides this
2037		default.
2038	SECURITY: Since 8.8.7, the check for non-setuid binaries
2039		interfered with setting an alternate group id for the
2040		RunAsUser option.  Problem noted by Randall Winchester of
2041		the University of Maryland.
2042	Add support for Berkeley DB 2.X.  Based on patch from John Kennedy
2043		of Cal State University, Chico.
2044	Remove support for OLD_NEWDB (pre-1.5 version of Berkeley DB).  Users
2045		which previously defined OLD_NEWDB=1 must now upgrade to the
2046		current version of Berkeley DB.
2047	Added support for regular expressions using the new map class regex.
2048		From Jan Krueger of Unix-AG of University of Hannover.
2049	Support for BIND 8.1.1's hesiod for hesiod maps and hesiod
2050		UserDatabases from Randall Winchester of the University
2051		of Maryland.
2052	Allow any shell for user shell on program deliveries on V1
2053		configurations for backwards compatibility on machines which
2054		do not have getusershell().  Fix from John Beck of Sun
2055		Microsystems.
2056	On operating systems which change the process title by reusing the
2057		argument vector memory, sendmail could corrupt memory if the
2058		last argument was either "-q" or "-d".  Problem noted by
2059		Frank Langbein of the University of Stuttgart.
2060	Support Local Mail Transfer Protocol (LMTP) between sendmail and
2061		mail.local on the F=z flag.
2062	Macro-expand the contents of the ErrMsgFile.  Previously this was
2063		only done if you had magic characters (0x81) to indicate
2064		macro expansion.  Now $x will be expanded.  This means that
2065		real dollar signs have to be backslash escaped.
2066	TCP Wrappers expects "unknown" in the hostname argument if the
2067		reverse DNS lookup for the incoming connection fails.
2068		Problem noted by Randy Grimshaw of Syracuse University and
2069		Wietse Venema of the Global Security Analysis Lab at
2070		IBM T.J. Watson Research.
2071	DSN success bounces generated from an invocation of sendmail -t
2072		would be sent to both the sender and MAILER-DAEMON.
2073		Problem noted by Claus Assmann of
2074		Christian-Albrechts-University of Kiel.
2075	Avoid "Error 0" messages on delivery mailers which exit with a
2076		valid exit value such as EX_NOPERM.  Fix from Andreas Luik
2077		of ISA Informationssysteme GmbH.
2078	Tokenize $&x expansions on right hand side of rules.  This eliminates
2079		the need to use tricks like $(dequote "" $&{client_name} $)
2080		to cause the ${client_name} macro to be properly tokenized.
2081	Add the MaxRecipientsPerMessage option: this limits the number of
2082		recipients that will be accepted in a single SMTP
2083		transaction.  After this number is reached, sendmail
2084		starts returning "452 Too many recipients" to all RCPT
2085		commands.  This can be used to limit the number of recipients
2086		per envelope (in particular, to discourage use of the server
2087		for spamming).  Note: a better approach is to restrict
2088		relaying entirely.
2089	Fixed pointer initialization for LDAP lmap struct, fixed -s option
2090		to ldapx map and added timeout for ldap_open call to
2091		avoid hanging sendmail in the event of hung LDAP servers.
2092		Patch from Booker Bense of Stanford University.
2093	Allow multiple -qI, -qR, or -qS queue run limiters.  For example,
2094		'-qRfoo -qRbar' would deliver mail to recipients with foo or
2095		bar in their address.  Patch from Allan E Johannesen of
2096		Worcester Polytechnic Institute.
2097	The bestmx map will now return a list of the MX servers for a host if
2098		passed a column delimiter via the -z map flag.  This can be
2099		used to check if the server is an MX server for the recipient
2100		of a message.  This can be used to help prevent relaying.
2101		Patch from Mitchell Blank Jr of Exec-PC.
2102	Mark failures for the *file* mailer and return bounce messages to the
2103		sender for those failures.
2104	Prevent bogus syslog timestamps on errors in sendmail.cf by
2105		preserving the TZ environment variable until TimeZoneSpec
2106		has been determined.  Problem noted by Ralf Hildebrandt of
2107		Technical University of Braunschweig.  Patch from Per Hedeland
2108		of Ericsson.
2109	Print test input in address test mode when input is not from the tty
2110		when the -v flag is given (i.e., sendmail -bt -v) to make
2111		output easier to decipher.  Problem noted by Aidan Nichol
2112		of Procter & Gamble.
2113	The LDAP map -s flag was not properly parsed and the error message
2114		given included the remainder of the arguments instead of
2115		solely the argument in error.  Problem noted by Aidan Nichol
2116		of Procter & Gamble.
2117	New DontBlameSendmail option.  This option allows administrators to
2118		bypass some of sendmail's file security checks at the expense
2119		of system security.  This should only be used if you are
2120		absolutely sure you know the consequences.  The available
2121		DontBlameSendmail options are:
2122			Safe
2123			AssumeSafeChown
2124			ClassFileInUnsafeDirPath
2125			ErrorHeaderInUnsafeDirPath
2126			GroupWritableDirPathSafe
2127			GroupWritableForwardFileSafe
2128			GroupWritableIncludeFileSafe
2129			GroupWritableAliasFile
2130			HelpFileinUnsafeDirPath
2131			WorldWritableAliasFile
2132			ForwardFileInGroupWritableDirPath
2133			IncludeFileInGroupWritableDirPath
2134			ForwardFileInUnsafeDirPath
2135			IncludeFileInUnsafeDirPath
2136			ForwardFileInUnsafeDirPathSafe
2137			IncludeFileInUnsafeDirPathSafe
2138			MapInUnsafeDirPath
2139			LinkedAliasFileInWritableDir
2140			LinkedClassFileInWritableDir
2141			LinkedForwardFileInWritableDir
2142			LinkedIncludeFileInWritableDir
2143			LinkedMapInWritableDir
2144			LinkedServiceSwitchFileInWritableDir
2145			FileDeliveryToHardLink
2146			FileDeliveryToSymLink
2147			WriteMapToHardLink
2148			WriteMapToSymLink
2149			WriteStatsToHardLink
2150			WriteStatsToSymLink
2151			RunProgramInUnsafeDirPath
2152			RunWritableProgram
2153	New DontProbeInterfaces option to turn off the inclusion of all the
2154		interface names in $=w on startup.  In particular, if you
2155		have lots of virtual interfaces, this option will speed up
2156		startup.  However, unless you make other arrangements, mail
2157		sent to those addresses will be bounced.
2158	Automatically create alias databases if they don't exist and
2159		AutoRebuildAliases is set.
2160	Add PrivacyOptions=noetrn flag to disable the SMTP ETRN command.
2161		Suggested by Christophe Wolfhugel of the Institut Pasteur.
2162	Add PrivacyOptions=noverb flag to disable the SMTP VERB command.
2163	When determining the client host name ($&{client_name} macro), do
2164		a forward (A) DNS lookup on the result of the PTR lookup
2165		and compare results.  If they differ or if the PTR lookup
2166		fails, &{client_name} will contain the IP address
2167		surrounded by square brackets (e.g., [127.0.0.1]).
2168	New map flag: -Tx appends "x" to lookups that return temporary failure
2169		(i.e, it is like -ax for the temporary failure case, in
2170		contrast to the success case).
2171	New syntax to do limited checking of header syntax.  A config line
2172		of the form:
2173			HHeader: $>Ruleset
2174		causes the indicated Ruleset to be invoked on the Header
2175		when read.  This ruleset works like the check_* rulesets --
2176		that is, it can reject mail on the basis of the contents.
2177	Limit the size of the HELO/EHLO parameter to prevent spammers
2178		from hiding their connection information in Received:
2179		headers.
2180	When SingleThreadDelivery is active, deliveries to locked hosts
2181		are skipped.  This will cause the delivering process to
2182		try the next MX host or queue the message if no other MX
2183		hosts are available.  Suggested by Alexander Litvin.
2184	The [FILE] mailer type now delivers to the file specified in the
2185		A= equate of the mailer definition instead of $u.  It also
2186		obeys all of the F= mailer flags such as the MIME
2187		7/8 bit conversion flags.  This is useful for defining
2188		a mailer which delivers to the same file regardless of the
2189		recipient (e.g., 'A=FILE /dev/null' to discard unwanted mail).
2190	Do not assume the identity of a remote connection is root@localhost
2191		if the remote connection closes the socket before the
2192		remote identity can be queried.
2193	Change semantics of the F=S mailer flag back to 8.7.5 behavior.
2194		Some mailers, including procmail, require that the real
2195		uid is left unchanged by sendmail.  Problem noted by Per
2196		Hedeland of Ericsson.
2197	No longer is the src/obj*/Makefile selected from a large list -- it
2198		is now generated using the information in BuildTools/OS/ --
2199		some of the details are determined dynamically via
2200		BuildTools/bin/configure.sh.
2201	The other programs in the sendmail distribution -- mail.local,
2202		mailstats, makemap, praliases, rmail, and smrsh -- now use
2203		the new Build method which creates an operating system
2204		specific Makefile using the information in BuildTools.
2205	Make 4xx reply codes to the SMTP MAIL command be non-sticky (i.e.,
2206		a failure on one message won't affect future messages to the
2207		same host).  This is necessary if the remote host sends
2208		a 451 error if the domain of the sender does not resolve
2209		as is common in anti-spam configurations.  Problem noted
2210		by Mitchell Blank Jr of Exec-PC.
2211	New "discard" mailer for check_* rulesets and header checking
2212		rulesets.  If one of the above rulesets resolves to the
2213		$#discard mailer, the commands will be accepted but the
2214		message will be completely discarded after it is accepting.
2215		This means that even if only one of the recipients
2216		resolves to the $#discard mailer, none of the recipients
2217		will receive the mail.  Suggested by Brian Kantor.
2218	All but the last cloned envelope of a split envelope were queued
2219		instead of being delivered.  Problem noted by John Caruso
2220		of CNET: The Computer Network.
2221	Fix deadlock situation in persistent host status file locking.
2222	Syslog an error if a user forward file could not be read due to
2223		an error.  Patch from John Beck of Sun Microsystems.
2224	Use the first name returned on machine lookups when canonifying a
2225		hostname via NetInfo.  Patch from Timm Wetzel of GWDG.
2226	Clear the $&{client_addr}, $&{client_name}, and $&{client_port}
2227		macros when delivering a bounce message to prevent
2228		rejection by a check_compat ruleset which uses these macros.
2229		Problem noted by Jens Hamisch of AgiX Internetservices GmbH.
2230	If the check_relay ruleset resolves to the the error mailer, the
2231		error in the $: portion of the resolved triplet is used
2232		in the rejection message given to the remote machine.
2233		Suggested by Scott Gifford of The Internet Ramp.
2234	Set the $&{client_addr}, $&{client_name}, and $&{client_port} macros
2235		before calling the check_relay ruleset.  Suggested by Scott
2236		Gifford of The Internet Ramp.
2237	Sendmail would get a segmentation fault if a mailer exited with an
2238		exit code of 79.  Problem noted by Aaron Schrab of ExecPC
2239		Internet.  Fix from Christophe Wolfhugel of the Pasteur
2240		Institute.
2241	Separate snprintf/vsnprintf routines into separate file for use by
2242		mail.local.
2243	Allow multiple map lookups on right hand side, e.g.,
2244		R$*	$( host $1 $) $| $( passwd $1 $).  Patch from
2245		Christophe Wolfhugel of the Pasteur Institute.
2246	Properly generate success DSN messages if requested for aliases
2247		which have owner- aliases.  Problem noted by Kari Hurtta
2248		of the Finnish Meteorological Institute.
2249	Properly display delayed-expansion macros ($&{macroname}) in
2250		address test mode (-bt).  Problem noted by Bryan Costales
2251		of InfoBeat, Inc.
2252	-qR could sometimes match names incorrectly.  Problem noted by
2253		Lutz Euler of Lavielle EDV Systemberatung GmbH & Co.
2254	Include a magic number and version in the StatusFile for the
2255		mailstats command.
2256	Record the number of rejected and discarded messages in the
2257		StatusFile for display by the mailstats command.  Patch
2258		from Randall Winchester of the University of Maryland.
2259	IDENT returns where the OSTYPE field equals "OTHER" now list the
2260		user portion as IDENT:username@site instead of
2261		username@site to differentiate the two.  Suggested by
2262		Kari Hurtta of the Finnish Meteorological Institute.
2263	Enforce timeout for LDAP queries.  Patch from Per Hedeland of
2264		Ericsson.
2265	Change persistent host status filename substitution so '/' is
2266		replaced by ':' instead of '|' to avoid clashes.  Also
2267		avoid clashes with hostnames with leading dots.  Fix from
2268		Mitchell Blank Jr. of Exec-PC.
2269	If the system lock table is full, only attempt to create a new
2270		queue entry five times before giving up.  Previously, it
2271		was attempted indefinitely which could cause the partition
2272		to run out of inodes.  Problem noted by Suzie Weigand of
2273		Stratus Computer, Inc.
2274	In verbose mode, warn if the sendmail.cf version is less than the
2275		currently supported version.
2276	Sorting for QueueSortOrder=host is now case insensitive.  Patch
2277		from Randall S. Winchester of the University of Maryland.
2278	Properly quote a full name passed via the -F command line option,
2279		the Full-Name: header, or the NAME environment variable if
2280		it contains characters which must be quoted.  Problem noted
2281		by Kari Hurtta of the Finnish Meteorological Institute.
2282	Avoid possible race condition that unlocked a mail job before
2283		releasing the transcript file on systems that use flock(2).
2284		In some cases, this might result in a "Transcript Unavailable"
2285		message in error bounces.
2286	Accept SMTP replies which contain only a reply code and no
2287		accompanying text.  Problem noted by Fernando Fraticelli of
2288		Digital Equipment Corporation.
2289	Portability:
2290		AIX 4.1 uses int for SOCKADDR_LEN_T from Motonori Nakamura
2291			of Kyoto University.
2292		AIX 4.2 requires <userpw.h> before <usersec.h>.  Patch from
2293			Randall S. Winchester of the University of
2294			Maryland.
2295		AIX 4.3 from Valdis Kletnieks of Virginia Tech CNS.
2296		CRAY T3E from Manu Mahonen of Center for Scientific Computing
2297			in Finland.
2298		Digital UNIX now uses statvfs for determining free
2299			disk space.  Patch from Randall S. Winchester of
2300			the University of Maryland.
2301		HP-UX 11.x from Richard Allen of Opin Kerfi HF and
2302			Regis McEwen of Progress Software Corporation.
2303		IRIX 64 bit fixes from Kari Hurtta of the Finnish
2304			Meteorological Institute.
2305		IRIX 6.2 configuration fix for mail.local from Michael Kyle
2306			of CIC/Advanced Computing Laboratory.
2307		IRIX 6.5 from Thomas H Jones II of SGI.
2308		IRIX 6.X load average code from Bob Mende of SGI.
2309		QNX from Glen McCready <glen@qnx.com>.
2310		SCO 4.2 and 5.x use /usr/bin instead of /usr/ucb for links
2311			to sendmail.  Install with group bin instead of kmem
2312			as kmem does not exist.  From Guillermo Freige of
2313			Gobernacion de la Pcia de Buenos Aires and Paul
2314			Fischer of BTG, Inc.
2315		SunOS 4.X does not include memmove().  Patch from
2316			Per Hedeland of Ericsson.
2317		SunOS 5.7 includes getloadavg() function for determining
2318			load average.  Patch from John Beck of Sun
2319			Microsystems.
2320	CONFIG: Increment version number of config file.
2321	CONFIG: add DATABASE_MAP_TYPE to set the default type of database
2322		map for the various maps.  The default is hash.  Patch from
2323		Robert Harker of Harker Systems.
2324	CONFIG: new confEBINDIR m4 variable for defining the executable
2325		directory for certain programs.
2326	CONFIG: new FEATURE(local_lmtp) to use the new LMTP support for
2327		local mail delivery.  By the default, /usr/libexec/mail.local
2328		is used.  This is expected to be the mail.local shipped
2329		with 8.9 which is LMTP capable.  The path is based on the
2330		new confEBINDIR m4 variable.
2331	CONFIG: Use confEBINDIR in determining path to smrsh for
2332		FEATURE(smrsh).  Note that this changes the default from
2333		/usr/local/etc/smrsh to /usr/libexec/smrsh.  To obtain the
2334		old path for smrsh, use FEATURE(smrsh, /usr/local/etc/smrsh).
2335	CONFIG: DOMAIN(generic) changes the default confFORWARD_PATH to
2336		include $z/.forward.$w+$h and $z/.forward+$h which allow
2337		the user to setup different .forward files for
2338		user+detail addressing.
2339	CONFIG: add confMAX_RCPTS_PER_MESSAGE, confDONT_PROBE_INTERFACES,
2340		and confDONT_BLAME_SENDMAIL to set MaxRecipientsPerMessage,
2341		DontProbeInterfaces, and DontBlameSendmail options.
2342	CONFIG: by default do not allow relaying (that is, accepting mail
2343		from outside your domain and sending it to another host
2344		outside your domain).
2345	CONFIG: new FEATURE(promiscuous_relay) to allow mail relaying from
2346		any site to any site.
2347	CONFIG: new FEATURE(relay_entire_domain) allows any host in your
2348		domain as defined by the 'm' class ($=m) to relay.
2349	CONFIG: new FEATURE(relay_based_on_MX) to allow relaying based on
2350		the MX records of the host portion of an incoming recipient.
2351	CONFIG: new FEATURE(access_db) which turns on the access database
2352		feature.  This database give you the ability to allow
2353		or refuse to accept mail from specified domains for
2354		administrative reasons.  By default, names that are listed
2355		as "OK" in the access db are domain names, not host names.
2356	CONFIG: new confCR_FILE m4 variable for defining the name of the file
2357		used for class 'R'.  Defaults to /etc/mail/relay-domains.
2358	CONFIG: new command RELAY_DOMAIN(domain) and RELAY_DOMAIN_FILE(file)
2359		to add items to class 'R' ($=R) for hosts allowed to relay.
2360	CONFIG: new FEATURE(relay_hosts_only) to change the behavior
2361		of FEATURE(access_db) and class 'R' to lookup individual
2362		host names only.
2363	CONFIG: new FEATURE(loose_relay_check).  Normally, if a recipient
2364		using % addressing is used, e.g.  user%site@othersite,
2365		and othersite is in class 'R', the check_rcpt ruleset
2366		will strip @othersite and recheck user@site for relaying.
2367		This feature changes that behavior.  It should not be
2368		needed for most installations.
2369	CONFIG: new FEATURE(relay_local_from) to allow relaying if the
2370		domain portion of the mail sender is a local host.  This
2371		should only be used if absolutely necessary as it opens
2372		a window for spammers.  Patch from Randall S. Winchester of
2373		the University of Maryland.
2374	CONFIG: new FEATURE(blacklist_recipients) turns on the ability to
2375		block incoming mail destined for certain recipient
2376		usernames, hostnames, or addresses.
2377	CONFIG: By default, MAIL FROM: commands in the SMTP session will be
2378		refused if the host part of the argument to MAIL FROM: cannot
2379		be located in the host name service (e.g., DNS).
2380	CONFIG: new FEATURE(accept_unresolvable_domains) accepts
2381		unresolvable hostnames in MAIL FROM: SMTP commands.
2382	CONFIG: new FEATURE(accept_unqualified_senders) accepts
2383		MAIL FROM: senders which do not include a domain.
2384	CONFIG: new FEATURE(rbl) Turns on rejection of hosts found in the
2385		Realtime Blackhole List.  You can specify the RBL name
2386		server to contact by specifying it as an optional argument.
2387		The default is rbl.maps.vix.com.  For details, see
2388		http://maps.vix.com/rbl/.
2389	CONFIG: Call Local_check_relay, Local_check_mail, and
2390		Local_check_rcpt from check_relay, check_mail, and
2391		check_rcpt.  Users with local rulesets should place the
2392		rules using LOCAL_RULESETS.  If a Local_check_* ruleset
2393		returns $#OK, the message is accepted.  If the ruleset
2394		returns a mailer, the appropriate action is taken, else
2395		the return of the ruleset is ignored.
2396	CONFIG: CYRUS_MAILER_FLAGS now includes the /:| mailer flags by
2397		default to support file, :include:, and program deliveries.
2398	CONFIG: Remove the default for confDEF_USER_ID so the binary can
2399		pick the proper default value.  See the SECURITY note
2400		above for more information.
2401	CONFIG: FEATURE(nodns) now warns the user that the feature is a
2402		no-op.  Patch from Kari Hurtta of the Finnish
2403		Meteorological Institute.
2404	CONFIG: OSTYPE(osf1) now sets DefaultUserID (confDEF_USER_ID) to
2405		daemon since DEC's /bin/mail will drop the envelope
2406		sender if run as mailnull.  See the Digital UNIX section
2407		of src/README for more information.  Problem noted by
2408		Kari Hurtta of the Finnish Meteorological Institute.
2409	CONFIG: .cf files are now stored in the same directory with the
2410		.mc files instead of in the obj directory.
2411	CONFIG: New options confSINGLE_LINE_FROM_HEADER,
2412		confALLOW_BOGUS_HELO, and confMUST_QUOTE_CHARS for
2413		setting SingleLineFromHeader, AllowBogusHELO, and
2414		MustQuoteChars respectively.
2415	MAIL.LOCAL: support -l flag to run LMTP on stdin/stdout.  This
2416		SMTP-like protocol allows detailed reporting of delivery
2417		status on a per-user basis.  Code donated by John Myers of
2418		CMU (now of Netscape).
2419	MAIL.LOCAL: HP-UX support from Randall S. Winchester of the
2420		University of Maryland.  NOTE: mail.local is not
2421		compatible with the stock HP-UX mail format.  Be sure to
2422		read mail.local/README.
2423	MAIL.LOCAL: Prevent other mail delivery agents from stealing a
2424		mailbox lock.  Patch from Randall S. Winchester of the
2425		University of Maryland.
2426	MAIL.LOCAL: glibc portability from John Kennedy of Cal State
2427		University, Chico.
2428	MAIL.LOCAL: IRIX portability from Kari Hurtta of the Finnish
2429		Meteorological Institute.
2430	MAILSTATS: Display the number of rejected and discarded messages
2431		in the StatusFile.  Patch from Randall Winchester of the
2432		University of Maryland.
2433	MAKEMAP: New -s flag to ignore safety checks on database map files
2434		such as linked files in world writable directories.
2435	MAKEMAP: Add support for Berkeley DB 2.X.  Remove OLD_NEWDB support.
2436	PRALIASES: Add support for Berkeley DB 2.X.
2437	PRALIASES: Do not automatically include NDBM support.  Problem
2438		noted by Ralf Hildebrandt of the Technical University of
2439		Braunschweig.
2440	RMAIL: Improve portability for other platforms.  Patches from
2441		Randall S. Winchester of the University of Maryland and
2442		Kari Hurtta of the Finnish Meteorological Institute.
2443	Changed Files:
2444		src/Makefiles/Makefile.* files have been modified to use
2445			the new build mechanism and are now BuildTools/OS/*.
2446		src/makesendmail changed to symbolic link to src/Build.
2447	New Files:
2448		BuildTools/M4/header.m4
2449		BuildTools/M4/depend/BSD.m4
2450		BuildTools/M4/depend/CC-M.m4
2451		BuildTools/M4/depend/NCR.m4
2452		BuildTools/M4/depend/Solaris.m4
2453		BuildTools/M4/depend/X11.m4
2454		BuildTools/M4/depend/generic.m4
2455		BuildTools/OS/AIX.4.2
2456		BuildTools/OS/AIX.4.x
2457		BuildTools/OS/CRAYT3E.2.0.x
2458		BuildTools/OS/HP-UX.11.x
2459		BuildTools/OS/IRIX.6.5
2460		BuildTools/OS/NEXTSTEP.4.x
2461		BuildTools/OS/NeXT.4.x
2462		BuildTools/OS/NetBSD.8.3
2463		BuildTools/OS/QNX
2464		BuildTools/OS/SunOS.5.7
2465		BuildTools/OS/dcosx.1.x.NILE
2466		BuildTools/README
2467		BuildTools/Site/README
2468		BuildTools/bin/Build
2469		BuildTools/bin/configure.sh
2470		BuildTools/bin/find_m4.sh
2471		BuildTools/bin/install.sh
2472		Makefile
2473		cf/cf/Build
2474		cf/cf/generic-hpux10.cf
2475		cf/feature/accept_unqualified_senders.m4
2476		cf/feature/accept_unresolvable_domains.m4
2477		cf/feature/access_db.m4
2478		cf/feature/blacklist_recipients.m4
2479		cf/feature/loose_relay_check.m4
2480		cf/feature/local_lmtp.m4
2481		cf/feature/promiscuous_relay.m4
2482		cf/feature/rbl.m4
2483		cf/feature/relay_based_on_MX.m4
2484		cf/feature/relay_entire_domain.m4
2485		cf/feature/relay_hosts_only.m4
2486		cf/feature/relay_local_from.m4
2487		cf/ostype/qnx.m4
2488		contrib/doublebounce.pl
2489		mail.local/Build
2490		mail.local/Makefile.m4
2491		mail.local/README
2492		mailstats/Build
2493		mailstats/Makefile.m4
2494		makemap/Build
2495		makemap/Makefile.m4
2496		praliases/Build
2497		praliases/Makefile.m4
2498		rmail/Build
2499		rmail/Makefile.m4
2500		rmail/rmail.0
2501		smrsh/Build
2502		smrsh/Makefile.m4
2503		src/Build
2504		src/Makefile.m4
2505		src/snprintf.c
2506	Deleted Files:
2507		cf/cf/Makefile (replaced by Makefile.dist)
2508		mail.local/Makefile
2509		mail.local/Makefile.dist
2510		mailstats/Makefile
2511		mailstats/Makefile.dist
2512		makemap/Makefile
2513		makemap/Makefile.dist
2514		praliases/Makefile
2515		praliases/Makefile.dist
2516		rmail/Makefile
2517		smrsh/Makefile
2518		smrsh/Makefile.dist
2519		src/Makefile
2520		src/Makefiles/Makefile.AIX.4 (split into AIX.4.x and AIX.4.2)
2521		src/Makefiles/Makefile.SMP_DC.OSx.NILE
2522			(renamed BuildTools/OS/dcosx.1.x.NILE)
2523		src/Makefiles/Makefile.Utah (obsolete platform)
2524	Renamed Files:
2525		READ_ME => README
2526		cf/cf/Makefile.dist => Makefile
2527		cf/cf/obj/* => cf/cf/*
2528		src/READ_ME => src/README
2529
25308.8.8/8.8.8	1997/10/24
2531	If the check_relay ruleset failed, the relay= field was logged
2532		incorrectly.  Problem noted by Kari Hurtta of the Finnish
2533		Meteorological Institute.
2534	If /usr/tmp/dead.letter already existed, sendmail could not
2535		add additional bounces to it.  Problem noted by Thomas J.
2536		Arseneault of SRI International.
2537	If an SMTP mailer used a non-standard port number for the outgoing
2538		connection, it would be displayed incorrectly in verbose mode.
2539		Problem noted by John Kennedy of Cal State University, Chico.
2540	Log the ETRN parameter specified by the client before altering them
2541		to internal form.  Suggested by Bob Kupiec of GES-Verio.
2542	EXPN and VRFY SMTP commands on malformed addresses were logging as
2543		User unknown with bogus delay= values.  Change them to log
2544		the same as compliant addresses.  Problem noted by Kari E.
2545		Hurtta of the Finnish Meteorological Institute.
2546	Ignore the debug resolver option unless using sendmail debug trace
2547		option for resolver.  Problem noted by Greg Nichols of Wind
2548		River Systems.
2549	If SingleThreadDelivery was enabled and the remote server returned a
2550		protocol error on the DATA command, the connection would be
2551		closed but the persistent host status file would not be
2552		unlocked so other sendmail processes could not deliver to
2553		that host.  Problem noted by Peter Wemm of DIALix.
2554	If queueing up a message due to an expensive mailer, don't increment
2555		the number of delivery attempts or set the last delivery
2556		attempt time so the message will be delivered on the next
2557		queue run regardless of MinQueueAge.  Problem noted by
2558		Brian J. Coan of the Institute for Global Communications.
2559	Authentication warnings of "Processed from queue _directory_" and
2560		"Processed by _username_ with -C _filename_" would be logged
2561		with the incorrect timestamp.  Problem noted by Kari E. Hurtta
2562		of the Finnish Meteorological Institute.
2563	Use a better heuristic for detecting GDBM.
2564	Log null connections on dropped connections.  Problem noted by
2565		Jon Lewis of Florida Digital Turnpike.
2566	If class dbm maps are rebuilt, sendmail will now detect this and
2567		reopen the map.  Previously, they could give stale
2568		results during a single message processing (but would
2569		recover when the next message was received).  Fix from
2570		Joe Pruett of Q7 Enterprises.
2571	Do not log failures such as "User unknown" on -bv or SMTP VRFY
2572		requests.  Problem noted by Kari E. Hurtta of the
2573		Finnish Meteorological Institute.
2574	Do not send a bounce message back to the sender regarding bad
2575		recipients if the SMTP connection is dropped before the
2576		message is accepted.  Problem noted by Kari E. Hurtta of the
2577		Finnish Meteorological Institute.
2578	Use "localhost" instead of "[UNIX: localhost]" when connecting to
2579		sendmail via a UNIX pipe.  This will allow rulesets using
2580		$&{client_name} to process without sending the string through
2581		dequote.  Problem noted by Alan Barrett of Internet Africa.
2582	A combination of deferred delivery mode, a double bounce situation,
2583		and the inability to save a bounce message to
2584		/var/tmp/dead.letter would cause sendmail to send a bounce
2585		to postmaster but not remove the offending envelope from the
2586		queue causing it to create a new bounce message each time the
2587		queue was run.  Problem noted by Brad Doctor of Net Daemons
2588		Associates.
2589	Remove newlines from hostname information returned via DNS.  There are
2590		no known security implications of newlines in hostnames as
2591		sendmail filters newlines in all vital areas; however, this
2592		could cause confusing error messages.
2593	Starting with sendmail 8.8.6, mail sent with the '-t' option would be
2594		rejected if any of the specified addresses were bad.  This
2595		behavior was modified to only reject the bad addresses and not
2596		the entire message.  Problem noted by Jozsef Hollosi of
2597		SuperNet, Inc.
2598	Use Timeout.fileopen when delivering mail to a file.  Suggested by
2599		Bryan Costales of InfoBeat, Inc.
2600	Display the proper Final-Recipient on DSN messages for non-SMTP
2601		mailers.  Problem noted by Kari E. Hurtta of the
2602		Finnish Meteorological Institute.
2603	An error in calculating the available space in the list of addresses
2604		for logging deliveries could cause an address to be silently
2605		dropped.
2606	Include the initial user environment if sendmail is restarted via
2607		a HUP signal.  This will give room for the process title.
2608		Problem noted by Jon Lewis of Florida Digital Turnpike.
2609	Mail could be delivered without a body if the machine does not
2610		support flock locking and runs out of processes during
2611		delivery.  Fix from Chuck Lever of the University of Michigan.
2612	Drop recipient address from 251 and 551 SMTP responses per RFC 821.
2613		Problem noted by Kari E. Hurtta of the Finnish Meteorological
2614		Institute.
2615	Make sure non-rebuildable database maps are opened before the
2616		rebuildable maps (i.e., alias files) in case the database maps
2617		are needed for verifying the left hand side of the aliases.
2618		Problem noted by Lloyd Parkes of Victoria University.
2619	Make sure sender RFC822 source route addresses are alias expanded for
2620		bounce messages.  Problem noted by Juergen Georgi of
2621		RUS University of Stuttgart.
2622	Minor lint fixes.
2623	Return a temporary error instead of a permanent error if an LDAP map
2624		search returns an error.  This will allow sequenced maps which
2625		use other LDAP servers to be checked.  Fix from Booker Bense
2626		of Stanford University.
2627	When automatically converting from quoted printable to 8bit text do
2628		not pad bare linefeeds with a space.  Problem noted by Theo
2629		Nolte of the University of Technology Aachen, Germany.
2630	Portability:
2631		Non-standard C compilers may have had a problem compiling
2632			conf.c due to a standard C external declaration of
2633			setproctitle().  Problem noted by Ted Roberts of
2634			Electronic Data Systems.
2635		AUX: has a broken O_EXCL implementation.  Reported by Jim
2636			Jagielski of jaguNET Access Services.
2637		BSD/OS: didn't compile if HASSETUSERCONTEXT was defined.
2638		Digital UNIX: Digital UNIX (and possibly others) moves
2639			loader environment variables into the loader memory
2640			area.  If one of these environment variables (such as
2641			LD_LIBRARY_PATH) was the last environment variable,
2642			an invalid memory address would be used by the process
2643			title routine causing memory corruption.  Problem
2644			noted by Sam Hartman of Mesa Internet Systems.
2645		GNU libc: uses an enum for _PC_CHOWN_RESTRICTED which caused
2646			chownsafe() to always return 0 even if the OS does
2647			not permit file giveaways.  Problem noted by
2648			Yasutaka Sumi of The University of Tokyo.
2649		IRIX6: Syslog buffer size set to 512 bytes.  Reported by
2650			Gerald Rinske of Siemens Business Services VAS.
2651		Linux: Pad process title with NULLs.  Problem noted by
2652			Jon Lewis of Florida Digital Turnpike.
2653		SCO OpenServer 5.0: SIOCGIFCONF ioctl call returns an
2654			incorrect value for the number of interfaces.
2655			Problem noted by Chris Loelke of JetStream Internet
2656			Services.
2657		SINIX: Update for Makefile and syslog buffer size from Gerald
2658			Rinske of Siemens Business Services VAS.
2659		Solaris: Make sure HASGETUSERSHELL setting for SunOS is not
2660			used on a Solaris machine.  Problem noted by
2661			Stephen Ma of Jtec Pty Limited.
2662		CONFIG: SINIX: Update from Gerald Rinske of Siemens Business
2663			Services VAS.
2664	MAKEMAP: Use a better heuristic for detecting GDBM.
2665	CONTRIB: expn.pl: Updated version from the author, David Muir Sharnoff.
2666	OP.ME: Document the F=i mailer flag.  Problem noted by Per Hedeland of
2667			Ericsson.
2668
26698.8.7/8.8.7	1997/08/03
2670	If using Berkeley DB on systems without O_EXLOCK (open a file with
2671		an exclusive lock already set -- i.e., almost all systems
2672		except 4.4-BSD derived systems), the initial attempt at
2673		rebuilding aliases file if the database didn't already
2674		exist would fail.  Patch from Raymund Will of LST Software
2675		GmbH.
2676	Bogus incoming SMTP commands would reset the SMTP conversation.
2677		Problem noted by Fredrik J�nsson of the Royal Institute
2678		of Technology, Stockholm.
2679	Since TCP Wrappers includes setenv(), unsetenv(), and putenv(),
2680		some environments could give "multiple definitions" for these
2681		routines during compilation.  If using TCP Wrappers, assume
2682		that these routines are included as though they were in the
2683		C library.  Patch from Robert La Ferla.
2684	When a NEWDB database map was rebuilt at the same time it was being
2685		used by a queue run, the maps could be left locked for the
2686		duration of the queue run, causing other processes to hang.
2687		Problem noted by Kendall Libby of Shore.NET.
2688	In some cases, NoRecipientAction=add-bcc was being ignored, so the
2689		mail was passed on without any recipient header.  This could
2690		cause problems downstream.  Problem noted by Xander Jansen
2691		of SURFnet ExpertiseCentrum.
2692	Give error when GDBM is used with sendmail.  GDBM's locking and
2693		linking of the .dir and .pag files interferes with sendmail's
2694		locking and security checks.  Problems noted by Fyodor
2695		Yarochkin of the Kyrgyz Republic FreeNet.
2696	Don't fsync qf files if SuperSafe option is not set.
2697	Avoid extra calls to gethostbyname for addresses for which a
2698		gethostbyaddr found no value.  Also, ignore any returns
2699		from gethostbyaddr that look like a dotted quad.
2700	If PTR lookup fails when looking up an SMTP peer, don't tag it as
2701		"may be forged", since at the network level we pretty much
2702		have to assume that the information is good.
2703	In some cases, errors during an SMTP session could leave files
2704		open or locked.
2705	Better handling of missing file descriptors (0, 1, 2) on startup.
2706	Better handling of non-setuid binaries -- avoids certain obnoxious
2707		errors during testing.
2708	Errors in file locking of NEWDB maps had the incorrect file name
2709		printed in the error message.
2710	If the AllowBogusHELO option were set and an EHLO with a bad or
2711		missing parameter were issued, the EHLO behaved like a HELO.
2712	Load limiting never kicked in for incoming SMTP transactions if the
2713		DeliveryMode=background and any recipient was an alias or
2714		had a .forward file.  From Nik Conwell of Boston University.
2715	On some non-Posix systems, the decision of whether chown(2) permits
2716		file giveaway was undefined.  From Tetsu Ushijima of the
2717		Tokyo Institute of Technology.
2718	Fix race condition that could cause the body of a message to be
2719		lost (so only the header was delivered).  This only occurs
2720		on systems that do not use flock(2), and only when a queue
2721		runner runs during a critical section in another message
2722		delivery.  Based on a patch from Steve Schweinhart of
2723		Results Computing.
2724	If a qf file was found in a mail queue directory that had a problem
2725		(wrong ownership, bad format, etc.) and the file name was
2726		exactly MAXQFNAME bytes long, then instead of being tried
2727		once, it would be tried on every queue run.  Problem noted
2728		by Bryan Costales of Mercury Mail.
2729	If the system supports an st_gen field in the status structure,
2730		include it when reporting that a file has changed after open.
2731		This adds a new compile flag, HAS_ST_GEN (0/1 option).
2732		This out to be checked as well as reported, since it is
2733		theoretically possible for an attacker to remove a file after
2734		it is opened and replace it with another file that has the
2735		same i-number, but some filesystems (notably AFS) return
2736		garbage in this field, and hence always look like the file
2737		has changed.  As a practical matter this is not a security
2738		problem, since the files can be neither hard nor soft links,
2739		and on no filesystem (that I am aware of) is it possible to
2740		have two files on the same filesystem with the same i-number
2741		simultaneously.
2742	Delete the root Makefile from the distribution -- it is only for
2743		use internally, and does not work at customer sites.
2744	Fix botch that caused the second MAIL FROM: command in a single
2745		transaction to clear the entire transaction.  Problem
2746		noted by John Kennedy of Cal State University, Chico.
2747	Work properly on machines that have _PATH_VARTMP defined without
2748		a trailing slash.  (And a pox on vendors that decide to
2749		ignore the established conventions!)  Problem noted by
2750		Gregory Neil Shapiro of WPI.
2751	Internal changes to make it easier to add another protocol family
2752		(intended for IPv6).  Patches are from John Kennedy of
2753		CSU Chico.
2754	In certain cases, 7->8 bit MIME decoding of Base64 text could leave
2755		an extra space at the beginning of some lines.  Problem
2756		noted by Charles Karney of Princeton University; fix based
2757		on a patch from Christophe Wolfhugel.
2758	Portability:
2759		Allow _PATH_VENDOR_CF to be set in Makefile for consistency
2760			with the _Sendmail_ book, 2nd edition.  Note that
2761			the book is actually wrong: _PATH_SENDMAILCF should
2762			be used instead.
2763		AIX 3.x: Include <sys/select.h>.  Patch from Gene Rackow
2764			of Argonne National Laboratory.
2765		OpenBSD from from Paul DuBois of the University of Wisconsin.
2766		RISC/os 4.0 from Paul DuBois of the University of Wisconsin.
2767		SunOS: Include <memory.h> to fix warning from util.c.  From
2768			James Aldridge of EUnet Ltd.
2769		Solaris: Change STDIR (location of status file) to /etc/mail
2770			in Makefiles.
2771		Linux, Dynix, UNICOS: Remove -DNDBM and -lgdbm from
2772			Makefiles.  Use NEWDB on Linux instead.
2773		NCR MP-RAS 3.x with STREAMware TCP/IP: SIOCGIFNUM ioctl
2774			exists but behaves differently than other OSes.
2775			Add SIOCGIFNUM_IS_BROKEN compile flag to get
2776			around the problem.  Problem noted by Tom Moore of
2777			NCR Corp.
2778		HP-UX 9.x: fix compile warnings for old select API.  Problem
2779			noted by Tom Smith of Digital Equipment Corp.
2780		UnixWare 2.x: compile warnings on offsetof macro.  Problem
2781			noted by Tom Good of the Community Access Information
2782			Resource Network
2783		SCO 4.2: compile problems caused by a change in the type of
2784			the "length" parameters passed to accept, getpeername,
2785			getsockname, and getsockopt.  Adds new compile flags
2786			SOCKADDR_SIZE_T and SOCKOPT_SIZE_T.  Problem reported
2787			by Tom Good of St. Vincent's North Richmond Community
2788			Mental Health Center Residential Services.
2789		AIX 4: Use size_t for SOCKADDR_SIZE_T and SOCKOPT_SIZE_T.
2790			Suggested by Brett Hogden of Rochester Gas & Electric
2791			Corp.
2792		Linux: avoid compile problem for versions of <setjmp.h> that
2793			#define both setjmp and longjmp.  Problem pointed out
2794			by J.R. Oldroyd of TerraNet.
2795		CONFIG: SCO UnixWare 2.1: Support for OSTYPE(sco-uw-2.1)
2796			from Christopher Durham of SCO.
2797		CONFIG: NEXTSTEP: define confCW_FILE to
2798			/etc/sendmail/sendmail.cw to match the usual
2799			configuration.  Patch from Dennis Glatting of
2800			PlainTalk.
2801	CONFIG: MAILER(fax) called a program that hasn't existed for a long
2802		time.  Convert to use the HylaFAX 4.0 conventions.  Suggested
2803		by Harry Styron.
2804	CONFIG: Improve sample anti-spam rulesets in cf/cf/knecht.mc.  These
2805		are the rulesets in use on sendmail.org.
2806	MAKEMAP: give error on GDBM files.
2807	MAIL.LOCAL: Make error messages a bit more explicit, for example,
2808		telling more details on what actually changed when "file
2809		changed after open".
2810	CONTRIB: etrn.pl: Ignore comments in Fw files.  Support multiple Fw
2811		files.
2812	CONTRIB: passwd-to-alias.pl: Handle 8 bit characters and '-'.
2813	NEW FILES:
2814		src/Makefiles/Makefile.OpenBSD
2815		src/Makefiles/Makefile.RISCos.4_0
2816		test/t_exclopen.c
2817		cf/ostype/sco-uw-2.1.m4
2818	DELETED FILES:
2819		Makefile
2820
28218.8.6/8.8.6	1997/06/14
2822	    *************************************************************
2823	    * The extensive assistance of Gregory Neil Shapiro of WPI	*
2824	    * in preparing this release is gratefully appreciated.	*
2825	    * Sun Microsystems has also provided resources toward	*
2826	    * continued sendmail development.				*
2827	    *************************************************************
2828	SECURITY: A few systems allow an open with the O_EXCL|O_CREAT open
2829		mode bits set to create a file that is a symbolic link that
2830		points nowhere.  This makes it possible to create a root
2831		owned file in an arbitrary directory by inserting the symlink
2832		into a writable directory after the initial lstat(2) check
2833		determined that the file did not exist.  The only verified
2834		example of a system having these odd semantics for O_EXCL
2835		and symbolic links was HP-UX prior to version 9.07.  Most
2836		systems do not have the problem, since a exclusive create
2837		of a file disallows symbolic links.  Systems that have been
2838		verified to NOT have the problem include AIX 3.x, *BSD,
2839		DEC OSF/1, HP-UX 9.07 and higher, Linux, SunOS, Solaris,
2840		and Ultrix.  This is a potential exposure on systems that
2841		have this bug and which do not have a MAILER-DAEMON alias
2842		pointing at a legitimate account, since this will cause old
2843		mail to be dropped in /var/tmp/dead.letter.
2844	SECURITY: Problems can occur on poorly managed systems, specifically,
2845		if maps or alias files are in world writable directories.
2846		If your system has alias maps in writable directories, it
2847		is potentially possible for an attacker to replace the .db
2848		(or .dir and .pag) files by symbolic links pointing at
2849		another database; this can be used either to expose
2850		information (e.g., by pointing an alias file at /etc/spwd.db
2851		and probing for accounts), or as a denial-of-service attack
2852		(by trashing the password database).  The fix disallows
2853		symbolic links entirely when rebuilding alias files or on
2854		maps that are in writable directories, and always warns on
2855		writable directories; 8.9 will probably consider writable
2856		directories to be fatal errors.  This does not represent an
2857		exposure on systems that have alias files in unwritable
2858		system directories.
2859	SECURITY: disallow .forward or :include: files that are links (hard
2860		or soft) if the parent directory (or any directory in the
2861		path) is writable by anyone other than the owner.  This is
2862		similar to the previous case for user files.  This change
2863		should not affect most systems, but is necessary to prevent
2864		an attacker who can write the directory from pointing such
2865		files at other files that are readable only by the owner.
2866	SECURITY: Tighten safechown rules: many systems will say that they
2867		have a safe (restricted to root) chown even on files that
2868		are mounted from another system that allows owners to give
2869		away files.  The new rules are very strict, trusting file
2870		ownership only in those few cases where the system has
2871		been verified to be at least as paranoid as necessary.
2872		However, it is possible to relax the rules to partially
2873		trust the ownership if the directory path is not world or
2874		group writable.  This might allow someone who has a legitimate
2875		:include: file (referenced directly from /etc/aliases) to
2876		become another non-root user if the :include: file is in a
2877		non-writable directory on an NFS-mounted filesystem where
2878		the local system says that giveaway is denied but it is
2879		actually permitted.  I believe this to be a very small set
2880		of cases.  If in doubt, do not point :include: aliases at
2881		NFS-mounted filesystems.
2882	SECURITY: When setting a numeric group id using the RunAsUser option
2883		(e.g., "O RunAsUser=10:20", the group id would not be set.
2884		Implicit group ids (e.g., "O RunAsUser=mailnull") or alpha
2885		group ids (e.g., "O RunAsUser=mailuser:mailgrp") worked fine.
2886		The user id was still set properly.  Problem noted by Uli
2887		Pralle of the Technical University of Berlin.
2888	Save the initial gid set for use when checking for if the
2889		PrivacyOptions=restrictmailq option is set.  Problem reported
2890		by Wolfgang Ley of DFN-CERT.
2891	Make 55x reply codes to the SMTP DATA-"." be non-sticky (i.e., a
2892		failure on one message won't affect future messages to the
2893		same host).
2894	IP source route printing had an "off by one" error that would
2895		affect any options that came after the route option.  Patch
2896		from Theo de Raadt.
2897	The "Message is too large" error didn't successfully bounce the error
2898		back to the sender.  Problem reported by Stephen More of
2899		PSI; patch from Gregory Neil Shapiro of WPI.
2900	Change SMTP status code 553 to map into Extended code 5.1.0 (instead
2901		of 5.1.3); it apparently gets used in multiple ways.
2902		Suggested by John Myers of Portola Communications.
2903	Fix possible extra null byte generated during collection if errors
2904		occur at the beginning of the stream.  Patch contributed by
2905		Andrey A. Chernov and Gregory Neil Shapiro.
2906	Code changes to avoid possible reentrant call of malloc/free within
2907		a signal handler.  Problem noted by John Beck of Sun
2908		Microsystems.
2909	Move map initialization to be earlier so that check_relay ruleset
2910		will have the latest version of the map data.  Problem noted
2911		by Paul Forgey of Metainfo; patch from Gregory Neil Shapiro.
2912	If there are fatal errors during the collection phase (e.g., message
2913		too large) don't send the bogus message.
2914	Avoid "cannot open xfAAA00000" messages when sending to aliases that
2915		have errors and have owner- aliases.  Problem noted by Michael
2916		Barber of MTU; fix from Gregory Neil Shapiro of WPI.
2917	Avoid null pointer dereference on illegal Boundary= parameters in
2918		multipart/mixed Content-Type: header.  Problem noted by
2919		Richard Muirden of RMIT University.
2920	Always print error messages during newaliases (-bi) even if the
2921		ErrorMode is not set to "print".  Fix from Gregory Neil
2922		Shapiro.
2923	Test mode could core dump if you did a /map lookup in an optional map
2924		that could not be opened.  Based on a fix from John Beck of
2925		Sun Microsystems.
2926	If DNS is misconfigured so that the last MX record tried points to
2927		a host that does not have an A record, but other MX records
2928		pointed to something reasonable, don't bounce the message
2929		with a "host unknown" error.  Note that this should really
2930		be fixed in the zone file for the domain.  Problem noted by
2931		Joe Rhett of Navigist, Inc.
2932	If a map fails (e.g., DNS times out) on all recipient addresses, mark
2933		the message as having been tried; otherwise the next queue
2934		run will not realize that this is a second attempt and will
2935		retry immediately.  Problem noted by Bryan Costales of
2936		Mercury Mail.
2937	If the clock is set backwards, and a MinQueueAge is set, no jobs
2938		will be run until the later setting of the clock is reached.
2939		"Problem" (I use the term loosely) noted by Eric Hagberg of
2940		Morgan Stanley.
2941	If the load average rises above the cutoff threshold (above which
2942		sendmail will not process the queue at all) during a queue
2943		run, abort the queue run immediately.  Problem noted by
2944		Bryan Costales of Mercury Mail.
2945	The variable queue processing algorithm (based on the message size,
2946		number of recipients, message precedence, and job age) was
2947		non-functional -- either the entire queue was processed or
2948		none of the queue was processed.  The updated algorithm
2949		does no queue run if a single recipient zero size job will
2950		not be run.
2951	If there is a fatal ("panic") message that will cause sendmail to
2952		die immediately, never hold the error message for future
2953		printing.
2954	Force ErrorMode=print in -bt mode so that all errors are printed
2955		regardless of the setting of the ErrorMode option in the
2956		configuration file.  Patch from Gregory Neil Shapiro.
2957	New compile flag HASSTRERROR says that this OS has the strerror(3)
2958		routine available in one of the libraries.  Use it in conf.h.
2959	The -m (match only) flag now works on host class maps.
2960	If class hash or btree maps are rebuilt, sendmail will now detect
2961		this and reopen the map.  Previously, they could give
2962		erroneous results during a single message processing
2963		(but would recover when the next message was received).
2964	Don't delete zero length queue files when doing queue runs until the
2965		files are at least ten minutes old.  This avoids a potential
2966		race condition: the creator creates the qf file, getting back
2967		a file descriptor.  The queue runner locks it and deletes it
2968		because it is zero length.  The creator then writes the
2969		descriptor that is now for a disconnected file, and the
2970		job goes away.  Based on a suggestion by Bryan Costales.
2971	When determining the "validated" host name ($_ macro), do a forward
2972		(A) DNS lookup on the result of the PTR lookup and compare
2973		results.  If they differ or if the PTR lookup fails, tag the
2974		address as "may be forged".
2975	Log null connections (i.e., hosts that connect but do not do any
2976		substantive activity on the connection before disconnecting;
2977		"substantive" is defined to be MAIL, EXPN, VRFY, or ETRN.
2978	Always permit "writes" to /dev/null regardless of the link count.
2979		This is safe because /dev/null is special cased, and no open
2980		or write is ever actually attempted.  Patch from Villy Kruse
2981		of TwinCom.
2982	If a message cannot be sent because of a 552 (exceeded storage
2983		allocation) response to the MAIL FROM:<>, and a SIZE= parameter
2984		was given, don't return the body in the bounce, since there
2985		is a very good chance that the message will double-bounce.
2986	Fix possible line truncation if a quoted-printable had an =00 escape
2987		in the body.  Problem noted by Charles Karney of the Princeton
2988		Plasma Physics Laboratory.
2989	Notify flags (e.g., -NSUCCESS) were lost on user+detail addresses.
2990		Problem noted by Kari Hurtta of the Finnish Meteorological
2991		Institute.
2992	The MaxDaemonChildren option wasn't applying to queue runs as
2993		documented.  Note that this increases the potential denial
2994		of service problems with this option: an attacker can
2995		connect many times, and thereby lock out queue runs as well
2996		as incoming connections.  If you use this option, you should
2997		run the "sendmail -bd" and "sendmail -q30m" jobs separately
2998		to avoid this attack.  Failure to limit noted by Matthew
2999		Dillon of BEST Internet Communications.
3000	Always give a message in newaliases if alias files cannot be
3001		opened instead of failing silently.  Suggested by Gregory
3002		Neil Shapiro.  This change makes the code match the O'Reilly
3003		book (2nd edition).
3004	Some older versions of the resolver could return with h_errno == -1
3005		if no name server could be reached, causing mail to bounce
3006		instead of queueing.  Treat this like TRY_AGAIN.  Fix from
3007		John Beck of SunSoft.
3008	If a :include: file is owned by a user that does not have an entry
3009		in the passwd file, sendmail could dereference a null pointer.
3010		Problem noted by Satish Mynam of Sun Microsystems.
3011	Take precautions to make sure that the SMTP protocol cannot get out
3012		of sync if (for example) an alias file cannot be opened.
3013	Fix a possible race condition that can cause a SIGALRM to come in
3014		immediately after a SIGHUP, causing the new sendmail to die.
3015	Avoid possible hang on SVr3 systems when doing child reaping.  Patch
3016		from Villy Kruse of TwinCom.
3017	Ignore improperly formatted SMTP reply codes.  Previously these were
3018		partially processed, which could cause confusing error
3019		returns.
3020	Fix possible bogus pointer dereference when doing ldapx map lookups
3021		on some architectures.
3022	Portability:
3023		A/UX: from Jim Jagielski of NASA/GSFC.
3024		glibc: SOCK_STREAM was changed from a #define to an enum,
3025			thus breaking #ifdef SOCK_STREAM.  Only option seems
3026			to be to assume SOCK_STREAM if __GNU_LIBRARY__ is
3027			defined.  Problem reported by A Sun of the University
3028			of Washington.
3029		Solaris: use SIOCGIFNUM to get the number of interfaces on
3030			the system rather than guessing at compile time.
3031			Patch contributed by John Beck of Sun Microsystems.
3032		Intel Paragon: from Wendy Lin of Purdue University.
3033		GNU Hurd: from Miles Bader of the GNU project.
3034		RISC/os 4.50 from Harlan Stenn of PFCS Corporation.
3035		ISC Unix: wait never returns if SIGCLD signals are blocked.
3036			Unfortunately releasing them opens a race condition,
3037			but there appears to be no fix for this.  Patch from
3038			Gregory Neil Shapiro.
3039		BIND 8.1 for IPv6 compatibility from John Kennedy.
3040		Solaris: a bug in strcasecmp caused characters with the
3041			high order bit set to apparently randomly match
3042			letters -- for example, $| (0233) matches "i" and "I".
3043			Problem noted by John Gregson of the University of
3044			Cambridge.
3045		IRIX 6.x: make Makefile.IRIX.6.2 apply to all 6.x.  From
3046			Kari Hurtta.
3047		IRIX 6.x: Create Makefiles for systems that claim to be
3048			IRIX64 but are 6.2 or higher (so use the regular
3049			IRIX Makefile).
3050		IRIX 6.x: Fix load average computation on 64 bit kernels.
3051			Problem noted by Eric Hagberg of Morgan Stanley.
3052	CONFIG: Some canonification was still done for UUCP-like addresses
3053		even if FEATURE(nocanonify) was set.  Problem pointed out by
3054		Brian Candler.
3055	CONFIG: In some cases UUCP mailers wouldn't properly recognize all
3056		local names as local.  Problem noted by Jeff Polk of BSDI;
3057		fix provided by Gregory Neil Shapiro.
3058	CONFIG: The "local:user" syntax entries in mailertables and other
3059		"mailer:user" syntax locations returned an incorrect value
3060		for the $h macro.  Problem noted by Gregory Neil Shapiro.
3061	CONFIG: Retain "+detail" information when forwarding mail to a
3062		MAIL_HUB, LUSER_RELAY, or LOCAL_RELAY.  Patch from Philip
3063		Guenther of Gustavus Adolphus College.
3064	CONFIG: Make sure user+detail works for FEATURE(virtusertable);
3065		rules are the same as for aliasing.  Based on a patch from
3066		Gregory Neil Shapiro.
3067	CONFIG: Break up parsing rules into several pieces; this should
3068		have no functional change in this release, but makes it
3069		possible to have better anti-spam rulesets in the future.
3070	CONFIG: Disallow double dots in host names to avoid having the
3071		HostStatusDirectory store status under the wrong name.
3072		In some cases this can be used as a denial-of-service attack.
3073		Problem noted by Ron Jarrell of Virginia Tech, patch from
3074		Gregory Neil Shapiro.
3075	CONFIG: Don't use F=m (multiple recipients per invocation) for
3076		MAILER(procmail), but do pass F=Pn9 (include Return-Path:,
3077		don't include From_, and convert to 8-bit).  Suggestions
3078		from Kimmo Suominen and Roderick Schertler.
3079	CONFIG: Domains under $=M (specified with MASQUERADE_DOMAIN) were
3080		being masqueraded as though FEATURE(masquerade_entire_domain)
3081		was specified, even when it wasn't.
3082	MAIL.LOCAL: Solaris 2.6 has snprintf.  From John Beck of SunSoft.
3083	MAIL.LOCAL: SECURITY: check to make sure that an attacker doesn't
3084		"slip in" a symbolic link between the lstat(2) call and the
3085		exclusive open.  This is only a problem on System V derived
3086		systems that allow an exclusive create on files that are
3087		symbolic links pointing nowhere.
3088	MAIL.LOCAL: If the final mailbox close() failed, the user id was
3089		not reset back to root, which on some systems would cause
3090		later mailboxes to fail.  Also, any partial message would
3091		not be truncated, which could result in repeated deliveries.
3092		Problem noted by Bruce Evans via Peter Wemm (FreeBSD
3093		developers).
3094	MAKEMAP: Handle cases where O_EXLOCK is #defined to be 0.  A similar
3095		change to the sendmail map code was made in 8.8.3.  Problem
3096		noted by Gregory Neil Shapiro.
3097	MAKEMAP: Give warnings on file problems such as map files that are
3098		symbolic links; although makemap is not setuid root, it is
3099		often run as root and hence has the potential for the same
3100		sorts of problems as alias rebuilds.
3101	MAKEMAP: Change compilation so that it will link properly on
3102		NEXTSTEP.
3103	CONTRIB: etrn.pl: search for Cw as well as Fw lines in sendmail.cf.
3104		Accept an optional list of arguments following the server
3105		name for the ETRN arguments to use (instead of $=w).  Other
3106		miscellaneous bug fixes.  From Christian von Roques via
3107		John Beck of Sun Microsystems.
3108	CONTRIB: Add passwd-to-alias.pl, contributed by Kari Hurtta.  This
3109		Perl script converts GECOS information in the /etc/passwd
3110		file into aliases, allowing for faster access to full name
3111		lookups; it is also clever about adding aliases (to root)
3112		for system accounts.
3113	NEW FILES:
3114		src/safefile.c
3115		cf/ostype/gnuhurd.m4
3116		cf/ostype/irix6.m4
3117		contrib/passwd-to-alias.pl
3118		src/Makefiles/Makefile.IRIX64.6.1
3119		src/Makefiles/Makefile.IRIX64.6.x
3120	RENAMED FILES:
3121		src/Makefiles/Makefile.IRIX.6.2 =>	Makefile.IRIX.6.x
3122		src/Makefiles/Makefile.IRIX64 =>	Makefile.IRIX64.6.0
3123
31248.8.5/8.8.5	1997/01/21
3125	SECURITY: Clear out group list during startup.  Without this, sendmail
3126		will continue to run with the group permissions of the caller,
3127		even if RunAsUser is specified.
3128	SECURITY: Make purgestat (-bH) be root-only.  This is not in response
3129		to any known attack, but it's best to be conservative.
3130		Suggested by Peter Wemm of DIALix.
3131	SECURITY: Fix buffer overrun problem in MIME code that has possible
3132		security implications.  Patch from Alex Garthwaite of the
3133		University of Pennsylvania.
3134	Use of a -f flag with a phrase attached (e.g., "-f 'Full Name <addr>'")
3135		would truncate the address after "Full".  Although the -f
3136		syntax is incorrect (since it is in the envelope, it
3137		shouldn't have comments and full names), the failure mode
3138		was unnecessarily awful.
3139	Fix a possible null pointer dereference when converting 8-bit data
3140		to a 7-bit format.  Problem noted by Jim Hutchins of
3141		Sandia National Labs and David James of British Telecom.
3142	Clear out stale state that affected F=9 on SMTP mailers in queue
3143		runs.  Although this really shouldn't be used (F=9 is for
3144		final delivery only, and using it on an SMTP mailer makes
3145		it possible for a message to be converted from 8->7->8->7
3146		bits several times), it shouldn't have failed with a syserr.
3147		Problem noted by Eric Hagberg of Morgan Stanley.
3148	_Really_ fix the multiple :maildrop code in the user database
3149		module.  Patch from Roy Mongiovi of Georgia Tech.
3150	Let F lines in the configuration file actually read root-only
3151		files if the configuration file is safe.  Based on a
3152		patch from Keith Reynolds of SCO.
3153	ETRN followed by QUIT would hold the connection open until the queue
3154		run completed.  Problem noted by Truck Lewis of TDK
3155		Semiconductor Corp.
3156	It turns out that despite the documentation, the TCP wrappers library
3157		does _not_ log rejected connections.  Do the logging ourselves.
3158		Problem noted by Fletcher Mattox of the University of Texas
3159		at Austin.
3160	If sendmail finds a qf file in its queue directory that is an unknown
3161		version (e.g., when backing out to an old version), the
3162		error is reported on every queue run.  Change it to only
3163		give the error once (and rename the qf => Qf).  Patch from
3164		William A. Gianopoulos of Raytheon Company.
3165	Start a new session when doing background delivery; currently it
3166		ignored signals but didn't start a new signal, that caused
3167		some problems if a background process tried to send mail
3168		under certain circumstances.  Problem noted by Eric Hagberg
3169		of Morgan Stanley; fix from Kari Hurtta.
3170	Simplify test for skipping a queue run to just check if the current
3171		load average is >= the queueing load average.  Previously
3172		the check factored in some other parameters that caused it
3173		to essentially never skip the queue run.  Patch from Bryan
3174		Costales.
3175	If the SMTP server is running in "nullserver" mode (that is, it is
3176		rejecting all commands), start sleeping after MAXBADCOMMAND
3177		(25) commands; this helps prevent a bad guy from putting
3178		you into a tight loop as a denial-of-service attack.  Based
3179		on an e-mail conversation with Brad Knowles of AOL.
3180	Slow down when too many "light weight" commands have been issued;
3181		this helps prevent a class of denial-of-service attacks.
3182		The current values and defaults are:
3183		    MAXNOOPCOMMANDS	20	NOOP, VERB, ONEX, XUSR
3184		    MAXHELOCOMMANDS	3	HELO, EHLO
3185		    MAXVRFYCOMMANDS	6	VRFY, EXPN
3186		    MAXETRNCOMMANDS	8	ETRN
3187		These will probably be configurable in a future release.
3188	On systems that have uid_t typedefed to be an unsigned short, programs
3189		that had the F=S flag and no U= equate would be invoked with
3190		the real uid set to 65535 rather than being left unchanged.
3191	In some cases, NOTIFY=NEVER was not being honored.  Problem noted
3192		by Steve Hubert of the University of Washington, Seattle.
3193	Mail that was Quoted-Printable encoded and had a soft line break on
3194		the last line (i.e., an incomplete continuation) had the last
3195		line dropped.  Since this appears to be illegal it isn't
3196		clear what to do with it, but flushing the last line seems
3197		to be a better "fail soft" approach.  Based on a patch from
3198		Eric Hagberg.
3199	If AllowBogusHELO and PrivacyOptions=needmailhelo are both set, a
3200		bogus HELO command still causes the "Polite people say HELO
3201		first" error message.  Problem pointed out by Chris Thomas
3202		of UCLA; patch from John Beck of SunSoft.
3203	Handle "sendmail -bp -qSfoobar" properly if restrictqrun is set
3204		 in PrivacyOptions.  The -q shouldn't turn this command off.
3205		 Problem noted by Murray Kucherawy of Pacific Bell Internet;
3206		 based on a patch from Gregory Neil Shapiro of WPI.
3207	Don't consider SMTP reply codes 452 or 552 (exceeded storage allocation)
3208		in a DATA transaction to be sticky; these can occur because
3209		a message is too large, and smaller messages should still go
3210		through.  Problem noted by Matt Dillon of Best Internet
3211		Communications.
3212	In some cases bounces were saved in /var/tmp/dead.letter even if they
3213		had been successfully delivered to the envelope sender.
3214		Problem noted Eric Hagberg of Morgan Stanley; solution from
3215		Gregory Neil Shapiro of WPI.
3216	Give better diagnostics on long alias lines.  Based on code contributed
3217		by Patrick Gosling of the University of Cambridge.
3218	Increase the number of virtual interfaces that will be probed for
3219		alternate names.  Problem noted by Amy Rich of Shore.Net.
3220	PORTABILITY:
3221		UXP/DS V20L10 for Fujitsu DS/90: Makefile patches from
3222			Toshiaki Nomura of Fujitsu Limited.
3223		SunOS with LDAP support: compile problems with struct timeval.
3224			Patch from Nick Cuccia of TCSI Corporation.
3225		SCO: from Keith Reynolds of SCO.
3226		Solaris: kstat load average computation wasn't being used.
3227			Fixes from Michael Ju. Tokarev of Telecom Service, JSC
3228			(Moscow).
3229		OpenBSD: from Jason Downs of teeny.org.
3230		Altos System V: from Tim Rice.
3231		Solaris 2.5: from Alan Perry of SunSoft.
3232		Solaris 2.6: from John Beck of SunSoft.
3233		Harris Nighthawk PowerUX (mh6000 box): from Bob Miorelli
3234			of Pratt & Whitney <miorelli@pweh.com>.
3235	CONFIG: It seems that I hadn't gotten the Received: line syntax
3236		_just_right_ yet.  Tweak it again.  I'll omit the names
3237		of the "contributors" (quantity two) in this one case.
3238		As of now, NO MORE DISCUSSION about the syntax of the
3239		Received: line.
3240	CONFIG: Although FEATURE(nullclient) uses EXPOSED_USER (class $=E),
3241		it never inserts that class into the output file.  Fix it
3242		so it will honor EXPOSED_USER but will _not_ include root
3243		automatically in this class.  Problem noted by Ronan KERYELL
3244		of Centre de Recherche en Informatique de l'�cole Nationale
3245		Sup�rieure des Mines de Paris (CRI-ENSMP).
3246	CONFIG: Clean up handling of "local:" syntax in relay specifications
3247		such as LUSER_RELAY.  This change permits the following
3248		syntaxes:  ``local:'' will send to the same user on the
3249		local machine (e.g., in a mailertable entry for "host",
3250		``local:'' will cause an address addressed to user@host to
3251		go to user on the local machone).  ``local:user'' will send
3252		to the named user on the local machine.  ``local:user@host''
3253		is equivalent to ``local:user'' (the host is ignored).  In
3254		all cases, the original user@host is passed in $@ (i.e., the
3255		detail information).  Inspired by a report from Michael Fuhr.
3256	CONFIG: Strip quotes from the first word of an "error:" host
3257		indication.  This lets you set (for example) the LUSER_RELAY
3258		to be ``error:\"5.1.1\" Your Message Here''.  Note the use
3259		of the \" so that the resulting string is properly quoted.
3260		Problem noted by Gregory Neil Shapiro of WPI.
3261	OP.ME: documentation was inconsistent about whether sendmail did a
3262		NOOP or a RSET to probe the connection (it does a RSET).
3263		Inconsistency noted by Deeran Peethamparam.
3264	OP.ME: insert additional blank pages so it will print properly on
3265		a duplex printer.  From Matthew Black of Cal State University,
3266		Long Beach.
3267
32688.8.4/8.8.4	1996/12/02
3269	SECURITY: under some circumstances, an attacker could get additional
3270		permissions by hard linking to files that were group
3271		writable by the attacker.  The solution is to disallow any
3272		files that have hard links -- this will affect .forward,
3273		:include:, and output files.  Problem noted by Terry
3274		Kyriacopoulos of Interlog Internet Services.  As a
3275		workaround, set UnsafeGroupWrites -- always a good idea.
3276	SECURITY: the TryNullMXList (w) option should not be safe -- if it
3277		is, it is possible to do a denial-of-service attack on
3278		MX hosts that rely on the use of the null MX list.  There
3279		is no danger if you have this option turned off (the default).
3280		Problem noted by Dan Bernstein.  Also, make the DontInitGroups
3281		unsafe.  I know of no specific attack against this, although
3282		a denial-of-service attack is probably possible, but in theory
3283		you should not be able to safely tweak anything that affects
3284		the permissions that are used when mail is delivered.
3285	Purgestat could go into an infinite loop if one of the host status
3286		directories somehow became empty.  Problem noted by Roy
3287		Mongiovi of Georgia Tech.
3288	Processes got "lost" when counting children due to a race condition.
3289		This caused "proc_list_probe: lost pid" messages to be logged.
3290		Problem noted by several people.
3291	On systems with System V SIGCLD child signal semantics (notably AIX
3292		and HP-UX), mail transactions would print the message "451
3293		SMTP-MAIL: lost child: No child processes".  Problem noted
3294		by several people.
3295	Miscellaneous compiler warnings on picky compilers (or when setting
3296		gcc to high warning levels).  From Tom Moore of NCR Corp.
3297	SMTP protocol errors, and most errors on MAIL FROM: lines should
3298		not be persistent between runs, since they are based on the
3299		message rather than the host.  Problem noted by Matt Dillon
3300		of Best Internet Communications.
3301	The F=7 flag was ignored on SMTP mailers.  Problem noted by Tom Moore
3302		of NCR (a.k.a., AT&T Global Information Solutions).
3303	Avoid the possibility of having a child daemon run to completion
3304		(including closing the SMTP socket) before the parent has
3305		had a chance to close the socket; this can cause the parent
3306		to hang for a long time waiting for the socket to drain.
3307		Patch from Don Lewis of TDK Semiconductor.
3308	If the fork() failed in a queue run, the queue runners would not be
3309		rescheduled (so queue runs would stop).  Patch from Don Lewis.
3310	Some error conditions in ETRN could cause output without an SMTP
3311		status code.  Problem noted by Don Lewis.
3312	Multiple :maildrop addresses in the user database didn't work properly.
3313		Patch from Roy Mongiovi of Georgia Tech.
3314	Add ".db" automatically onto any user database spec that does not
3315		already have it; this is for consistency with makemap, the
3316		K line, and the documentation.  Inconsistency pointed out
3317		by Roy Mongiovi.
3318	Allow sendmail to be properly called in nohup mode.  Patch from
3319		Kyle Jones of UUNET.
3320	Change ETRN to ignore but still update host status files; previously
3321		it would ignore them and not save the updated status, which
3322		caused stale information to be maintained.  Based on a patch
3323		from Christopher Davis of Kapor Enterprises Inc.  Also, have
3324		ETRN ignore the MinQueueAge option.
3325	Patch long term host status to recover more gracefully from an empty
3326		host status file condition.  Patch from NAKAMURA Motonori
3327		of Kyoto University.
3328	Several patches to signal handling code to fix potential race
3329		conditions from Don Lewis.
3330	Make it possible to compile with -DDAEMON=0 (previously it had some
3331		compile errors).  This turns DAEMON, QUEUE, and SMTP into
3332		0/1 compilation flags.  Note that DAEMON is an obsolete
3333		compile flag; use NETINET instead.  Solution based on a
3334		patch from Bryan Costales.
3335	PORTABILITY FIXES:
3336		AIX4: getpwnam() and getpwuid() do a sequential scan of the
3337			/etc/security/passwd file when called as root.  This
3338			is very slow on some systems.  To speed it up, use the
3339			(undocumented) _getpw{nam,uid}_shadow() routines.
3340			Patch from Chris Thomas of UCLA/OAC Systems Group.
3341		SCO 5.x: include -lprot in the Makefile.  Patch from Bill
3342			Glicker of Burrelle's Information Service.
3343		NEWS-OS 4.x: need a definition for MODE_T to compile.  Patch
3344			from Makoto MATSUSHITA of Osaka University.
3345		SunOS 4.0.3: compile problems.  Patches from Andrew Cole of
3346			Leeds University and SASABE Tetsuro of the University
3347			of Tokyo.
3348		DG/UX 5.4.4.11 from Brian J. Murrell of InterLinx Support
3349			Services, Inc.
3350		Domain/OS from Don (Truck) Lewis of TDK Semiconductor Corp.
3351			I believe this to have only been a problem if you
3352			compiled with -DUSE_VENDOR_CF_PATH -- another reason
3353			to stick with /etc/sendmail.cf as your One True Path.
3354		Digital UNIX (OSF/1 on Alpha) load average computation from
3355			Martin Laubach of the Technischen Universit�t Wien.
3356	CONFIG: change default Received: line to be multiple lines rather
3357		than one long one.  By popular demand.
3358	MAIL.LOCAL: warnings weren't being logged on some systems.  Patch
3359		from Jerome Berkman of U.C. Berkeley.
3360	MAKEMAP: be sure to zero hinfo to avoid cruft that can cause runs
3361		to take a very long time.  Problem noted by Yoshiro YONEYA
3362		of NTT Software Corporation.
3363	CONTRIB: add etrn.pl, contributed by John Beck.
3364	NEW FILES:
3365		contrib/etrn.pl
3366
33678.8.3/8.8.3	1996/11/17
3368	SECURITY: it was possible to get a root shell by lying to sendmail
3369		about argv[0] and then sending it a signal.  Problem noted
3370		by Leshka Zakharoff <leshka@leshka.chuvashia.su> on the
3371		best-of-security list.
3372	Log sendmail binary version number in "Warning: .cf version level
3373		(%d) exceeds program functionality (%d) message" -- this
3374		should make it clearer to people that they are running
3375		the wrong binary.
3376	Fix a problem that occurs when you open an SMTP connection and then
3377		do one or more ETRN commands followed by a MAIL command; at
3378		the end of the DATA phase sendmail would incorrectly report
3379		"451 SMTP-MAIL: lost child: No child processes".  Problem
3380		noted by Eric Bishop of Virginia Tech.
3381	When doing text-based host canonification (typically /etc/hosts
3382		lookup), a null host name would match any /etc/hosts entry
3383		with space at the end of the line.  Problem noted by Steve
3384		Hubert of the University of Washington, Seattle.
3385	7 to 8 bit BASE64 MIME conversions could duplicate bits of text.
3386		Problem reported by Tom Smith of Digital Equipment Corp.
3387	Increase the size of the DNS answer buffer -- the standard UDP packet
3388		size PACKETSZ (512) is not sufficient for some nameserver
3389		answers containing very many resource records.  The resolver
3390		may also switch to TCP and retry if it detects UDP packet
3391		overflow.  Also, allow for the fact that the resolver
3392		routines res_query and res_search return the size of the
3393		*un*truncated answer in case the supplied answer buffer it
3394		not big enough to accommodate the entire answer.  Patch from
3395		Eric Wassenaar.
3396	Improvements to MaxDaemonChildren code.  If you think you have too
3397		many children, probe the ones you have to verify that they
3398		are still around.  Suggested by Jared Mauch of CICnet, Inc.
3399		Also, do this probe before growing the vector of children
3400		pids; this previously caused the vector to grow indefinitely
3401		due to a race condition.  Problem reported by Kyle Jones of
3402		UUNET.
3403	On some architectures, <db.h> (from the Berkeley DB library) defines
3404		O_EXLOCK to zero; this fools the map compilation code into
3405		thinking that it can avoid race conditions by locking on open.
3406		Change it to check for O_EXLOCK non-zero.  Problem noted by
3407		Leif Erlingsson of Data Lege.
3408	Always call res_init() on startup (if compiled in, of course) to
3409		allow the sendmail.cf file to tweak resolver flags; without
3410		it, flag tweaks in ResolverOptions are ignored.  Patch from
3411		Andrew Sun of Merrill Lynch.
3412	Improvements to host status printing code.  Suggested by Steve Hubert
3413		of the University of Washington, Seattle.
3414	Change MinQueueAge option processing to do the check for the job age
3415		when reading the queue file, rather than at the end; this
3416		avoids parsing the addresses, which can do DNS lookups.
3417		Problem noted by John Beck of InReference, Inc.
3418	When MIME was being 7->8 bit decoded, "From " lines weren't being
3419		properly escaped.  Problem noted by Peter Nilsson of the
3420		University of Linkoping.
3421	In some cases, sendmail would retain root permissions during queue
3422		runs even if RunAsUser was set.  Problem noted by Mark
3423		Thomas of Mark G. Thomas Consulting.
3424	If the F=l flag was set on an SMTP mailer to indicate that it is
3425		actually local delivery, and NOTIFY=SUCCESS is specified in
3426		the envelope, and the receiving SMTP server speaks DSN, then
3427		the DSN would be both generated locally and propagated to the
3428		other end.
3429	The U= mailer field didn't correctly extract the group id if the
3430		user id was numeric.  Problem noted by Kenneth Herron of
3431		MCI Telecommunications Communications.
3432	If a message exceeded the fixed maximum size on input, the body of
3433		the message was included in the bounce.  Note that this did
3434		not occur if it exceeded the maximum _output_ size.  Problem
3435		reported by Kyle Jones of UUNET.
3436	PORTABILITY FIXES:
3437		AIX4: 4.1 doesn't have a working setreuid(2); change the
3438			AIX4 defines to use seteuid(2) instead, which
3439			works on 4.1 as well as 4.2.  Problem noted by
3440			H�kan Lindholm of interAF, Sweden.
3441		AIX4: use tzname[] vector to determine time zone name.
3442			Patch from NAKAMURA Motonori of Kyoto University.
3443		MkLinux: add Makefile.Linux.ppc and OSTYPE(mklinux) support.
3444			Contributed by Paul DuBois <dubois@primate.wisc.edu>.
3445		Solaris: kstat(3k) support for retrieving the load average.
3446			This adds the LA_KSTAT definition for LA_TYPE.
3447			The outline of the implementation was contributed
3448			by Michael Tokarev of Telecom Service, JSC, Moscow.
3449		HP-UX 10.0 gripes about the (perfectly legal!) forward
3450			declaration of struct rusage at the top of conf.h;
3451			change it to only be included if you are using gcc,
3452			which is apparently the only compiler that requires
3453			it in the first place.  Problem noted by Jeff
3454			Earickson of Colby College.
3455		IRIX: don't default to using gcc.  IRIX is a civilized
3456			operating system that comes with a decent compiler
3457			by default.  Problem noted by Barry Bouwsma and
3458			Kari Hurtta.
3459	CONFIG: specify F=9 as default in FEATURE(local_procmail) for
3460		consistency with other local mailers.  Inconsistency
3461		pointed out by Teddy Hogeborn <teddy@fukt.hk-r.se>.
3462	CONFIG: if the "limited best mx" feature is used (to reduce DNS
3463		overhead) as part of the bestmx_is_local feature, the
3464		domain part was dropped from the name.  Patch from Steve
3465		Hubert of the University of Washington, Seattle.
3466	CONFIG: catch addresses of the form "user@.dom.ain"; these could
3467		end up being translated to the null host name, which would
3468		return any entry in /etc/hosts that had a space at the end
3469		of the line.  Problem noted by Steve Hubert of the
3470		University of Washington, Seattle.
3471	CONFIG: add OSTYPE(aix4).  From Michael Sofka of Rensselaer
3472		Polytechnic Institute.
3473	MAKEMAP: tweak hash and btree parameters for better performance.
3474		Patch from Matt Dillon of Best Internet Communications.
3475	NEW FILES:
3476		src/Makefiles/Makefile.Linux.ppc
3477		cf/ostype/aix4.m4
3478		cf/ostype/mklinux.m4
3479
34808.8.2/8.8.2	1996/10/18
3481	SECURITY: fix a botch in the 7-bit MIME patch; the previous patch
3482		changed the code but didn't fix the problem.
3483	PORTABILITY FIXES:
3484		Solaris: Don't use the system getusershell(3); it can
3485			apparently corrupt the heap in some circumstances.
3486			Problem found by Ken Pizzini of Spry, Inc.
3487	OP.ME: document several mailer flags that were accidentally omitted
3488		from this document.  These flags were F=d, F=j, F=R, and F=9.
3489	CONFIG: no changes.
3490
34918.8.1/8.8.1	1996/10/17
3492	SECURITY: unset all environment variables that the resolver will
3493		examine during queue runs and daemon mode.  Problem noted
3494		by Dan Bernstein of the University of Illinois at Chicago.
3495	SECURITY: in some cases an illegal 7-bit MIME-encoded text/plain
3496		message could overflow a buffer if it was converted back
3497		to 8 bits.  This caused core dumps and has the potential
3498		for a remote attack.  Problem first noted by Gregory Shapiro
3499		of WPI.
3500	Avoid duplicate deliveries of error messages on systems that don't
3501		have flock(2) support.  Patch from Motonori Nakamura of
3502		Kyoto University.
3503	Ignore null FallBackMX (V) options.  If this option is null (as
3504		opposed to undefined) it can cause "null signature" syserrs
3505		on illegal host names.
3506	If a Base64 encoded text/plain message has no trailing newline in
3507		the encoded text, conversion back to 8 bits will drop the
3508		final line.  Problem noted by Pierre David.
3509	If running with a RunAsUser, sendmail would give bogus "cannot
3510		setuid" (or seteuid, or setreuid) messages on some systems.
3511		Problem pointed out by Jordan Mendelson of Web Services, Inc.
3512	Always print error messages in -bv mode -- previously, -bv would
3513		be absolutely silent on errors if the error mode was sent
3514		to (say) mail-back.  Problem noted by Kyle Jones of UUNET.
3515	If -qI/R/S is set (or the ETRN command is used), ignore all long
3516		term host status.  This is necessary because it is common
3517		to do this when you know a host has just come back up.
3518	Disallow duplicate HELO/EHLO commands as required by RFC 1651 section
3519		4.2.  Excessive permissiveness noted by Lee Flight of the
3520		University of Leicester.
3521	If a service (such as NIS) is specified as the last entry in the
3522		service switch, but that service is not compiled in, sendmail
3523		would return a temporary failure when an entry was not found
3524		in the map.  This caused the message to be queued instead of
3525		bouncing immediately.  Problem noted by Harry Edmon of the
3526		University of Washington.
3527	PORTABILITY FIXES:
3528		Solaris 2.3 had compilation problems in conf.c.  Several
3529			people pointed this out.
3530		NetBSD from Charles Hannum of MIT.
3531		AIX4 improvements based on info from Steve Bauer of South
3532			Dakota School of Mines & Technology.
3533	CONFIG: ``error:code message'' syntax was broken in virtusertable.
3534		Patch from Gil Kloepfer Jr.
3535	CONFIG: if FEATURE(nocanonify) was specified, hosts in $=M (set
3536		using MASQUERADE_DOMAIN) were not masqueraded unless they
3537		were also in $=w.  Problem noted by Zoltan Basti of
3538		Softec.
3539	MAIL.LOCAL: patches to compile and link cleanly on AIX.  Based
3540		on a patch from Eric Hagberg of Morgan Stanley.
3541	MAIL.LOCAL: patches to compile on NEXTSTEP.  From Patrick Nolan
3542		of Stanford via Robert La Ferla.
3543
35448.8.0/8.8.0	1996/09/26
3545	Under some circumstances, Bcc: headers would not be properly
3546		deleted.  Pointed out by Jonathan Kamens of OpenVision.
3547	Log a warning if the sendmail daemon is invoked without a full
3548		pathname, which prevents "kill -1" from working.  I was
3549		urged to put this in by Andrey A. Chernov of DEMOS (Russia).
3550	Fix small buffer overflow.  Since the data in this buffer was not
3551		read externally, there was no security problem (and in fact
3552		probably wouldn't really overflow on most compilers).  Pointed
3553		out by KIZU takashi of Osaka University.
3554	Fix problem causing domain literals such as [1.2.3.4] to be ignored
3555		if a FallbackMXHost was specified in the configuration file
3556		-- all mail would be sent to the fallback even if the original
3557		host was accessible.  Pointed out by Munenari Hirayama of
3558		NSC (Japan).
3559	A message that didn't terminate with a newline would (sometimes) not
3560		have the trailing "." added properly in the SMTP dialogue,
3561		causing SMTP to hang.  Patch from Per Hedeland of Ericsson.
3562	The DaemonPortOptions suboption to bind to a particular address was
3563		incorrect and nonfunctional due to a misunderstanding of the
3564		semantics of binding on a passive socket.  Patch from
3565		NIIBE Yutaka of Mitsubishi Research Institute.
3566	Increase the number of MX hosts for a single name to 100 to better
3567		handle the truly huge service providers such as AOL, which
3568		has 13 at the moment (and climbing).  In order to avoid
3569		trashing memory, the buffer for all names has only been
3570		slightly increased in size, to 12.8K from 10.2K -- this means
3571		that if a single name had 100 MX records, the average size
3572		of those records could not exceed 128 bytes.  Requested by
3573		Brad Knowles of America On Line.
3574	Restore use of IDENT returns where the OSTYPE field equals "OTHER".
3575		Urged by Dan Bernstein of U.C. Berkeley.
3576	Print q_statdate and q_specificity in address structure debugging
3577		printout.
3578	Expand MCI structure flag bits for debugging output.
3579	Support IPv6-style domain literals, which can have colons between
3580		square braces.
3581	Log open file descriptors for the "cannot dup" messages in deliver();
3582		this is an attempt to track down a bug that one person seems
3583		to be having (it may be a Solaris bug!).
3584	DSN NOTIFY parameters were not properly propagated across queue runs;
3585		this caused the NOTIFY info to sometimes be lost.  Problem
3586		pointed out by Claus Assmann of the
3587		Christian-Albrechts-University of Kiel.
3588	The statistics gathered in the sendmail.st file were too high; in
3589		some cases failures (e.g., user unknown or temporary failure)
3590		would count as a delivery as far as the statistics were
3591		concerned.  Problem noted by Tom Moore of AT&T GIS.
3592	Systems that don't have flock() would not send split envelopes in
3593		the initial run.  Problem pointed out by Leonard Zubkoff of
3594		Dandelion Digital.
3595	Move buffer overflow checking -- these primarily involve distrusting
3596		results that may come from NIS and DNS.
3597	4.4-BSD-derived systems, including FreeBSD, NetBSD, and BSD/OS didn't
3598		include <paths.h> and hence had the wrong pathnames for a few
3599		things like /var/tmp.  Reported by Matthew Green.
3600	Conditions were reversed for the Priority: header, resulting in all
3601		values being interpreted as non-urgent except for non-urgent,
3602		which was interpreted as normal.  Patch from Bryan Costales.
3603	The -o (optional) flag was being ignored on hash and btree maps
3604		since 8.7.2.  Fix from Bryan Costales.
3605	Content-Types listed in class "q" will always be encoded as
3606		Quoted-Printable (or more accurately, will never be encoded
3607		as base64).  The class can have primary types (e.g., "text")
3608		or full types (e.g., "text/plain").  Based on a suggestion by
3609		Marius Olafsson of the University of Iceland.
3610	Define ${envid} to be the original envelope id (from the ESMTP DSN
3611		dialogue) so it can be passed to programs in mailers.
3612	Define ${bodytype} to be the body type (from the -B flag or the
3613		BODY= ESMTP parameter) so it can be passed to programs in
3614		mailers.
3615	Cause the VRFY command to return 252 instead of 250 unless the F=q
3616		flag is set in the mailer descriptor.  Suggested by John
3617		Myers of CMU.
3618	Implement ESMTP ETRN command to flush the queue for a specific host.
3619		The command takes a host name; data for that host is
3620		immediately (and asynchronously) flushed.  Because this shares
3621		the -qR implementation, other hosts may be attempted, but
3622		there should be no security implications.  Implementation
3623		from John Beck of InReference, Inc.  See RFC 1985 for details.
3624	Add three new command line flags to pass in DSN parameters: -V envid
3625		(equivalent to ENVID=envid on the MAIL command), -R ret
3626		(equivalent to RET=ret on the MAIL command), and -Nnotify
3627		(equivalent to NOTIFY=notify on the RCPT command).  Note
3628		that the -N flag applies to all recipients; there is no way
3629		to specify per-address notifications on the command line,
3630		nor is there an equivalent for the ORCPT= per-address
3631		parameter.
3632	Restore LogLevel option to be safe (it can only be increased);
3633		apparently I went into paranoid mode between 8.6 and 8.7
3634		and made it unsafe.  Pointed out by Dabe Murphy of the
3635		University of Maryland.
3636	New logging on log level 15:  all SMTP traffic.  Patches from
3637		Andrew Gross of San Diego Supercomputer Center.
3638	NetInfo property value searching code wasn't stopping when it found
3639		a match.  This was causing the wrong values to be found (and
3640		had a memory leak).  Found by Bastian Schleuter of TU-Berlin.
3641	Add new F=0 (zero) mailer flag to turn off MX lookups.  It was pointed
3642		out by Bill Wisner of Electronics for Imaging that you can't
3643		use the bracket address form for the MAIL_HUB macro, since
3644		that causes the brackets to remain in the envelope recipient
3645		address used for delivery.  The simple fix (stripping off the
3646		brackets in the config file) breaks the use of IP literal
3647		addresses.  This flag will solve that problem.
3648	Add MustQuoteChars option.  This is a list of characters that must
3649		be quoted if they are found in the phrase part of an address
3650		(that is, the full name part).  The characters @,;:\()[] are
3651		always in this list and cannot be removed.  The default is
3652		this list plus . and ' to match RFC 822.
3653	Add AllowBogusHELO option; if set, sendmail will allow HELO commands
3654		that do not include a host name for back compatibility with
3655		some stupid SMTP clients.  Setting this violates RFC 1123
3656		section 5.2.5.
3657	Add MaxDaemonChildren option; if this is set, sendmail will start
3658		rejecting connections if it has more than this many
3659		outstanding children accepting mail.  Note that you may
3660		see more processes than this because of outgoing mail; this
3661		is for incoming connections only.
3662	Add ConnectionRateThrottle option.  If set to a positive value, the
3663		number of incoming SMTP connections that will be permitted
3664		in a single second is limited to this number.  Connections are
3665		not refused during this time, just deferred.  The intent is to
3666		flatten out demand so that load average limiting can kick in.
3667		It is less radical than MaxDaemonChildren, which will stop
3668		accepting connections even if all the connections are idle
3669		(e.g., due to connection caching).
3670	Add Timeout.hoststatus option.  This interval (defaulting to 30m)
3671		specifies how long cached information about the state of a
3672		host will be kept before they are considered stale and the
3673		host is retried.  If you are using persistent host status
3674		(i.e., the HostStatusDirectory option is set) this will apply
3675		between runs; otherwise, it applies only within a single queue
3676		run and hence is useful only for hosts that have large queues
3677		that take a very long time to run.
3678	Add SingleLineFromHeader option.  If set, From: headers are coerced
3679		into being a single line even if they had newlines in them
3680		when read.  This is to get around a botch in Lotus Notes.
3681	Text class maps were totally broken -- if you ever retrieved the last
3682		item in a table it would be truncated.  Problem noted by
3683		Gregory Neil Shapiro of WPI.
3684	Extend the lines printed by the mailq command (== the -bp flag) when
3685		-v is given to 120 characters; this allows more information
3686		to be displayed.  Suggested by Gregory Neil Shapiro of WPI.
3687	Allow macro definitions (`D' lines) with unquoted commas; previously
3688		this was treated as end-of-input.  Problem noted by Bryan
3689		Costales.
3690	The RET= envelope parameter (used for DSNs) wasn't properly written
3691		to the queue file.  Fix from John Hughes of Atlantic
3692		Technologies, Inc.
3693	Close /var/tmp/dead.letter after a successful write -- otherwise
3694		if this happens in a queue run it can cause nasty delays.
3695		Problem noted by Mark Horton of AT&T.
3696	If userdb entries pointed to userdb entries, and there were multiple
3697		values for a given key, the database cursor would get
3698		trashed by the recursive call.  Problem noted by Roy Mongiovi
3699		of Georgia Tech.  Fixed by reading all the values and creating
3700		a comma-separated list; thus, the -v output will be somewhat
3701		different for this case.
3702	Fix buffer allocation problem with Hesiod-based userdb maps when
3703		HES_GETMAILHOST is defined.  Based on a patch by Betty Lee
3704		of Stanford University.
3705	When envelopes were split due to aliases with owner- aliases, and
3706		there was some error on one of the lists, more than one of
3707		the owners would get the message.  Problem pointed out by
3708		Roy Mongiovi of Georgia Tech.
3709	Detect excessive recursion in macro expansions, e.g., $X defined
3710		in terms of $Y which is defined in terms of $X.  Problem
3711		noted by Bryan Costales; patch from Eric Wassenaar.
3712	When using F=U to get "ugly UUCP" From_ lines, a buffer could in
3713		some cases get trashed causing bogus From_ lines.  Fix from
3714		Kyle Jones of UUNET.
3715	When doing load average initialization, if the nlist call for avenrun
3716		failed, the second and subsequent lookups wouldn't notice
3717		that fact causing bogus load averages to be returned.  Noted
3718		by Casper Dik of Sun Holland.
3719	Fix problem with incompatibility with some versions of inet_aton that
3720		have changed the return value to unsigned, so a check for an
3721		error return of -1 doesn't work.  Use INADDR_NONE instead.
3722		This could cause mail to addresses such as [foo.com] to bounce
3723		or get dropped.  Problem noted by Christophe Wolfhugel of the
3724		Pasteur Institute.
3725	DSNs were inconsistent if a failure occurred during the DATA phase
3726		rather than the RCPT phase: the Action: would be correct, but
3727		the detailed status information would be wrong.  Problem noted
3728		by Bob Snyder of General Electric Company.
3729	Add -U command line flag and the XUSR ESMTP extension, both indicating
3730		that this is the initial MUA->MTA submission.  The flag current
3731		does nothing, but in future releases (when MUAs start using
3732		these flags) it will probably turn on things like DNS
3733		canonification.
3734	Default end-of-line string (E= specification on mailer [M] lines)
3735		to \r\n on SMTP mailers.  Default remains \n on non-SMTP
3736		mailers.
3737	Change the internal definition for the *file* and *include* mailers
3738		to have $u in the argument vectors so that they aren't
3739		misinterpreted as SMTP mailers and thus use \r\n line
3740		termination.  This will affect anyone who has redefined
3741		either of these in their configuration file.
3742	Don't assume that IDENT servers close the connection after a query;
3743		responses can be newline terminated.  From Terry Kennedy of
3744		St. Peter's College.
3745	Avoid core dumps on erroneous configuration files that have
3746		$#mailer with nothing following.  From Bryan Costales.
3747	Avoid null pointer dereference with high debug values in unlockqueue.
3748		Fix from Randy Martin of Clemson University.
3749	Fix possible buffer overrun when expanding very large macros.  Fix
3750		from Kyle Jones of UUNET.
3751	After 25 EXPN or VRFY commands, start pausing for a second before
3752		processing each one.  This avoids a certain form of denial
3753		of service attack.  Potential attack pointed out by Bryan
3754		Costales.
3755	Allow new named (not numbered!) config file rules to do validity
3756		checking on SMTP arguments: check_mail for MAIL commands and
3757		check_rcpt for RCPT commands.  These rulesets can do anything
3758		they want; their result is ignored unless they resolve to the
3759		$#error mailer, in which case the indicated message is printed
3760		and the command is rejected.  Similarly, the check_compat
3761		ruleset is called before delivery with "from_addr $| to_addr"
3762		(the $| is a meta-symbol used to separate the two addresses);
3763		it can give a "this sender can't send to this recipient"
3764		notification.  Note that this patch allows $| to stand alone
3765		in rulesets.
3766	Define new macros ${client_name}, ${client_addr}, and ${client_port}
3767		that have the name, IP address, and port number (respectively)
3768		of the SMTP client (that is, the entity at the other end of
3769		the connection.  These can be used in (e.g.) check_rcpt to
3770		verify that someone isn't trying to relay mail through your
3771		host inappropriately.  Be sure to use the deferred evaluation
3772		form, for example $&{client_name}, to avoid having these bound
3773		when sendmail reads the configuration file.
3774	Add new config file rule check_relay to check the incoming connection
3775		information.  Like check_compat, it is passed the host name
3776		and host address separated by $| and can reject connections
3777		on that basis.
3778	Allow IDA-style recursive function calls.  Code contributed by Mark
3779		Lovell and Paul Vixie.
3780	Eliminate the "No ! in UUCP From address!" message" -- instead, create
3781		a virtual UUCP address using either a domain address or the $k
3782		macro.  Based on code contributed by Mark Lovell and Paul
3783		Vixie.
3784	Add Stanford LDAP map.  Requires special libraries that are not
3785		included with sendmail.  Contributed by Booker C. Bense
3786		<bbense@networking.stanford.edu>; contact him for support.
3787		See also the src/READ_ME file.
3788	Allow -dANSI to turn on ANSI escape sequences in debug output; this
3789		puts metasymbols (e.g., $+) in reverse video.  Really useful
3790		only for debugging deep bits of code where it is important to
3791		distinguish between the single-character metasymbol $+ and the
3792		two characters $, +.
3793	Changed ruleset 89 (executed in dumpstate()) to a named ruleset,
3794		debug_dumpstate.
3795	Add new UnsafeGroupWrites option; if set, .forward and :include:
3796		files that are group writable are considered "unsafe" -- that
3797		is, programs and files referenced from such files are not
3798		valid recipients.
3799	Delete bogosity test for FallBackMX host; this prevented it to be a
3800		name that was not in DNS or was a domain-literal.  Problem
3801		noted by Tom May.
3802	Change the introduction to error messages to more clearly delineate
3803		permanent from temporary failures; if both existed in a
3804		single message it could be confusing.  Suggested by John
3805		Beck of InReference, Inc.
3806	The IngoreDot (i) option didn't work for lines that were terminated
3807		with CRLF.  Problem noted by Ted Stockwell of Secure
3808		Computing Corporation.
3809	Add a heuristic to improve the handling of unbalanced `<' signs in
3810		message headers.  Problem reported by Matt Dillon of Best
3811		Internet Communications.
3812	Check for bogus characters in the 0200-0237 range; since these are
3813		used internally, very strange errors can occur if those
3814		characters appear in headers.  Problem noted by Anders Gertz
3815		of Lysator.
3816	Implement 7 -> 8 bit MIME conversions.  This only takes place if the
3817		recipient mailer has the F=9 flag set, and only works on
3818		text/plain body types.  Code contributed by Marius Olafsson
3819		of the University of Iceland.
3820	Special case "postmaster" name so that it is always treated as lower
3821		case in alias files regardless of configuration settings;
3822		this prevents some potential problems where "Postmaster" or
3823		"POSTMASTER" might not match "postmaster".  In most cases
3824		this change is a no-op.
3825	The -o map flag was ignored for text maps.  Problem noted by Bryan
3826		Costales.
3827	The -a map flag was ignored for dequote maps.  Problem noted by
3828		Bryan Costales.
3829	Fix core dump when a lookup of a class "prog" map returns no
3830		response.  Patch from Bryan Costales.
3831	Log instances where sendmail is deferring or rejecting connections
3832		on LogLevel 14.  Suggested by Kyle Jones of UUNET.
3833	Include port number in process title for network daemons.  Suggested
3834		by Kyle Jones of UUNET.
3835	Send ``double bounces'' (errors that occur when sending an error
3836		message) to the address indicated in the DoubleBounceAddress
3837		option (default: postmaster).  Previously they were always
3838		sent to postmaster.  Suggested by Kyle Jones of UUNET.
3839	Add new mode, -bD, that acts like -bd in all respects except that
3840		it runs in foreground.  This is useful for using with a
3841		wrapper that "watches" system services.  Suggested by Kyle
3842		Jones of UUNET.
3843	Fix botch in spacing around (parenthesized) comments in addresses
3844		when the comment comes before the address.  Patch from
3845		Motonori Nakamura of Kyoto University.
3846	Use the prefix "Postmaster notify" on the Subject: lines of messages
3847		that are being bounced to postmaster, rather than "Returned
3848		mail".  This permits the person who is postmaster more
3849		easily determine what messages are to their role as
3850		postmaster versus bounces to mail they actually sent.  Based
3851		on a suggestion by Motonori Nakamura.
3852	Add new value "time" for QueueSortOrder option; this causes the queue
3853		to be sorted strictly by the time of submission.  Note that
3854		this can cause very bad behavior over slow lines (because
3855		large jobs will tend to delay small jobs) and on nodes with
3856		heavy traffic (because old things in the queue for hosts that
3857		are down delay processing of new jobs).  Also, this does not
3858		guarantee that jobs will be delivered in submission order
3859		unless you also set DeliveryMode=queue.  In general, it should
3860		probably only be used on the command line, and only in
3861		conjunction with -qRhost.domain.  In fact, there are very few
3862		cases where it should be used at all.  Based on an
3863		implementation by Motonori Nakamura.
3864	If a map lookup in ruleset 5 returns tempfail, queue the message in
3865		the same manner as other rulesets.  Previously a temporary
3866		failure in ruleset 5 was ignored.  Patch from Booker Bense
3867		of Stanford University.
3868	Don't proceed to the next MX host if an SMTP MAIL command returns a
3869		5yz (permanent failure) code.  The next MX host will still be
3870		tried if the connection cannot be opened in the first place
3871		or if the MAIL command returns a 4yz (temporary failure) code.
3872		(It's hard to know what to do here, since neither RFC 974 nor
3873		RFC 1123 specify when to proceed to the next MX host.)
3874		Suggested by Jonathan Kamens of OpenVision, Inc.
3875	Add new "-t" flag for map definitions (the "K" line in the .cf file).
3876		This causes map lookups that get a temporary failure (e.g.,
3877		name server failure) to _not_ defer the delivery of the
3878		message.  This should only be used if your configuration file
3879		is prepared to do something sensible in this case.  Based on
3880		an idea by Gregory Shapiro of WPI.
3881	Fix problem finding network interface addresses.  Patch from
3882		Motonori Nakamura.
3883	Don't reject qf entries that are not owned by your effective uid if
3884		you are not running setuid; this makes management of certain
3885		kinds of firewall setups difficult.  Patch suggested by
3886		Eamonn Coleman of Qualcomm.
3887	Add persistent host status.  This keeps the information normally
3888		maintained within a single queue run in disk files that are
3889		shared between sendmail instances.  The HostStatusDirectory
3890		is the directory in which the information is maintained.  If
3891		not set, persistent host status is turned off.  If not a full
3892		pathname, it is relative to the queue directory.  A common
3893		value is ".hoststat".
3894		There are also two new operation modes:
3895		  * -bh prints the status of hosts that have had recent
3896		    connections.
3897		  * -bH purges the host statuses.  No attempt is made to save
3898		    recent status information.
3899		This feature was originally written by Paul Vixie of Vixie
3900		Enterprises for KJS and adapted for V8 by Mark Lovell of
3901		Bigrock Consulting.  Paul's funding of Mark and Mark's patience
3902		with my insistence that things fit cleanly into the V8
3903		framework is gratefully appreciated.
3904	New SingleThreadDelivery option (requires HostStatusDirectory to
3905		operate).  Avoids letting two sendmails on the local machine
3906		open connections to the same remote host at the same time.
3907		This reduces load on the other machine, but can cause mail to
3908		be delayed (for example, if one sendmail is delivering a huge
3909		message, other sendmails won't be able to send even small
3910		messages).  Also, it requires another file descriptor (for the
3911		lock file) per connection, so you may have to reduce
3912		ConnectionCacheSize to avoid running out of per-process
3913		file descriptors.  Based on the persistent host status code
3914		contributed by Paul Vixie and Mark Lovell.
3915	Allow sending to non-simple files (e.g., /dev/null) even if the
3916		SafeFileEnvironment option is set.  Problem noted by Bryan
3917		Costales.
3918	The -qR flag mistakenly matched flags in the "R" line of the queue
3919		file.  Problem noted by Bryan Costales.
3920	If a job was aborted using the interrupt signal (e.g., control-C from
3921		the keyboard), on some occasions an empty df file would be
3922		left around; these would collect in the queue directory.
3923		Problem noted by Bryan Costales.
3924	Change the makesendmail script to enhance the search for Makefiles
3925		based on release number.  For example, on SunOS 5.5.1, it will
3926		search for Makefile.SunOS.5.5.1, Makefile.SunOS.5.5, and then
3927		Makefile.SunOS.5.x (in addition to the other rules, e.g.,
3928		adding $arch).  Problem noted by Jason Mastaler of Atlanta
3929		Webmasters.
3930	When creating maps using "newaliases", always map the keys to lower
3931		case when creating the map unless the -f flag is specified on
3932		the map itself.  Previously this was done based on the F=u
3933		flag in the local mailer, which meant you could create aliases
3934		that you could never access.  Problem noted by Bob Wu of DEC.
3935	When a job was read from the queue, the bits causing notification on
3936		failure or delay were always set.  This caused those
3937		notifications to be sent even if NOTIFY=NEVER had been
3938		specified.  Problem noted by Steve Hubert of the University
3939		of Washington, Seattle.
3940	Add new configurable routine validate_connection (in conf.c).  This
3941		lets you decide if you are willing to accept traffic from
3942		this host.  If it returns FALSE, all SMTP commands will return
3943		"550 Access denied".  -DTCPWRAPPERS will include support for
3944		TCP wrappers; you will need to add -lwrap to the link line.
3945		(See src/READ_ME for details.)
3946	Don't include the "THIS IS A WARNING MESSAGE ONLY" banner on postmaster
3947		bounces.  Some people seemed to think that this could be
3948		confusing (even though it is true).  Suggested by Motonori
3949		Nakamura.
3950	Add new RunAsUser option; this causes sendmail to do a setuid to that
3951		user early in processing to avoid potential security problems.
3952		However, this means that all .forward and :include: files must
3953		be readable by that user, and all files to be written must be
3954		writable by that user and all programs will be executed by that
3955		user.  It is also incompatible with the SafeFileEnvironment
3956		option.  In other words, it may not actually add much to
3957		security.  However, it should be useful on firewalls and other
3958		places where users don't have accounts and the aliases file is
3959		well constrained.
3960	Add Timeout.iconnect.  This is like Timeout.connect except it is used
3961		only on the first attempt to delivery to an address.  It could
3962		be set to be lower than Timeout.connect on the principle that
3963		the mail should go through quickly to responsive hosts; less
3964		responsive hosts get to wait for the next queue run.
3965	Fix a problem on Solaris that occasionally causes programs
3966		(such as vacation) to hang with their standard input connected
3967		to a UDP port.  It also created some signal handling problems.
3968		The problems turned out to be an interaction between vfork(2)
3969		and some of the libraries, particularly NIS/NIS+.  I am
3970		indebted to Tor Egge <tegge@idt.ntnu.no> for this fix.
3971	Change user class map to do the same matching that actual delivery
3972		will do instead of just a /etc/passwd lookup.  This adds
3973		fuzzy matching to the user map.  Patch from Dan Oscarsson.
3974	The Timeout.* options are not safe -- they can be used to create a
3975		denial-of-service attack.  Problem noted by Christophe
3976		Wolfhugel.
3977	Don't send PostmasterCopy messages in the event of a "delayed"
3978		notification.  Suggested by Barry Bouwsma.
3979	Don't advertise "VERB" ESMTP extension if the "noexpn" privacy
3980		option is set, since this disables VERB mode.  Suggested
3981		by John Hawkinson of MIT.
3982	Complain if the QueueDirectory (Q) option is not set.  Problem noted
3983		by Motonori Nakamura of Kyoto University.
3984	Only queue messages on transient .forward open failures if there
3985		were no successful opens.  The previous behavior caused it
3986		to queue even if a "fall back" .forward was found.  Problem
3987		noted by Ann-Kian Yeo of the Dept. of Information Systems
3988		and Computer Science (DISCS), NUS, Singapore.
3989	Don't do 8->7 bit conversions when bouncing a MIME message that
3990		is bouncing because of a MIME error during 8->7 bit conversion;
3991		the encapsulated message will bounce again, causing a loop.
3992		Problem noted by Steve Hubert of the University of Washington.
3993	Create xf (transcript) files using the TempFileMode option value
3994		instead of 0644.  Suggested by Ann-Kian Yeo of the
3995		National University of Singapore.
3996	Print errors if setgid/setuid/etc. fail during delivery.  This helps
3997		detect cases where DefaultUid is set to something that the
3998		system can't cope with.
3999	PORTABILITY FIXES:
4000		Support for AIX/RS 2.2.1 from Mark Whetzel of Western
4001			Atlas International.
4002		Patches for Intel Paragon OSF/1 1.3 from Leo Bicknell
4003			<bicknell@ufp.org>.
4004		On DEC OSF/1 3.2 and earlier, the MatchGECOS code would only
4005			work on the first recipient of a message due to a
4006			bug in the getpwent family.  If this is something you
4007			use, you can define DEC_OSF_BROKEN_GETPWENT=1 for a
4008			workaround.  From Maximum Entropy of Sanford C.
4009			Bernstein and Associates.
4010		FreeBSD 1.1.5.1 uname -r returns a string containing
4011			parentheses, which breaks makesendmail.  Reported
4012			by Piero Serini <piero@strider.ibenet.it>.
4013		Sequent DYNIX/ptx 4.0.2 patches from Jack Woolley of
4014			Systems and Computer Technology Corporation.
4015		Solaris 2.x: omit the UUCP grade parameter (-g flag) because
4016			it is system-dependent.  Problem noted by J.J. Bailey
4017			of Bailey Computer Consulting.
4018		Pyramid NILE running DC/OSx support from Earle F. Ake of
4019			Hassler Communication Systems Technology, Inc.
4020		HP-UX 10.x compile glitches, reported by Anne Brink of the
4021			U.S. Army and James Byrne of Harte & Lyne Limited.
4022		NetBSD from Matthew Green of the NetBSD crew.
4023		SCO 5.x from Keith Reynolds of SCO.
4024		IRIX 6.2 from Robert Tarrall of the University of
4025			Colorado and Kari Hurtta of the Finnish Meteorological
4026			Institute.
4027		UXP/DS (Fujitsu/ICL DS/90 series) support from Diego R.
4028			Lopez, CICA (Seville).
4029		NCR SVR4 MP-RAS 3.x support from Tom Moore of NCR.
4030		PTX 3.2.0 from Kenneth Stailey of the US Department of Labor
4031			Employment Standards Administration.
4032		Altos System V (5.3.1) from Tim Rice of Multitalents.
4033		Concurrent Systems Corporation Maxion from Donald R. Laster
4034			Jr.
4035		NetInfo maps (improved debugging and multi-valued aliases)
4036			from Adrian Steinmann of Steinmann Consulting.
4037		ConvexOS 11.5 (including SecureWare C2 and the Share Scheduler)
4038			from Eric Schnoebelen of Convex.
4039		Linux 2.0 mail.local patches from Horst von Brand.
4040		NEXTSTEP 3.x compilation from Robert La Ferla.
4041		NEXTSTEP 3.x code changes from Allan J. Nathanson of NeXT.
4042		Solaris 2.5 configuration fixes for mail.local by Jim Davis
4043			of the University of Arizona.
4044		Solaris 2.5 has a working setreuid.  Noted by David Linn of
4045			Vanderbilt University.
4046		Solaris changes for praliases, makemap, mailstats, and smrsh.
4047			Previously you had to add -DSOLARIS in Makefile.dist;
4048			this auto-detects.  Based on a patch from Randall
4049			Winchester of the University of Maryland.
4050	CONFIG: add generic-nextstep3.3.mc file.  Contributed by
4051		Robert La Ferla of Hot Software.
4052	CONFIG: allow mailertables to resolve to ``error:code message''
4053		(where "code" is an exit status) on domains (previously
4054		worked only on hosts).  Patch from Cor Bosman of Xs4all
4055		Foundation.
4056	CONFIG: hooks for IPv6-style domain literals.
4057	CONFIG: predefine ALIAS_FILE and change the prototype file so that
4058		if it is undefined the AliasFile option is never set; this
4059		should be transparent for most everyone.  Suggested by John
4060		Myers of CMU.
4061	CONFIG: add FEATURE(limited_masquerade).  Without this feature, any
4062		domain listed in $=w is masqueraded.  With it, only those
4063		domains listed in a MASQUERADE_DOMAIN macro are masqueraded.
4064	CONFIG: add FEATURE(masquerade_entire_domain).  This causes
4065		masquerading specified by MASQUERADE_DOMAIN to apply to all
4066		hosts under those domains as well as the domain headers
4067		themselves.  For example, if a configuration had
4068		MASQUERADE_DOMAIN(foo.com), then without this feature only
4069		foo.com would be masqueraded; with it, *.foo.com would be
4070		masqueraded as well.  Based on an implementation by Richard
4071		(Pug) Bainter of U. Texas.
4072	CONFIG: add FEATURE(genericstable) to do a more general rewriting of
4073		outgoing addresses.  Defaults to ``hash -o /etc/genericstable''.
4074		Keys are user names; values are outgoing mail addresses.  Yes,
4075		this does overlap with the user database, and figuring out
4076		just when to use which one may be tricky.  Based on code
4077		contributed by Richard (Pug) Bainter of U. Texas with updates
4078		from Per Hedeland of Ericsson.
4079	CONFIG: add FEATURE(virtusertable) to do generalized rewriting of
4080		incoming addresses.  Defaults to ``hash -o /etc/virtusertable''.
4081		Keys are either fully qualified addresses or just the host
4082		part (with the @ sign).  For example, a table containing:
4083			info@foo.com	foo-info
4084			info@bar.com	bar-info
4085			@baz.org	jane@elsewhere.net
4086		would send all mail destined for info@foo.com to foo-info
4087		(which is presumably an alias), mail addressed to info@bar.com
4088		to bar-info, and anything addressed to anyone at baz.org will
4089		be sent to jane@elsewhere.net.  The names foo.com, bar.com,
4090		and baz.org must all be in $=w.  Based on discussions with
4091		a great many people.
4092	CONFIG: add nullclient configurations to define SMTP_MAILER_FLAGS.
4093		Suggested by Richard Bainter.
4094	CONFIG: add FAX_MAILER_ARGS to tweak the arguments passed to the
4095		"fax" mailer.
4096	CONFIG: allow mailertable entries to resolve to local:user; this
4097		passes the original user@host in to procmail-style local
4098		mailers as the "detail" information to allow them to do
4099		additional clever processing.  From Joe Pruett of
4100		Teleport Corporation.  Delivery to the original user can
4101		be done by specifying "local:" (with nothing after the colon).
4102	CONFIG: allow any context that takes "mailer:domain" to also take
4103		"mailer:user@domain" to force mailing to the given user;
4104		"local:user" can also be used to do local delivery.  This
4105		applies on *_RELAY and in the mailertable entries.  Based
4106		on a suggestion by Ribert Kiessling of Easynet.
4107	CONFIG: Allow FEATURE(bestmx_is_local) to take an argument that
4108		limits the possible domains; this reduces the number of DNS
4109		lookups required to support this feature.  For example,
4110		FEATURE(bestmx_is_local, my.site.com) limits the lookups
4111		to domains under my.site.com.  Code contributed by Anthony
4112		Thyssen <anthony@cit.gu.edu.au>.
4113	CONFIG: LOCAL_RULESETS introduces any locally defined rulesets,
4114		such as the check_rcpt ruleset.  Suggested by Gregory Shapiro
4115		of WPI.
4116	CONFIG: MAILER_DEFINITIONS introduces any mailer definitions, in the
4117		event you have to define local mailers.  Suggested by
4118		Gregory Shapiro of WPI.
4119	CONFIG: fix cases where a three- (or more-) stage route-addr could
4120		be misinterpreted as a list:...; syntax.  Based on a patch by
4121		Vlado Potisk <Vlado_Potisk@tempest.sk>.
4122	CONFIG: Fix masquerading of UUCP addresses when the UUCP relay is
4123		remotely connected.  The address host!user was being
4124		converted to host!user@thishost instead of host!user@uurelay.
4125		Problem noted by William Gianopoulos of Raytheon Company.
4126	CONFIG: add confTO_ICONNECT to set Timeout.iconnect.
4127	CONFIG: change FEATURE(redirect) message from "User not local" to
4128		"User has moved"; the former wording was confusing if the
4129		new address is still on the local host.  Based on a suggestion
4130		by Andreas Luik.
4131	CONFIG: add support in FEATURE(nullclient) for $=E (exposed users).
4132		However, the class is not pre-initialized to contain root.
4133		Suggested by Gregory Neil Shapiro.
4134	CONTRIB: Remove XLA code at the request of the author, Christophe
4135		Wolfhugel.
4136	CONTRIB: Add re-mqueue.pl, contributed by Paul Pomes of Qualcomm.
4137	MAIL.LOCAL: make it possible to compile mail.local on Solaris.  Note
4138		well: this produces a slightly different mailbox format (no
4139		Content-Length: headers), file ownerships and modes are
4140		different (not owned by group mail; mode 600 instead of 660),
4141		and the local mailer flags will have to be tweaked (make them
4142		match bsd4.4) in order to use this mailer.  Patches from Paul
4143		Hammann of the Missouri Research and Education Network.
4144	MAIL.LOCAL: in some cases it could return EX_OK even though there
4145		was a delivery error, such as if the ownership on the file
4146		was wrong or the mode changed between the initial stat and
4147		the open.  Problem reported by William Colburn of the New
4148		Mexico Institute of Mining and Technology.
4149	MAILSTATS: handle zero length files more reliably.  Patch from Bryan
4150		Costales.
4151	MAILSTATS: add man page contributed by Keith Bostic of BSDI.
4152	MAKEMAP: The -d flag (to allow duplicate keys) to a btree map wasn't
4153		honored.  Fix from Michael Scott Shappe.
4154	PRALIASES: add man page contributed by Keith Bostic of BSDI.
4155	NEW FILES:
4156		src/Makefiles/Makefile.AIX.2
4157		src/Makefiles/Makefile.IRIX.6.2
4158		src/Makefiles/Makefile.maxion
4159		src/Makefiles/Makefile.NCR.MP-RAS.3.x
4160		src/Makefiles/Makefile.SCO.5.x
4161		src/Makefiles/Makefile.UXPDSV20
4162		mailstats/mailstats.8
4163		praliases/praliases.8
4164		cf/cf/generic-nextstep3.3.mc
4165		cf/feature/genericstable.m4
4166		cf/feature/limited_masquerade.m4
4167		cf/feature/masquerade_entire_domain.m4
4168		cf/feature/virtusertable.m4
4169		cf/ostype/aix2.m4
4170		cf/ostype/altos.m4
4171		cf/ostype/maxion.m4
4172		cf/ostype/solaris2.ml.m4
4173		cf/ostype/uxpds.m4
4174		contrib/re-mqueue.pl
4175	DELETED FILES:
4176		src/Makefiles/Makefile.Solaris
4177		contrib/xla/README
4178		contrib/xla/xla.c
4179	RENAMED FILES:
4180		src/Makefiles/Makefile.NCR3000 =>	Makefile.NCR.MP-RAS.2.x
4181		src/Makefiles/Makefile.SCO.3.2v4.2 =>	Makefile.SCO.4.2
4182		src/Makefiles/Makefile.UXPDS =>		Makefile.UXPDSV10
4183		src/Makefiles/Makefile.NeXT =>		Makefile.NeXT.2.x
4184		src/Makefiles/Makefile.NEXTSTEP =>	Makefile.NeXT.3.x
4185
41868.7.6/8.7.3	1996/09/17
4187	SECURITY: It is possible to force getpwuid to fail when writing the
4188		queue file, causing sendmail to fall back to running programs
4189		as the default user.  This is not exploitable from off-site.
4190		Workarounds include using a unique user for the DefaultUser
4191		(old u & g options) and using smrsh as the local shell.
4192	SECURITY: fix some buffer overruns; in at least one case this allows
4193		a local user to get root.  This is not known to be exploitable
4194		from off-site.  The workaround is to disable chfn(1) commands.
4195
41968.7.5/8.7.3	1996/03/04
4197	Fix glitch in 8.7.4 when putting certain internal lines; this can
4198		in some case cause connections to hang or messages to have
4199		extra spaces in odd places.  Patch from Eric Wassenaar;
4200		reports from Eric Hall of Chiron Corporation, Stephen
4201		Hansen of Stanford University, Dean Gaudet of HotWired,
4202		and others.
4203
42048.7.4/8.7.3	1996/02/18
4205	SECURITY: In some cases it was still possible for an attacker to
4206		insert newlines into a queue file, thus allowing access to
4207		any user (except root).
4208	CONFIG: no changes -- it is not a bug that the configuration
4209		version number is unchanged.
4210
42118.7.3/8.7.3	1995/12/03
4212	Fix botch in name server timeout in RCPT code; this problem caused
4213		two responses in SMTP, which breaks things horribly.  Fix
4214		from Gregory Neil Shapiro of WPI.
4215	Verify that L= value on M lines cannot be negative, which could cause
4216		negative array subscripting.  Not a security problem since
4217		this has to be in the config file, but it could have caused
4218		core dumps.  Pointed out by Bryan Costales.
4219	Fix -d21 debug output for long macro names.  Pointed out by Bryan
4220		Costales.
4221	PORTABILITY FIXES:
4222		SCO doesn't have ftruncate.  From Bill Aten of Computerizers.
4223		IBM's version of arpa/nameser.h defaults to the wrong byte
4224			order.  Tweak it to work properly.  Based on fixes
4225			from Fletcher Mattox of UTexas and Betty Lee of
4226			Stanford University.
4227	CONFIG: add confHOSTS_FILE m4 variable to set HostsFile option.
4228		Deficiency pointed out by Bryan Costales of ICSI.
4229
42308.7.2/8.7.2	1995/11/19
4231	REALLY fix the backslash escapes in SmtpGreetingMessage,
4232		OperatorChars, and UnixFromLine options.  They were not
4233		properly repaired in 8.7.1.
4234	Completely delete the Bcc: header if and only if there are other
4235		valid recipient headers (To:, Cc: or Apparently-To:, the
4236		last being a historic botch, of course).  If Bcc: is the
4237		only recipient header in the message, its value is tossed,
4238		but the header name is kept.  The old behavior (always keep
4239		the header name and toss the value) allowed primary recipients
4240		to see that a Bcc: went to _someone_.
4241	Include queue id on ``Authentication-Warning: <host>: <user> set
4242		sender to <address> using -f'' syslog messages.  Suggested
4243		by Kari Hurtta.
4244	If a sequence or switch map lookup entry gets a tempfail but then
4245		continues on to another map type, but the name is not found,
4246		return a temporary failure from the sequence or switch map.
4247		For example, if hosts search ``dns files'' and DNS fails
4248		with a tempfail, the hosts map will go on and search files,
4249		but if it fails the whole thing should be a tempfail, not
4250		a permanent (host unknown) failure, even though that is the
4251		failure in the hosts.files map.  This error caused hard
4252		bounces when it should have requeued.
4253	Aliases to files such as /users/bar/foo/inbox, with /users/bar/foo
4254		owned by bar mode 700 and inbox being setuid bar stopped
4255		working properly due to excessive paranoia.  Pointed out by
4256		John Hawkinson of Panix.
4257	An SMTP RCPT command referencing a host that gave a nameserver
4258		timeout would return a 451 command (8.6 accepted it and
4259		queued it locally).  Revert to the 8.6 behavior in order
4260		to simplify queue management for clustered systems.  Suggested
4261		by Gregory Neil Shapiro of WPI.  The same problem could break
4262		MH, which assumes that the SMTP session will succeed (tsk, tsk
4263		-- mail gets lost!); this was pointed out by Stuart Pook of
4264		Infobiogen.
4265	Fix possible buffer overflow in munchstring().  This was not a security
4266		problem because you couldn't specify any argument to this
4267		without first giving up root privileges, but it is still a
4268		good idea to avoid future problems.  Problem noted by John
4269		Hawkinson and Sam Hartman of MIT.
4270	``452 Out of disk space for temp file'' messages weren't being
4271		printed.  Fix from David Perlin of Nanosoft.
4272	Don't advertise the ESMTP DSN extension if the SendMimeErrors option
4273		is not set, since this is required to get the actual DSNs
4274		created.  Problem pointed out by John Gardiner Myers of CMU.
4275	Log permission problems that cause .forward and :include: files to
4276		be untrusted or ignored on log level 12 and higher.  Suggested
4277		by Randy Martin of Clemson University.
4278	Allow user ids in U= clauses of M lines to have hyphens and
4279		underscores.
4280	Fix overcounting of recipients -- only happened when sending to an
4281		alias.  Pointed out by Mark Andrews of SGI and Jack Woolley
4282		of Systems and Computer Technology Corporation.
4283	If a message is sent to an address that fails, the error message that
4284		is returned could show some extraneous "success" information
4285		included even if the user did not request success notification,
4286		which was confusing.  Pointed out by Allan Johannesen of WPI.
4287	Config files that had no AliasFile definition were defaulting to
4288		using /etc/aliases; this caused problems with nullclient
4289		configurations.  Change it back to the 8.6 semantics of
4290		having no local alias file unless it is declared.  Problem
4291		noted by Charles Karney of Princeton University.
4292	Fix compile problem if NOTUNIX is defined.  Pointed out by Bryan
4293		Costales of ICSI.
4294	Map lookups of class "userdb" maps were always case sensitive; they
4295		should be controlled by the -f flag like other maps.  Pointed
4296		out by Bjart Kvarme <bjart.kvarme@usit.uio.no>.
4297	Fix problem that caused some addresses to be passed through ruleset 5
4298		even when they were tagged as "sticky" by prefixing the
4299		address with an "@".  Patch from Thomas Dwyer III of Michigan
4300		Technological University.
4301	When converting a message to Quoted-Printable, prevent any lines with
4302		dots alone on a line by themselves.  This is because of the
4303		preponderance of broken mailers that still get this wrong.
4304		Code contributed by Per Hedeland of Ericsson.
4305	Fix F{macro}/file construct -- it previously did nothing.  Pointed
4306		out by Bjart Kvarme of USIT/UiO (Norway).
4307	Announce whether a cached connection is SMTP or ESMTP (in -v mode).
4308		Requested by Allan Johannesen.
4309	Delete check for text format of alias files -- it should be legal
4310		to have the database format of the alias files without the
4311		text version.  Problem pointed out by Joe Rhett of Navigist,
4312		Inc.
4313	If "Ot" was specified with no value, the TZ variable was not properly
4314		imported from the environment.  Pointed out by Frank Crawford
4315		<frank@ansto.gov.au>.
4316	Some architectures core dumped on "program" maps that didn't have
4317		extra arguments.  Patch from Booker C. Bense of Stanford
4318		University.
4319	Queue run processes would re-spawn daemons when given a SIGHUP; only
4320		the parent should do this.  Fix from Brian Coan of the
4321		Association for Progressive Communications.
4322	If MinQueueAge was set and a message was considered but not run
4323		during a queue run and the Timeout.queuereturn interval was
4324		reached, a "timed out" error message would be returned that
4325		didn't include the failed address (and claimed to be a warning
4326		even though it was fatal).  The fix is to not return such
4327		messages until they are actually tried, i.e., in the next
4328		MinQueueAge interval.  Problem noted by Rein Tollevik of
4329		SINTEF RUNIT, Oslo.
4330	Add HES_GETMAILHOST compile flag to support MIT Hesiod distributions
4331		that have the hes_getmailhost() routine.  DEC Hesiod
4332		distributions do not have this routine.  Based on a patch
4333		from Betty Lee of Stanford University.
4334	Extensive cleanups to map open code to handle a locking race condition
4335		in ndbm, hash, and btree format database files on some (most
4336		non-4.4-BSD based) OS architectures.  This should solve the
4337		occasional "user unknown" problem during alias rebuilds that
4338		has plagued me for quite some time.  Based on a patch from
4339		Thomas Dwyer III of Michigan Technological University.
4340	PORTABILITY FIXES:
4341		Solaris: Change location of newaliases and mailq from
4342			/usr/ucb to /usr/bin to match Sun settings.  From
4343			James B. Davis of TCI.
4344		DomainOS: Makefile.DomainOS doesn't require -ldbm.  From
4345			Don Lewis of Silicon Systems.
4346		HP-UX 10: rename Makefile.HP-UX.10 => Makefile.HP-UX.10.x
4347			so that the makesendmail script will find it.  Pointed
4348			out by Richard Allen of the University of Iceland.
4349			Also, use -Aa -D_HPUX_SOURCE instead of -Ae, which
4350			isn't supported on all compilers.
4351		UXPDS: compilation fixes from Diego R. Lopez.
4352	CONFIG: FAX mailer wasn't setting .FAX as a pseudo-domain unless
4353		you also had a FAX_RELAY.  From Thomas.Tornblom@Hax.SE.
4354	CONFIG: Minor glitch in S21 -- attachment of local domain name
4355		didn't have trailing dot.  From Jim Hickstein of Teradyne.
4356	CONFIG: Fix best_mx_is_local feature to allow nested addresses such as
4357		user%host@thishost.  From Claude Scarpelli of Infobiogen
4358		(France).
4359	CONFIG: OSTYPE(hpux10) failed to define the location of the help file.
4360		Pointed out by Hannu Martikka of Nokia Telecommunications.
4361	CONFIG: Diagnose some inappropriate ordering in configuration files,
4362		such as FEATURE(smrsh) listed after MAILER(local).  Based on
4363		a bug report submitted by Paul Hoffman of Proper Publishing.
4364	CONFIG: Make OSTYPE files consistently not override settings that
4365		have already been set.  Previously it worked differently
4366		for different files.
4367	CONFIG: Change relay mailer to do masquerading like 8.6 did.  My take
4368		is that this is wrong, but the change was causing problems
4369		for some people.  From Per Hedeland of Ericsson.
4370	CONTRIB: bitdomain.c patch from John Gardiner Myers <jgm+@CMU.EDU>;
4371		portability changes for Posix environments (no functional
4372		changes).
4373
43748.7.1/8.7.1	1995/10/01
4375	Old macros that have become options (SmtpGreetingMessage,
4376		OperatorChars, and UnixFromLine) didn't allow backslash
4377		escapes in the options, where they previously had.  Bug
4378		pointed out by John Hawkinson of MIT.
4379	Fix strange case of an executable called by a program map that
4380		returns a value but also a non-zero exit status; this
4381		would give contradictory results in the higher level; in
4382		particular, the default clause in the map lookup would be
4383		ignored.  Change to ignore the value if the program returns
4384		non-zero exit status.  From Tom Moore of AT&T GIS.
4385	Shorten parameters passed to syslog() in some contexts to avoid a
4386		bug in many vendors' implementations of that routine.  Although
4387		this isn't really a bug in sendmail per se, and my solution
4388		has to assume that syslog() has at least a 1K buffer size
4389		internally (I know some vendors have shortened this
4390		dramatically -- they're on their own), sendmail is a popular
4391		target.  Also, limit the size of %s arguments in sprintf.
4392		These both have possible security implications.  Solutions
4393		suggested by Casper Dik of Sun's Network Security Group
4394		(Holland), Mark Seiden, and others.
4395	Fix a problem that might cause a non-standard -B (body type)
4396		parameter to be passed to the next server with undefined
4397		results.  This could have security implications.
4398	If a filesystem was at > 100% utilization, the freediskspace()
4399		routine incorrectly returned an error rather than zero.
4400		Problem noted by G. Paul Ziemba of Alantec.
4401	Change MX sort order so that local hostnames (those in $=w) always
4402		sort first within a given preference.  This forces the bestmx
4403		map to always return the local host first, if it is included
4404		in the list of highest priority MX records.  From K. Robert
4405		Elz.
4406	Avoid some possible null pointer dereferences.  Fixes from Randy
4407		Martin <WOLF@CLEMSON.EDU>
4408	When sendmail starts up on systems that have no fully qualified
4409		domain name (FQDN) anywhere in the first matching host map
4410		(e.g., /etc/hosts if the hosts service searches "files dns"),
4411		sendmail would sleep to try to find a FQDN, which it really
4412		really needs.  This has been changed to fall through to the
4413		next map type if it can't find a FQDN -- i.e., if the hosts
4414		file doesn't have a FQDN, it will try dns even though the
4415		short name was found in /etc/hosts.  This is probably a crock,
4416		but many people have hosts files without FQDNs.  Remember:
4417		domain names are your friends.
4418	Log a high-priority message if you can't find your FQDN during startup.
4419		Suggested by Simon Barnes of Schlumberger Limited.
4420	When using Hesiod, initialize it early to improve error reporting.
4421		Patch from Don Lewis of Silicon Systems, Inc.
4422	Apparently at least some versions of Linux have a 90 !minute! TCP
4423		connection timeout in the kernel.  Add a new "connect" timeout
4424		to limit this time.  Defaults to zero (use whatever the
4425		kernel provides).  Based on code contributed by J.R. Oldroyd
4426		of TerraNet.
4427	Under some circumstances, a failed message would not be properly
4428		removed from the queue, causing tons of bogus error messages.
4429		(This fix eliminates the problematic EF_KEEPQUEUE flag.)
4430		Problem noted by Allan E Johannesen and Gregory Neil Shapiro
4431		of WPI.
4432	PORTABILITY FIXES:
4433		On IRIX 5.x, there was an inconsistency in the setting
4434			of sendmail.st location.  Change the Makefile to
4435			install it in /var/sendmail.st to match the OSTYPE
4436			file and SGI standards.  From Andre
4437			<andre@curry.zfe.siemens.de>.
4438		Support for Fujitsu/ICL UXP/DS (For the DS/90 Series)
4439			from Diego R. Lopez <drlopez@cica.es>.
4440		Linux compilation patches from J.R. Oldroyd of TerraNet, Inc.
4441		LUNA 2 Mach patches from Motonori Nakamura.
4442		SunOS Makefile was including -ldbm, which is for the old
4443			dbm library.  The ndbm library is part of libc.
4444	CONFIG: avoid bouncing ``user@host.'' (note trailing dot) with
4445		``local configuration error'' in nullclient configuration.
4446		Patch from Gregory Neil Shapiro of WPI.
4447	CONFIG: don't allow an alias file in nullclient configurations --
4448		since all addresses are relayed, they give errors during
4449		rebuild.  Suggested by Per Hedeland of Ericsson.
4450	CONFIG: local mailer on Solaris 2 should always get a -f flag because
4451		otherwise the F=S causes the From_ line to imply that root is
4452		the sender.  Problem pointed out by Claude Scarpelli of
4453		Infobiogen (France).
4454	NEW FILES:
4455		cf/feature/use_ct_file.m4 (omitted from 8.7 by mistake)
4456		src/Makefiles/Makefile.KSR (omitted from 8.7 by mistake)
4457		src/Makefiles/Makefile.UXPDS
4458
44598.7/8.7		1995/09/16
4460	Fix a problem that could cause sendmail to run out of file
4461		descriptors due to a trashed data structure after a
4462		vfork.  Fix from Brian Coan of the Institute for
4463		Global Communications.
4464	Change the VRFY response if you have disabled VRFY -- some
4465		people seemed to think that it was too rude.
4466	Avoid reference to uninitialized file descriptor if HASFLOCK
4467		was not defined.  This was used "safely" in the sense
4468		that it only did a stat, but it would have set the
4469		map modification time improperly.  Problem pointed out
4470		by Roy Mongiovi of Georgia Tech.
4471	Clean up the Subject: line on warning messages and return
4472		receipts so that they don't say "Returned mail:"; this
4473		can be confusing.
4474	Move ruleset entry/exit debugging from 21.2 to 21.1 -- this is
4475		useful enough to make it worthwhile printing on "-d".
4476	Avoid logging alias statistics every time you read the alias
4477		file on systems with no database method compiled in.
4478	If you have a name with a trailing dot, and you try looking it
4479		up using gethostbyname without the dot (for /etc/hosts
4480		compatibility), be sure to turn off RES_DEFNAMES and
4481		RES_DNSRCH to avoid finding the wrong name accidentally.
4482		Problem noted by Charles Amos of the University of
4483		Maryland.
4484	Don't do timeouts in collect if you are not running SMTP.
4485		There is nothing that says you can't have a long
4486		running program piped into sendmail (possibly via
4487		/bin/mail, which just execs sendmail).  Problem reported
4488		by Don "Truck" Lewis of Silicon Systems.
4489	Try gethostbyname() even if the DNS lookup fails iff option I
4490		is not set.  This allows you to have hosts listed in
4491		NIS or /etc/hosts that are not known to DNS.  It's normally
4492		a bad idea, but can be useful on firewall machines.  This
4493		should really be broken out on a separate flag, I suppose.
4494	Avoid compile warnings against BIND 4.9.3, which uses function
4495		prototypes.  From Don Lewis of Silicon Systems.
4496	Avoid possible incorrect diagnosis of DNS-related errors caused
4497		by things like attempts to resolve uucp names using
4498		$[ ... $] -- the fix is to clear h_errno at appropriate
4499		times.  From Kyle Jones of UUNET.
4500	SECURITY: avoid denial-of-service attacks possible by destroying
4501		the alias database file by setting resource limits low.
4502		This involves adding two new compile-time options:
4503		HASSETRLIMIT (indicating that setrlimit(2) support is
4504		available) and HASULIMIT (indicating that ulimit(2) support
4505		is available -- the Release 3 form is used).  The former
4506		is assumed on BSD-based systems, the latter on System
4507		V-based systems.  Attack noted by Phil Brandenberger of
4508		Swarthmore University.
4509	New syntaxes in test (-bt) mode:
4510		``.Dmvalue'' will define macro "m" to "value".
4511		``.Ccvalue'' will add "value" to class "c".
4512		``=Sruleset'' will dump the contents of the indicated
4513			ruleset.
4514		``=M'' will display the known mailers.
4515		``-ddebug-spec'' is equivalent to the command-line
4516			-d debug flag.
4517		``$m'' will print the value of macro $m.
4518		``$=c'' will print the contents of class $=c.
4519		``/mx host'' returns the MX records for ``host''.
4520		``/parse address'' will parse address, returning the value of
4521			crackaddr (essentially, the comment information)
4522			and the parsed address.
4523		``/try mailer address'' will rewrite address into the form
4524			it will have when presented to the indicated mailer.
4525		``/tryflags flags'' will set flags used by parsing.  The
4526			flags can be `H' for header or `E' for envelope,
4527			and `S' for sender or `R' for recipient.  These
4528			can be combined, so `HR' sets flags for header
4529			recipients.
4530		``/canon hostname'' will try to canonify hostname and
4531			return the result.
4532		``/map mapname key'' will look up `key' in the indicated
4533			`mapname' and return the result.
4534	Somewhat better handling of UNIX-domain socket addresses -- it
4535		should show the pathname rather than hex bytes.
4536	Restore ``-ba'' mode -- this reads a file from stdin and parses
4537		the header for envelope sender information and uses
4538		CR-LF as message terminators.  It was thought to be
4539		obsolete (used only for Arpanet NCP protocols), but it
4540		turns out that the UK ``Grey Book'' protocols require
4541		that functionality.
4542	Fix a fix in previous release -- if gethostname and gethostbyname
4543		return a name without dots, and if an attempt to canonify
4544		that name fails, wait one minute and try again.  This can
4545		result in an extra 60 second delay on startup if your system
4546		hostname (as returned by hostname(1)) has no dot and no names
4547		listed in /etc/hosts or your NIS map have a dot.
4548	Check for proper domain name on HELO and EHLO commands per
4549		RFC 1123 section 5.2.5.  Problem noted by Thomas Dwyer III
4550		of Michigan Technological University.
4551	Relax chownsafe rules slightly -- old version said that if you
4552		can't tell if _POSIX_CHOWN_RESTRICTED is set (that is,
4553		if fpathconf returned EINVAL or ENOSYS), assume that
4554		chown is not safe.  The new version falls back to whether
4555		you are on a BSD system or not.  This is important for
4556		SunOS, which apparently always returns one of those
4557		error codes.  This impacts whether you can mail to files
4558		or not.
4559	Syntax errors such as unbalanced parentheses in the configuration
4560		file could be omitted if you had "Oem" prior to the
4561		syntax error in the config file.  Change to always print
4562		the error message.  It was especially weird because it
4563		would cause a "warning" message to be sent to the Postmaster
4564		for every message sent (but with no transcript).  Problem
4565		noted by Gregory Paris of Motorola.
4566	Rewrite collect and putbody to handle full 8-bit data, including
4567		zero bytes.  These changes are internally extensive, but
4568		should have minimal impact on external function.
4569	Allow full words for option names -- if the option letter is
4570		(apparently) a space, then take the word following -- e.g.,
4571			O MatchGECOS=TRUE
4572		The full list of old and new names is as follows:
4573			7	SevenBitInput
4574			8	EightBitMode
4575			A	AliasFile
4576			a	AliasWait
4577			B	BlankSub
4578			b	MinFreeBlocks/MaxMessageSize
4579			C	CheckpointInterval
4580			c	HoldExpensive
4581			D	AutoRebuildAliases
4582			d	DeliveryMode
4583			E	ErrorHeader
4584			e	ErrorMode
4585			f	SaveFromLine
4586			F	TempFileMode
4587			G	MatchGECOS
4588			H	HelpFile
4589			h	MaxHopCount
4590			i	IgnoreDots
4591			I	ResolverOptions
4592			J	ForwardPath
4593			j	SendMimeErrors
4594			k	ConnectionCacheSize
4595			K	ConnectionCacheTimeout
4596			L	LogLevel
4597			l	UseErrorsTo
4598			m	MeToo
4599			n	CheckAliases
4600			O	DaemonPortOptions
4601			o	OldStyleHeaders
4602			P	PostmasterCopy
4603			p	PrivacyOptions
4604			Q	QueueDirectory
4605			q	QueueFactor
4606			R	DontPruneRoutes
4607			r, T	Timeout
4608			S	StatusFile
4609			s	SuperSafe
4610			t	TimeZoneSpec
4611			u	DefaultUser
4612			U	UserDatabaseSpec
4613			V	FallbackMXHost
4614			v	Verbose
4615			w	TryNullMXList
4616			x	QueueLA
4617			X	RefuseLA
4618			Y	ForkEachJob
4619			y	RecipientFactor
4620			z	ClassFactor
4621			Z	RetryFactor
4622		The old macros that passed information into sendmail have
4623		been changed to options; those correspondences are:
4624			$e	SmtpGreetingMessage
4625			$l	UnixFromLine
4626			$o	OperatorChars
4627			$q	(deleted -- not necessary)
4628		To avoid possible problems with an older sendmail,
4629		configuration level 6 is accepted by this version of
4630		sendmail; any config file using the new names should
4631		specify "V6" in the configuration.
4632	Change address parsing to properly note that a phrase before a
4633		colon and a trailing semicolon are essentially the same
4634		as text outside of angle brackets (i.e., sendmail should
4635		treat them as comments).  This is to handle the
4636		``group name: addr1, addr2, ..., addrN;'' syntax (it will
4637		assume that ``group name:'' is a comment on the first
4638		address and the ``;'' is a comment on the last address).
4639		This requires config file support to get right.  It does
4640		understand that :: is NOT this syntax, and can be turned
4641		off completely by setting the ColonOkInAddresses option.
4642	Level 6 config files added with new mailer flags:
4643		    A	Addresses are aliasable.
4644		    i	Do udb rewriting on envelope as well as header
4645			sender lines.  Applies to the from address mailer
4646			flags rather than the recipient mailer flags.
4647		    j	Do udb rewriting on header recipient addresses.
4648			Applies to the sender mailer flags rather than the
4649			recipient mailer flags.
4650		    k	Disable check for loops when doing HELO command.
4651		    o	Always run as the mail recipient, even on local
4652			delivery.
4653		    w	Check for an /etc/passwd entry for this user.
4654		    5	Pass addresses through ruleset 5.
4655		    :	Check for :include: on this address.
4656		    |	Check for |program on this address.
4657		    /	Check for /file on this address.
4658		    @	Look up sender header addresses in the user
4659			database.  Applies to the mailer flags for the
4660			mailer corresponding to the envelope sender
4661			address, rather than to recipient mailer flags.
4662		Pre-level 6 configuration files set A, w, 5, :, |, /, and @
4663		on the "local" mailer, the o flag on the "prog" and "*file*"
4664		mailers, and the ColonOkInAddresses option.
4665	Eight-to-seven bit MIME conversions.  This borrows ideas from
4666		John Beck of Hewlett-Packard, who generously contributed
4667		their implementation to me, which I then didn't use (see
4668		mime.c for an explanation of why).  This adds the
4669		EightBitMode option (a.k.a. `8') and an F=8 mailer flag
4670		to control handling of 8-bit data.  These have to cope with
4671		two types of 8-bit data: unlabelled 8-bit data (that is,
4672		8-bit data that is entered without declaring it as 8-bit
4673		MIME -- technically this is illegal according to the
4674		specs) and labelled 8-bit data (that is, it was declared
4675		as 8BITMIME in the ESMTP session or by using the
4676		-B8BITMIME command line flag).  If the F=8 mailer flag is
4677		set then 8-bit data is sent to non-8BITMIME machines
4678		instead of converting to 7 bit (essentially using
4679		just-send-8 semantics).  The values for EightBitMode are:
4680		    m	convert unlabelled 8-bit input to 8BITMIME, and do
4681			any necessary conversion of 8BITMIME to 7BIT
4682			(essentially, the full MIME option).
4683		    p	pass unlabelled 8-bit input, but convert labelled
4684			8BITMIME input to 7BIT as required (default).
4685		    s	strict adherence: reject unlabelled 8-bit input,
4686			convert 8BITMIME to 7BIT as required.  The F=8
4687			flag is ignored.
4688		Unlabelled 8-bit data is rejected in mode `s' regardless of
4689			the setting of F=8.
4690	Add new internal class 'n', which is the set of MIME Content-Types
4691		which can not be 8 to 7 bit encoded because of other
4692		considerations.  Types "multipart/*" and "message/*" are
4693		never directly encoded (although their components can be).
4694	Add new internal class 's', which is the set of subtypes of the
4695		MIME message/* content type that can be treated as though
4696		they are an RFC822 message.  It is predefined to have
4697		"rfc822".  Suggested By Kari Hurtta.
4698	Add new internal class 'e'.  This is the set of MIME
4699		Content-Transfer-Encodings that can be converted to
4700		a seven bit format (Quoted-Printable or Base64).  It is
4701		preinitialized to contain "7bit", "8bit", and "binary".
4702	Add C=charset mailer parameter and the the DefaultCharSet option (no
4703		short name) to set the default character set to use in the
4704		Content-Type: header when doing encoding of an 8-bit message
4705		which isn't marked as MIME into MIME format.  If the C=
4706		parameter is set on the Envelope From address, use that as
4707		the default encoding; else use the DefaultCharSet option.
4708		If neither is set, it defaults to "unknown-8bit" as
4709		suggested by RFC 1428 section 3.
4710	Allow ``U=user:group'' field in mailer definition to set a default
4711		user and group that a mailer will be executed as.  This
4712		overrides the 'u' and 'g' options, and if the `F=S' flag is
4713		also set, it is the uid/gid that will always be used (that
4714		is, the controlling address is ignored).  The values may be
4715		numeric or symbolic; if only a symbolic user is given (no
4716		group) that user's default group in the passwd file is used
4717		as the group.  Based on code donated by Chip Rosenthal of
4718		Unicom.
4719	Allow `u' option to also accept user:group as a value, in the same
4720		fashion as the U= mailer option.
4721	Add the symbolic time zone name in the Arpanet format dates (as
4722		a comment).  This adds a new compile-time configuration
4723		flag: TZ_TYPE can be set to TZ_TM_NAME (use the value
4724		of (struct tm *)->tm_name), TZ_TM_ZONE (use the value
4725		of (struct tm *)->tm_zone), TZ_TZNAME (use extern char
4726		*tzname[(struct tm *)->tm_isdst]), TZ_TIMEZONE (use
4727		timezone()), or TZ_NONE (don't include the comment).  Code
4728		from Chip Rosenthal.
4729	The "Timeout" option (formerly "r") is extended to allow suboptions.
4730		For example,
4731		    O Timeout.helo = 2m
4732		There are also two new suboptions "queuereturn" and
4733		"queuewarn"; these subsume the old T option.  Thus, to
4734		set them both the preferred new syntax is
4735		    O Timeout.queuereturn = 5d
4736		    O Timeout.queuewarn = 4h
4737	Sort queue by host name instead of by message priority if the
4738		QueueSortOrder option (no short name) is set is set to
4739		``host''.  This makes better use of the connection cache,
4740		but may delay more ``interactive'' messages behind large
4741		backlogs under some circumstances.  This is probably a
4742		good option if you have high speed links or don't do lots
4743		of ``batch'' messages, but less good if you are using
4744		something like PPP on a 14.4 modem.  Based on code
4745		contributed by Roy Mongiovi of Georgia Tech (my main
4746		contribution was to make it configurable).
4747	Save i-number of df file in qf file to simplify rebuilding of queue
4748		after disastrous disk crash.  Suggested by Kyle Jones of
4749		UUNET; closely based on code from KJS DECWRL code written
4750		by Paul Vixie.  NOTA BENE: The qf files produced by 8.7
4751		are NOT back compatible with 8.6 -- that is, you can convert
4752		from 8.6 to 8.7, but not the other direction.
4753	Add ``F=d'' mailer flag to disable all use of angle brackets in
4754		route-addrs in envelopes; this is because in some cases
4755		they can be sent to the shell, which interprets them as
4756		I/O redirection.
4757	Don't include error file (option E) with return-receipts; this
4758		can be confusing.
4759	Don't send "Warning: cannot send" messages to owner-* or
4760		*-request addresses.  Suggested by Christophe Wolfhugel
4761		of the Institut Pasteur, Paris.
4762	Allow -O command line flag to set long form options.
4763	Add "MinQueueAge" option to set the minimum time between attempts
4764		to run the queue.  For example, if the queue interval
4765		(-q value) is five minutes, but the minimum queue age
4766		is fifteen minutes, jobs won't be tried more often than
4767		once every fifteen minutes.  This can be used to give
4768		you more responsiveness if your delivery mode is set to
4769		queue-only.
4770	Allow "fileopen" timeout (default: 60 seconds) for opening
4771		:include: and .forward files.
4772	Add "-k", "-v", and "-z" flags to map definitions; these set the
4773		key field name, the value field name, and the field
4774		delimiter.  The field delimiter can be a single character
4775		or the sequence "\t" or "\n" for tab or newline.
4776		These are for use by NIS+ and similar access methods.
4777	Change maps to always strip quotes before lookups; the -q flag
4778		turns off this behavior.  Suggested by Motonori Nakamura.
4779	Add "nisplus" map class.  Takes -k and -v flags to choose the
4780		key and value field names respectively.  Code donated by
4781		Sun Microsystems.
4782	Add "hesiod" map class.  The "file name" is used as the
4783		"HesiodNameType" parameter to hes_resolve(3).  Returns the
4784		first value found for the match.  Code donated by Scott
4785		Hutton of Indiana University.
4786	Add "netinfo" (NeXT NetInfo) map class.  Maps can have a -k flag to
4787		specify the name of the property that is searched as the
4788		key and a -v flag to specify the name of the property that
4789		is returned as the value (defaults to "members").  The
4790		default map is "/aliases".  Some code based on code
4791		contributed by Robert La Ferla of Hot Software.
4792	Add "text" map class.  This does slow, linear searches through
4793		text files.  The -z flag specifies a column delimiter
4794		(defaults to any sequence of white space), the -k flag
4795		sets the key column number, and the -v flag sets the
4796		value column number.  Lines beginning with `#' are treated
4797		as comments.
4798	Add "program" map class to execute arbitrary programs.  The search
4799		key is presented as the last argument; the output is one
4800		line read from the programs standard output.  Exit statuses
4801		are from sysexits.h.
4802	Add "sequence" map class -- searches maps in sequence until it
4803		finds a match.  For example, the declarations:
4804		    Kmap1 ...
4805		    Kmap2 ...
4806		    Kmapseq sequence map1 map2
4807		defines a map "mapseq" that first searches map1; if the
4808		value is found it is returned immediately, otherwise
4809		map2 is searched and the value returned.
4810	Add "switch" map class.  This is much like "sequence" except that
4811		the ordering is fetched from an external file, usually
4812		the system service switch.  The parameter is the name of
4813		the service to switch on, and the maps that it will use
4814		are the name of the switch map followed by ".service_type".
4815		For example, if the declaration of the map is
4816		    Ksample switch hosts
4817		and the system service switch specifies that hosts are
4818		looked up using dns and nis in that order, then this is
4819		equivalent to
4820		    Ksample sequence sample.dns sample.nis
4821		The subordinate maps (sample.*) must already be defined.
4822	Add "user" map class -- looks up users using getpwnam.  Takes a
4823		"-v field" flag on the definition that tells what passwd
4824		entry to return -- legal values are name, passwd, uid, gid,
4825		gecos, dir, and shell.  Generally expected to be used with
4826		the -m (matchonly) flag.
4827	Add "bestmx" map class -- returns the best MX value for the host
4828		listed as the value.  If there are several "best" MX records
4829		for this host, one will be chosen at random.
4830	Add "userdb" map class -- looks up entries in the user database.
4831		The "file name" is actually the tag that will be used,
4832		typically "mailname".  If there are multiple entries
4833		matching the name, the one chosen is undefined.
4834	Add multiple queue timeouts (both return and warning).  These are
4835		set by the Precedence: or Priority: header fields to one of
4836		three values.  If a Priority: is set and has value "normal",
4837		"urgent", or "non-urgent" the corresponding timeouts are
4838		used.  If no priority is set, the Precedence: is consulted;
4839		if negative, non-urgent timeouts are used; if greater than
4840		zero, urgent timeouts are used.  Otherwise, normal timeouts
4841		are used.  The timeouts are set by setting the six timeouts
4842		queue{warn,return}.{urgent,normal,non-urgent}.
4843	Fix problem when a mail address is resolved to a $#error mailer
4844		with a temporary failure indication; it works in SMTP,
4845		but when delivering locally the mail is silently discarded.
4846		This patch, from Kyle Jones of UUNET, bounces it instead
4847		of queueing it (queueing is very hard).
4848	When using /etc/hosts or NIS-style lookups, don't assume that
4849		the first name in the list is the best one -- instead,
4850		search for the first one with a dot.  For example, if
4851		an /etc/hosts entry reads
4852		    128.32.149.68	mammoth mammoth.CS.Berkeley.EDU
4853		this change will use the second name as the canonical
4854		machine name instead of the initial, unqualified name.
4855	Change dequote map to replace spaces in quoted text with a value
4856		indicated by the -s flag on the dequote map definition.
4857		For example, ``Mdequote dequote -s_'' will change
4858		"Foo Bar" into an unquoted Foo_Bar instead of leaving it
4859		quoted (because of the space character).  Suggested by Dan
4860		Oscarsson for use in X.400 addresses.
4861	Implement long macro names as ${name}; long class names can
4862		be similarly referenced as $={name} and $~{name}.
4863		Definitions are (e.g.) ``D{name}value''.  Names that have
4864		a leading lower case letter or punctuation characters are
4865		reserved for internal use by sendmail; i.e., config files
4866		should use names that begin with a capital letter.  Based
4867		on code contributed by Dan Oscarsson.
4868	Fix core dump if getgrgid returns a null group list (as opposed
4869		to an empty group list, that is, a pointer to a list
4870		with no members).  Fix from Andrew Chang of Sun Microsystems.
4871	Fix possible core dump if malloc fails -- if the malloc in xalloc
4872		failed, it called syserr which called newstr which called
4873		xalloc....  The newstr is now avoided for "panic" messages.
4874		Reported by Stuart Kemp of James Cook University.
4875	Improve connection cache timeouts; previously, they were not even
4876		checked if you were delivering to anything other than an
4877		IPC-connected host, so a series of (say) local mail
4878		deliveries could cause cached connections to be open
4879		much longer than the specified timeout.
4880	If an incoming message exceeds the maximum message size, stop
4881		writing the incoming bytes to the queue data file, since
4882		this can fill your mqueue partition -- this is a possible
4883		denial-of-service attack.
4884	Don't reject all numeric local user names unless HESIOD is
4885		defined.  It turns out that Posix allows all-numeric
4886		user names.  Fix from Tony Sanders of BSDI.
4887	Add service switch support.  If the local OS has a service
4888		switch (e.g., /etc/nsswitch.conf on Solaris or /etc/svc.conf
4889		on DEC systems) that will be used; otherwise, it falls back
4890		to using a local mechanism based on the ServiceSwitchFile
4891		option (default: /etc/service.switch).  For example, if the
4892		service switch lists "files" and "nis" for the aliases
4893		service, that will be the default lookup order.  the "files"
4894		("local" on DEC) service type expands to any alias files
4895		you listed in the configuration file, even if they aren't
4896		actually file lookups.
4897	Option I (NameServerOptions) no longer sets the "UseNameServer"
4898		variable which tells whether or not DNS should be considered
4899		canonical.  This is now determined based on whether or not
4900		"dns" is in the service list for "hosts".
4901	Add preliminary support for the ESMTP "DSN" extension (Delivery
4902		Status Notifications).  DSN notifications override
4903		Return-Receipt-To: headers, which are bogus anyhow --
4904		support for them has been removed.
4905	Add T=mts-name-type/address-type/diagnostic-type keyletter to mailer
4906		definitions to define the types used in DSN returns for
4907		MTA names, addresses, and diagnostics respectively.
4908	Extend heuristic to force running in ESMTP mode to look for the
4909		five-character string "ESMTP" anywhere in the 220 greeting
4910		message (not just the second line).  This is to provide
4911		better compatibility with other ESMTP servers.
4912	Print sequence number of job when running the queue so you can
4913		easily see how much progress you have made.  Suggested
4914		by Peter Wemm of DIALix.
4915	Map newlines to spaces in logged message-ids; some versions of
4916		syslog truncate the rest of the line after newlines.
4917		Suggested by Fletcher Mattox of U. Texas.
4918	Move up forking for job runs so that if a message is split into
4919		multiple envelopes you don't get "fork storms" -- this
4920		also improves the connection cache utilization.
4921	Accept "<<>>", "<<<>>>", and so forth as equivalent to "<>" for
4922		the purposes of refusing to send error returns.  Suggested
4923		by Motonori Nakamura of Ritsumeikan University.
4924	Relax rules on when a file can be written when referenced from
4925		the aliases file: use the default uid/gid instead of the
4926		real uid/gid.  This allows you to create a file owned by
4927		and writable only by the default uid/gid that will work
4928		all the time (without having the setuid bit set).  Change
4929		suggested by Shau-Ping Lo and Andrew Cheng of Sun
4930		Microsystems.
4931	Add "DialDelay" option (no short name) to provide an "extra"
4932		delay for dial on demand systems.  If this is non-zero
4933		and a connect fails, sendmail will wait this long and
4934		then try again.  If it takes longer than the kernel
4935		timeout interval to establish the connection, this
4936		option can give the network software time to establish
4937		the link.  The default units are seconds.
4938	Move logging of sender information to be as early as possible;
4939		previously, it could be delayed a while for SMTP mail
4940		sent to aliases.  Suggested by Brad Knowles of the
4941		Defense Information Systems Agency.
4942	Call res_init() before setting RES_DEBUG; this is required by
4943		BIND 4.9.3, or so I'm told.  From Douglas Anderson of
4944		the National Computer Security Center.
4945	Add xdelay= field in logs -- this is a transaction delay, telling
4946		you how long it took to deliver to this address on the
4947		last try.  It is intended to be used for sorting mailing
4948		lists to favor "quick" addresses.  Provided for use by
4949		the mailprio scripts (see below).
4950	If a map cannot be opened, and that map is non-optional, and
4951		an address requires that map for resolution, queue the
4952		map instead of bouncing it.  This involves creating a
4953		pseudo-class of maps called "bogus-map" -- if a required
4954		map cannot be opened, the class is changed to bogus-map;
4955		all queries against bogus-map return "tempfail".  The
4956		bogus-map class is not directly accessible.  A sample
4957		implementation was donated by Jem Taylor of Glasgow
4958		University Computing Service.
4959	Fix a possible core dump when mailing to a program that talks
4960		SMTP on its standard input.  Fix from Keith Moore of
4961		the University of Kentucky.
4962	Make it possible to resolve filenames to $#local $: @ /filename;
4963		previously, the "@" would cause it to not be recognized
4964		as a file.  Problem noted by Brian Hill of U.C. Davis.
4965	Accept a -1 signal to re-exec the daemon.  This only works if
4966		argv[0] is a full path to sendmail.
4967	Fix bug in "addr=..." field in O option on little-endian machines
4968		-- the network number wasn't being converted to network
4969		byte order.  Patch from Kurt Lidl of Pix Technologies
4970		Corporation.
4971	Pre-initialize the resolver early on; this is to avoid a bug with
4972		BIND 4.9.3 that can cause the _res.retry field to get
4973		reset to zero, causing all name server lookups to time
4974		out.  Fix from Matt Day of Artisoft.
4975	Restore T line (trusted users) in config file -- but instead of
4976		locking out the -f flag, they just tell whether or not
4977		an X-Authentication-Warning: will be added.  This really
4978		just creates new entries in class 't', so "Ft/file/name"
4979		can be used to read trusted user names from a file.
4980		Trusted users are also allowed to execute programs even
4981		if they have a shell that isn't in /etc/shells.
4982	Improve NEWDB alias file rebuilding so it will create them
4983		properly if they do not already exist.  This had been
4984		a MAYBENEXTRELEASE feature in 8.6.9.
4985	Check for @:@ entry in NIS maps before starting up to avoid
4986		(but not prevent, sigh) race conditions.  This ought to
4987		be handled properly in ypserv, but isn't.  Suggested by
4988		Michael Beirne of Motorola.
4989	Refuse connections if there isn't enough space on the filesystem
4990		holding the queue.  Contributed by Robert Dana of Wolf
4991		Communications.
4992	Skip checking for directory permissions in the path to a file
4993		when checking for file permissions iff setreuid()
4994		succeeded -- it is unnecessary in that case.  This avoids
4995		significant performance problems when looking for .forward
4996		files.  Based on a suggestion by Win Bent of USC.
4997	Allow symbolic ruleset names.  Syntax can be "Sname" to get an
4998		arbitrary ruleset number assigned or "Sname = integer"
4999		to assign a specific ruleset number.  Reference is
5000		$>name_or_number.  Names can be composed of alphas, digits,
5001		underscore, or hyphen (first character must be non-numeric).
5002	Allow -o flag on AliasFile lines to make the alias file optional.
5003		From Bryan Costales of ICSI.
5004	Add NoRecipientAction option to handle the case where there is
5005		no legal recipient header in the message.  It can take
5006		on values:
5007		  None			Leave the message as is.  The
5008					message will be passed on even
5009					though it is in technically
5010					illegal syntax.
5011		  Add-To		Add a To: header with any
5012					recipients that it can find from
5013					the envelope.  This risks exposing
5014					Bcc: recipients.
5015		  Add-Apparently-To	Add an Apparently-To: header.  This
5016					has almost no redeeming social value,
5017					and is provided only for back
5018					compatibility.
5019		  Add-To-Undisclosed	Add a header reading
5020					To: undisclosed-recipients:;
5021					which will have the effect of
5022					making the message legal without
5023					exposing Bcc: recipients.
5024		  Add-Bcc		To add an empty Bcc: header.
5025					There is a chance that mailers down
5026					the line will delete this header,
5027					which could cause exposure of Bcc:
5028					recipients.
5029		The default is NoRecipientAction=None.
5030	Truncate (rather than delete) Bcc: lines in the header.  This
5031		should prevent later sendmails (at least, those that don't
5032		themselves delete Bcc:) from considering this message to
5033		be non-conforming -- although it does imply that non-blind
5034		recipients can see that a Bcc: was sent, albeit not to whom.
5035	Add SafeFileEnvironment option.  If declared, files named as delivery
5036		targets must be regular files in addition to the regular
5037		checks.  Also, if the option is non-null then it is used as
5038		the name of a directory that is used as a chroot(2)
5039		environment for the delivery; the file names listed in an
5040		alias or forward should include the name of this root.
5041		For example, if you run with
5042			O SafeFileEnvironment=/arch
5043		then aliases should reference "/arch/rest/of/path".  If a
5044		value is given, sendmail also won't try to save to
5045		/usr/tmp/dead.letter (instead it just leaves the job in the
5046		queue as Qfxxxxxx).  Inspired by *Hobbit*'s sendmail patch kit.
5047	Support -A flag for alias files; this will comma concatenate like
5048		entries.  For example, given the aliases:
5049			list: member1
5050			list: member2
5051		and an alias file declared as:
5052			OAhash:-A /etc/aliases
5053		the final alias inserted will be "list: member1,member2";
5054		without -A you will get an error on the second and subsequent
5055		alias for "list".  Contributed by Bryan Costales of ICSI.
5056	Line-buffer transcript file.  Suggested by Liudvikas Bukys.
5057	Fix a problem that could cause very long addresses to core dump in
5058		some special circumstances.  Problem pointed out by Allan
5059		Johannesen.
5060	(Internal change.)  Change interface to expand() (macro expansion)
5061		to be simpler and more consistent.
5062	Delete check for funny qf file names.  This didn't really give
5063		any extra security and caused some people some problems.
5064		(If you -really- want this, define PICKY_QF_NAME_CHECK
5065		at compile time.)  Suggested by Kyle Jones of UUNET.
5066	(Internal change.)  Change EF_NORETURN to EF_NO_BODY_RETN and
5067		merge with DSN code; this is simpler and more consistent.
5068		This may affect some people who have written their own
5069		checkcompat() routine.
5070	(Internal change.)  Eliminate `D' line in qf file.  The df file
5071		is now assumed to be the same name as the qf file (with
5072		the `q' changed to a `d', of course).
5073	Avoid forking for delivery if all recipient mailers are marked as
5074		"expensive" -- this can be a major cost on some systems.
5075		Essentially, this forces sendmail into "queue only" mode
5076		if all it is going to do is queue anyway.
5077	Avoid sending a null message in some rather unusual circumstances
5078		(specifically, the RCPT command returns a temporary
5079		failure but the connection is lost before the DATA
5080		command).  Fix from Scott Hammond of Secure Computing
5081		Corporation.
5082	Change makesendmail to use a somewhat more rational naming scheme:
5083		Makefiles and obj directories are named $os.$rel.$arch,
5084		where $os is the operating system (e.g., SunOS), $rel is
5085		the release number (e.g., 5.3), and $arch is the machine
5086		architecture (e.g., sun4).  Any of these can be omitted,
5087		and anything after the first dot in a release number can
5088		be replaced with "x" (e.g., SunOS.4.x.sun4).  The previous
5089		version used $os.$arch.$rel and was rather less general.
5090	Change makesendmail to do a "make depend" in the target directory
5091		when it is being created.  This involves adding an empty
5092		"depend:" entry in most Makefiles.
5093	Ignore IDENT return value if the OSTYPE field returns "OTHER",
5094		as indicated by RFC 1413.  Pointed out by Kari Hurtta
5095		of the Finnish Meteorological Institute.
5096	Fix problem that could cause multiple responses to DATA command
5097		on header syntax errors (e.g., lines beginning with colons).
5098		Problem noted by Jens Thomassen of the University of Oslo.
5099	Don't let null bytes in headers cause truncation of the rest of
5100		the header.
5101	Log Authentication-Warning:s.  Suggested by Motonori Nakamura.
5102	Increase timeouts on message data puts to allow time for receivers
5103		to canonify addresses in headers on the fly.  This is still
5104		a rather ugly heuristic.  From Motonori Nakamura.
5105	Add "HasWildcardMX" suboption to ResolverOptions; if set, MX
5106		records are not used when canonifying names, and when MX
5107		lookups are done for addressing they must be fully
5108		qualified.  This is useful if you have a wildcard MX record,
5109		although it may cause other problems.  In general, don't use
5110		wildcard MX records.  Patch from Motonori Nakamura.
5111	Eliminate default two-line SMTP greeting message.  Instead of
5112		adding an extra "ESMTP spoken here" line, the word "ESMTP"
5113		is added between the first and second word of the first
5114		line of the greeting message (i.e., immediately after the
5115		host name).  This eliminates the need for the BROKEN_SMTP_PEERS
5116		compile flag.  Old sendmails won't see the ESMTP, but that's
5117		acceptable because SIZE was the only useful extension that
5118		old sendmails understand.
5119	Avoid gethostbyname calls on UNIX domain sockets during SIGUSR1
5120		invoked state dumps.  From Masaharu Onishi.
5121	Allow on-line comments in .forward and :include: files; they are
5122		introduced by the string "<LWSP>#@#<LWSP>", where <LWSP>
5123		is a space or a tab.  This is intended for native
5124		representation of non-ASCII sets such as Japanese, where
5125		existing encodings would be unreadable or would lose
5126		data -- for example,
5127		 <motonori@cs.ritsumei.ac.jp> NAKAMURA Motonori
5128					(romanized/less information)
5129		 <motonori@cs.ritsumei.ac.jp> =?ISO-2022-JP?B?GyRCQ2ZCPBsoQg==?=
5130					      =?ISO-2022-JP?B?GyRCQUdFNRsoQg==?=
5131					(with MIME encoding, not human readable)
5132		 <motonori@cs.ritsumei.ac.jp> #@# ^[$BCfB<^[(B ^[$BAGE5^[(B
5133					(native encoding with ISO-2022-JP)
5134		The last form is human readable in the Japanese environment.
5135		Based on a fix from (surprise!) Motonori Nakamura.
5136	Don't make SMTP error returns on MAIL FROM: line be "sticky" for all
5137		messages to that host; these are most frequently associated
5138		with addresses rather than the host, with the exception of
5139		421 (service shutting down).  The effect was to cause queues
5140		to sometimes take an excessive time to flush.  Reported by
5141		Robert Sargent of Southern Geographics Technologies and
5142		Eric Prestemon of American University.
5143	Add Nice=N mailer option to set the niceness at which a mailer will
5144		run.  This is actually a relative niceness (that is, an
5145		increment on the background value).
5146	Log queue runs that are skipped due to high loads.  They are logged
5147		at LOG_INFO priority iff the log level is > 8.  Contributed
5148		by Bruce Nagel of Data General.
5149	Allow the error mailer to accept a DSN-style error status code
5150		instead of an sysexits status code in the host part.
5151		Anything with a dot will be interpreted as a DSN-style code.
5152	Add new mailer flag: F=3 will tell translations to Quoted-Printable
5153		to encode characters that might be munged by an EBCDIC system
5154		in addition to the set required by RFC 1521.  The additional
5155		characters are !, ", #, $, @, [, \, ], ^, `, {, |, }, and ~.
5156		(Think of "IBM 360" as the mnemonic for this flag.)
5157	Change check for mailing to files to look for a pathname of [FILE]
5158		rather than looking for the mailer named *file*.  The mapping
5159		of leading slashes still goes to the *file* mailer.  This
5160		allows you to implement the *file* mailer as a separate
5161		program, for example, to insert a Content-Length: header
5162		or do special security policy.  However, note that the usual
5163		initial checking for the file permissions is still done, and
5164		the program in question needs to be very careful about how
5165		it does the file write to avoid security problems.
5166	Be able to read ~root/.forward even if the path isn't accessible to
5167		regular users.  This is disrecommended because sendmail
5168		sometimes does not run as root (e.g., when an unsafe option
5169		is specified on the command line), but should otherwise be
5170		safe because .forward files must be owned by the user for
5171		whom mail is being forwarded, and cannot be a symbolic link.
5172		Suggested by Forrest Aldrich of Wang Laboratories.
5173	Add new "HostsFile" option that is the pathname to the /etc/hosts
5174		file.  This is used for canonifying hostnames when the
5175		service type is "files".
5176	Implement programs on F (read class from file) line.  The syntax is
5177		Fc|/path/to/program to read the output from the program
5178		into class "c".
5179	Probe the network interfaces to find alternate names for this
5180		host.  Requires the SIOCGIFCONF ioctl call.  Code
5181		contributed by SunSoft.
5182	Add "E" configuration line to set or propagate environment
5183		variables into children.  "E<envar>" will propagate
5184		the named variable from the environment when sendmail
5185		was invoked into any children it calls; "E<envar>=<value>"
5186		sets the named variable to the indicated value.  Any
5187		variables not explicitly named will not be in the child
5188		environment.  However, sendmail still forces an
5189		"AGENT=sendmail" environment variable, in part to enforce
5190		at least one environment variable, since many programs and
5191		libraries die horribly if this is not guaranteed.
5192	Change heuristic for rebuilding both NEWDB and NDBM versions of
5193		alias databases -- new algorithm looks for the substring
5194		"/yp/" in the file name.  This is more portable and involves
5195		less overhead.  Suggested by Motonori Nakamura.
5196	Dynamically allocate the queue work list so that you don't lose
5197		jobs in large queue runs.  The old QUEUESIZE compile parameter
5198		is replaced by QUEUESEGSIZE (the unit of allocation, which
5199		should not need to be changed) and the MaxQueueRunSize option,
5200		which is the absolute maximum number of jobs that will ever
5201		be handled in a single queue run.  Based on code contributed
5202		by Brian Coan of the Institute for Global Communications.
5203	Log message when a message is dropped because it exceeds the maximum
5204		message size.  Suggested by Leo Bicknell of Virginia Tech.
5205	Allow trusted users (those on a T line or in $=t) to use -bs without
5206		an X-Authentication-Warning: added.  Suggested by Mark Thomas
5207		of Mark G. Thomas Consulting.
5208	Announce state of compile flags on -d0.1 (-d0.10 throws in the
5209		OS-dependent defines).  The old semantic of -d0.1 to not
5210		run the daemon in background has been moved to -d99.100,
5211		and the old 52.5 flag (to avoid disconnect() from closing
5212		all output files) has been moved to 52.100.  This makes
5213		things more consistent (flags below .100 don't change
5214		semantics) and separates out the backgrounding so that
5215		it doesn't happen automatically on other unrelated debugging
5216		flags.
5217	If -t is used but no addresses are found in the header, give an
5218		error message rather than just doing nothing.  Fix from
5219		Motonori Nakamura.
5220	On systems (like SunOS) where the effective gid is not necessarily
5221		included in the group list returned by getgroups(), the
5222		`restrictmailq' option could sometimes cause an authorized
5223		user to not be able to use `mailq'.  Fix from Charles Hannum
5224		of MIT.
5225	Allow symbolic service names for [IPC] mailers.  Suggested by
5226		Gerry Magennis of Logica International.
5227	Add DontExpandCnames option to prevent $[ ... $] from expanding CNAMEs
5228		when running DNS.  For example, if the name FTP.Foo.ORG is
5229		a CNAME for Cruft.Foo.ORG, then when sitting on a machine in
5230		the Foo.ORG domain a lookup of "FTP" returns "Cruft.Foo.ORG"
5231		if this option is not set, or "FTP.Foo.ORG" if it is set.
5232		This is technically illegal under RFC 822 and 1123, but the
5233		IETF is moving toward legalizing it.  Note that turning on
5234		this option is not sufficient to guarantee that a downstream
5235		neighbor won't rewrite the address for you.
5236	Add "-m" flag to makesendmail script -- this tells you what object
5237		directory and Makefile it will use, but doesn't actually do
5238		the make.
5239	Do some additional checking on the contents of the qf file to try
5240		to detect attacks against the qf file.  In particular,
5241		abort on any line beginning "From ", and add an "end of
5242		file" line -- any data after that line is prohibited.
5243	Always use /etc/sendmail.cf, regardless of the arbitrary vendor
5244		choices.  This can be overridden in the Makefile by using
5245		either -DUSE_VENDOR_CF_PATH to get the vendor location
5246		(to the extent that we know it) or by defining
5247		_PATH_SENDMAILCF (which is a "hard override").  This allows
5248		sendmail 8 to have more consistent installation instructions.
5249	Allow macros on `K' line in config file.  Suggested by Andrew Chang
5250		of Sun Microsystems.
5251	Improved symbol table hash function from Eric Wassenaar.  This one
5252		is at least 50% faster.
5253	Fix problem that didn't notice that timeout on file open was a
5254		transient error.  Fix from Larry Parmelee of Cornell
5255		University.
5256	Allow comments (lines beginning with a `#') in files read for
5257		classes.  Suggested by Motonori Nakamura.
5258	Make SIGINT (usually ^C) in test mode return to the prompt instead
5259		of dropping out entirely.  This makes testing some of the
5260		name server lookups easier to deal with when there are
5261		hung servers.  From Motonori Nakamura.
5262	Add new ${opMode} macro that is set to the current operation mode
5263		(e.g., `s' for -bs, `t' for -bt, etc.).  Suggested by
5264		Claude Marinier <MARINIER@emp.ewd.dreo.dnd.ca>.
5265	Add new delivery mode (Odd) that defers all map lookups to queue runs.
5266		Kind of like queue-only mode (Odq) except it tries to avoid
5267		any external service requests; for dial-on-demand hosts that
5268		want to minimize DNS lookups when mail is being queued.  For
5269		this to work you will also have to make sure that gethostbyname
5270		of your local host name does not do a DNS lookup.
5271	Improved handling of "out of space" conditions from John Myers of
5272		Carnegie Mellon.
5273	Improved security for mailing to files on systems that have fchmod(2)
5274		support.
5275	Improve "cannot send message for N days" message -- now says "could
5276		not send for past N days".  Suggested by Tom Moore of AT&T
5277		Global Information Solutions.
5278	Less misleading Subject: line on messages sent to postmaster only.
5279		From Motonori Nakamura.
5280	Avoid duplicate error messages on bad command line flags.  From
5281		Motonori Nakamura.
5282	Better error message for case where ruleset 0 falls off the end
5283		or otherwise does not resolve to a canonical triple.
5284	Fix a problem that could cause multiple bounce messages if a bad
5285		address was sent along with a good address to an SMTP
5286		site where that SMTP site returned a 4yz code in response
5287		to the final dot of the data.  Problem reported by David
5288		James of British Telecom.
5289	Add "volatile" declarations so that gcc -O2 will work.  Patches
5290		from Alexander Dupuy of System Management ARTS.
5291	Delete duplicates in MX lists -- believe it or not, there are sites
5292		that list the same host twice in an MX list.  This deletion
5293		only works on adjacent preferences, so an MX list that
5294		had A=5, B=10, A=15 would leave both As, but one that had
5295		A=5, A=10, B=15 would reduce to A, B.  This is intentional,
5296		just in case there is something weird I haven't thought of.
5297		Suggested by Barry Shein of Software Tool & Die.
5298	SECURITY: .forward files cannot be symbolic links.  If they are,
5299		a bad guy can read your private files.
5300	PORTABILITY FIXES:
5301		Solaris 2 from Rob McMahon <cudcv@csv.warwick.ac.uk>.
5302		System V Release 4 from Motonori Nakamura of Ritsumeikan
5303			University.  This expands the disk size
5304			checking to include all (?) SVR4 configurations.
5305		System V Release 4 from Kimmo Suominen -- initgroups(3)
5306			and setrlimit(2) are both available.
5307		System V Release 4 from sob@sculley.ffg.com -- some versions
5308			apparently "have EX_OK defined in other headerfiles."
5309		Linux Makefile typo.
5310		Linux getusershell(3) is broken in Slackware 2.0 --
5311			from Andrew Pam of Xanadu Australia.
5312		More Linux tweaking from John Kennedy of California State
5313			University, Chico.
5314		Cray changes from Eric Wassenaar:  ``On Cray, shorts,
5315			ints, and longs are all 64 bits, and all structs
5316			are multiples of 64 bits.  This means that the
5317			sizeof operator returns only multiples of 8.
5318			This requires adaptation of code that really
5319			deals with 32 bit or 16 bit fields, such as IP
5320			addresses or nameserver fields.''
5321		DG/UX 5.4.3 from Mark T. Robinson <mtr@ornl.gov>.  To
5322			get the old behavior, use -DDGUX_5_4_2.
5323		DG/UX hack: add _FORCE_MAIL_LOCAL_=yes environment
5324			variable to fix bogus /bin/mail behavior.
5325		Tandem NonStop-UX from Rick McCarty <mccarty@mpd.tandem.com>.
5326			This also cleans up some System V Release 4 compile
5327			problems.
5328		Solaris 2: sendmail.cw file should be in /etc/mail to
5329			match all the other configuration files.  Fix
5330			from Glenn Barry of Emory University.
5331		Solaris 2.3: compile problem in conf.c.  Fix from Alain
5332			Nissen of the University of Liege, Belgium.
5333		Ultrix: freespace calculation was incorrect.  Fix from
5334			Takashi Kizu of Osaka University.
5335		SVR4: running in background gets a SIGTTOU because the
5336			emulation code doesn't realize that "getpeername"
5337			doesn't require reading the file.  Fix from Peter
5338			Wemm of DIALix.
5339		Solaris 2.3: due to an apparent bug in the socket emulation
5340			library, sockets can get into a "wedged" state where
5341			they just return EPROTO; closing and re-opening the
5342			socket clears the problem.  Fix from Bob Manson
5343			of Ohio State University.
5344		Hitachi 3050R & 3050RX running HI-UX/WE2: portability
5345			fixes from Akihiro Hashimoto ("Hash") of Chiba
5346			University.
5347		AIX changes to allow setproctitle to work from Rainer Sch�pf
5348			of Zentrum f�r Datenverarbeitung der Universit�t
5349			Mainz.
5350		AIX changes for load average from Ed Ravin of NASA/Goddard.
5351		SCO Unix from Chip Rosenthal of Unicom (code was using the
5352			wrong statfs call).
5353		ANSI C fixes from Adam Glass (NetBSD project).
5354		Stardent Titan/ANSI C fixes from Kate Hedstrom of Rutgers
5355			University.
5356		DG-UX fixes from Bruce Nagel of Data General.
5357		IRIX64 updates from Mark Levinson of the University of
5358			Rochester Medical Center.
5359		Altos System V (``the first UNIX/XENIX merge the Altos
5360			did for their Series 1000 & Series 2000 line;
5361			their merged code was licensed back to AT&T and
5362			Microsoft and became System V release 3.2'') from
5363			Tim Rice <timr@crl.com>.
5364		OSF/1 running on Intel Paragon from Jeff A. Earickson
5365			<jeff@ssd.intel.com> of Intel Scalable Systems
5366			Division.
5367		Amdahl UTS System V 2.1.5 (SVr3-based) from Janet Jackson
5368			<janet@dialix.oz.au>.
5369		System V Release 4 (statvfs semantic fix) from Alain
5370			Durand of I.M.A.G.
5371		HP-UX 10.x multiprocessor load average changes from
5372			Scott Hutton and Jeff Sumler of Indiana University.
5373		Cray CSOS from Scott Bolte of Cray Computer Corporation.
5374		Unicos 8.0 from Douglas K. Rand of the University of North
5375			Dakota, Scientific Computing Center.
5376		Solaris 2.4 fixes from Sanjay Dani of Dani Communications.
5377		ConvexOS 11.0 from Christophe Wolfhugel.
5378		IRIX 4.0.5 from David Ashton-Reader of CADcentre.
5379		ISC UNIX from J. J. Bailey.
5380		HP-UX 9.xx on the 8xx series machines from Remy Giraud
5381			of Meteo France.
5382		HP-UX configuration from Tom Lane <tgl@sss.pgh.pa.us>.
5383		IRIX 5.2 and 5.3 from Kari E. Hurtta.
5384		FreeBSD 2.0 from Mike Hickey of Federal Data Corporation.
5385		Sony NEWS-OS 4.2.1R and 6.0.3 from Motonori Nakamura.
5386		Omron LUNA unios-b, mach from Motonori Nakamura.
5387		NEC EWS-UX/V 4.2 from Motonori Nakamura.
5388		NeXT 2.1 from Bryan Costales.
5389		AUX patch thanks to Mike Erwin of Apple Computer.
5390		HP-UX 10.0 from John Beck of Hewlett-Packard.
5391		Ultrix: allow -DBROKEN_RES_SEARCH=0 if you are using a
5392			non-DEC resolver.  Suggested by Allan Johannesen.
5393		UnixWare 2.0 fixes from Petr Lampa of the Technical
5394			University of Brno (Czech Republic).
5395		KSR OS 1.2.2 support from Todd Miller of the University
5396			of Colorado.
5397		UX4800 support from Kazuhisa Shimizu of NEC.
5398	MAKEMAP: allow -d flag to allow insertion of duplicate aliases
5399		in type ``btree'' maps.  The semantics of this are undefined
5400		for regular maps, but it can be useful for the user database.
5401	MAKEMAP: lock database file while rebuilding to avoid sendmail
5402		lookups while the rebuild is going on.  There is a race
5403		condition between the open(... O_TRUNC ...) and the lock
5404		on the file, but it should be quite small.
5405	SMRSH: sendmail restricted shell added to the release.  This can
5406		be used as an alternative to /bin/sh for the "prog" mailer,
5407		giving the local administrator more control over what
5408		programs can be run from sendmail.
5409	MAIL.LOCAL: add this local mailer to the tape.  It is not really
5410		part of the release proper, and isn't fully supported; in
5411		particular, it does not run on System V based systems and
5412		never will.
5413	CONTRIB: a patch to rmail.c from Bill Gianopoulos of Raytheon
5414		to allow rmail to compile on systems that don't have
5415		function prototypes and systems that don't have snprintf.
5416	CONTRIB: add the "mailprio" scripts that will help you sort mailing
5417		lists by transaction delay times so that addresses that
5418		respond quickly get sent first.  This is to prevent very
5419		sluggish servers from delaying other peoples' mail.
5420		Contributed by Tony Sanders of BSDI.
5421	CONTRIB: add the "bsdi.mc" file as contributed by Tony Sanders
5422		of BSDI.  This has a lot of comments to help people out.
5423	CONFIG: Don't have .mc files include(../m4/cf.m4) -- instead,
5424		put this on the m4 command line.  On GNU m4 (which
5425		supports the __file__ primitive) you can run m4 in an
5426		arbitrary directory -- use either:
5427			m4 ${CFDIR}/m4/cf.m4 config.mc > config.cf
5428		or
5429			m4 -I${CFDIR} m4/cf.m4 config.mc > config.cf
5430		On other versions of m4 that don't support __file__, you
5431		can use:
5432			m4 -D_CF_DIR_=${CFDIR}/ ${CFDIR}/m4/cf.m4 ...
5433		(Note the trailing slash on the _CF_DIR_ definition.)
5434		Old versions of m4 will default to _CF_DIR_=.. for back
5435		compatibility.
5436	CONFIG: fix mail from <> so it will properly convert to
5437		MAILER-DAEMON on local addresses.
5438	CONFIG: fix code that was supposed to catch colons in host
5439		names.  Problem noted by John Gardiner Myers of CMU.
5440	CONFIG: allow use of SMTP_MAILER_MAX in nullclient configuration.
5441		From Paul Riddle of the University of Maryland, Baltimore
5442		County.
5443	CONFIG: Catch and reject "." as a host address.
5444	CONFIG: Generalize domaintable to look up all domains, not
5445		just unqualified ones.
5446	CONFIG: Delete OLD_SENDMAIL support -- as near as I can tell, it
5447		was never used and didn't work anyway.
5448	CONFIG: Set flags A, w, 5, :, /, |, and @ on the "local" mailer
5449		and d on all mailers in the UUCP class.
5450	CONFIG: Allow "user+detail" to be aliased specially: it will first
5451		look for an alias for "user+detail", then for "user+*", and
5452		finally for "user".  This is intended for forwarding mail
5453		for system aliases such as root and postmaster to a
5454		centralized hub.
5455	CONFIG: add confEIGHT_BIT_HANDLING to set option 8 (see above).
5456	CONFIG: add smtp8 mailer; this has the F=8 (just-send-8) flag set.
5457		The F=8 flag is also set on the "relay" mailer, since
5458		this is expected to be another sendmail.
5459	CONFIG: avoid qualifying all UUCP addresses sent via SMTP with
5460		the name of the UUCP_RELAY -- in some cases, this is the
5461		wrong value (e.g., when we have local UUCP connections),
5462		and this can create unreplyable addresses.  From Chip
5463		Rosenthal of Unicom.
5464	CONFIG: add confRECEIVED_HEADER to change the format of the
5465		Received: header inserted into all messages.  Suggested by
5466		Gary Mills of the University of Manitoba.
5467	CONFIG: Make "notsticky" the default; use FEATURE(stickyhost)
5468		to get the old behavior.  I did this upon observing
5469		that almost everyone needed this feature, and that the
5470		concept I was trying to make happen didn't work with
5471		some user agents anyway.  FEATURE(notsticky) still works,
5472		but it is a no-op.
5473	CONFIG: Add LUSER_RELAY -- the host to which unrecognized user
5474		names are sent, rather than immediately diagnosing them
5475		as User Unknown.
5476	CONFIG: Add SMTP_MAILER_ARGS, ESMTP_MAILER_ARGS, SMTP8_MAILER_ARGS,
5477		and RELAY_MAILER_ARGS to set the arguments for the
5478		indicated mailers.  All default to "IPC $h".  Patch from
5479		Larry Parmelee of Cornell University.
5480	CONFIG: pop mailer needs F=n flag to avoid "annoying side effects
5481		on the client side" and F=P to get an appropriate
5482		return-path.  From Kimmo Suominen.
5483	CONFIG: add FEATURE(local_procmail) to use the procmail program
5484		as the local mailer.  For addresses of the form "user+detail"
5485		the "detail" part is passed to procmail via the -a flag.
5486		Contributed by Kimmo Suominen.
5487	CONFIG: add MAILER(procmail) to add an interface to procmail for
5488		use from mailertables.  This lets you execute arbitrary
5489		procmail scripts.  Contributed by Kimmo Suominen.
5490	CONFIG: add T= fields (MTS type) to local, smtp, and uucp mailers.
5491	CONFIG: add OSTYPE(ptx2) for DYNIX/ptx 2.x from Sequent.  From
5492		Paul Southworth of CICNet Systems Support.
5493	CONFIG: use -a$g as default to UUCP mailers, instead of -a$f.
5494		This causes the null return path to be rewritten as
5495		MAILER-DAEMON; otherwise UUCP gets horribly confused.
5496		From Michael Hohmuth of Technische Universitat Dresden.
5497	CONFIG: Add FEATURE(bestmx_is_local) to cause any hosts that
5498		list us as the best possible MX record to be treated as
5499		though they were local (essentially, assume that they
5500		are included in $=w).  This can cause additional DNS
5501		traffic, but is easier to administer if this fits your
5502		local model.  It does not work reliably if there are
5503		multiple hosts that share the best MX preference.
5504		Code contributed by John Oleynick of Rutgers.
5505	CONFIG: Add FEATURE(smrsh) to use smrsh (the SendMail Restricted
5506		SHell) instead of /bin/sh as the program used for delivery
5507		to programs.  If an argument is included, it is used as
5508		the path to smrsh; otherwise, /usr/local/etc/smrsh is
5509		assumed.
5510	CONFIG: Add LOCAL_MAILER_MAX and PROCMAILER_MAILER_MAX to limit the
5511		size of messages to the local and procmail mailers
5512		respectively.  Contributed by Brad Knowles of the Defense
5513		Information Systems Agency.
5514	CONFIG: Handle leading ``phrase:'' and trailing ``;'' as comments
5515		(just like text outside of angle brackets) in order to
5516		properly deal with ``group: addr1, ... addrN;'' syntax.
5517	CONFIG: Require OSTYPE macro (the defaults really don't apply to
5518		any real systems any more) and tweak the DOMAIN macro
5519		so that it is less likely that users will accidentally use
5520		the Berkeley defaults.  Also, create some generic files
5521		that really can be used in the real world.
5522	CONFIG: Add new configuration macros to set character sets for
5523		messages _arriving from_ various mailers: LOCAL_MAILER_CHARSET,
5524		SMTP_MAILER_CHARSET, and UUCP_MAILER_CHARSET.
5525	CONFIG: Change UUCP_MAX_SIZE to UUCP_MAILER_MAX for consistency.
5526		The old name will still be accepted for a while at least.
5527	CONFIG: Implement DECNET_RELAY as spec for host to which DECNET
5528		mail (.DECNET pseudo-domain or node::user) will be sent.
5529		As with all relays, it can be ``mailer:hostname''.  Suggested
5530		by Scott Hutton.
5531	CONFIG: Add MAILER(mail11) to get DECnet support.  Code contributed
5532		by Barb Dijker of Labyrinth Computer Services.
5533	CONFIG: change confCHECK_ALIASES to default to False -- it has poor
5534		performance for large alias files, and this confused many
5535		people.
5536	CONFIG: Add confCF_VERSION to append local information to the
5537		configuration version number displayed during SMTP startup.
5538	CONFIG: fix some.newsgroup.usenet@local.host syntax (previously it
5539		would only work when locally addressed.  Fix from
5540		Edvard Tuinder of Cistron Internet Services.
5541	CONFIG: use ${opMode} to avoid error on .REDIRECT addresses if option
5542		"n" (CheckAliases) is set when rebuilding alias database.
5543		Based on code contributed by Claude Marinier.
5544	CONFIG: Allow mailertable to have values of the form
5545		``error:code message''.  The ``code'' is a status code
5546		derived from the sysexits codes -- e.g., NOHOST or UNAVAILABLE.
5547		Contributed by David James <dwj@agw.bt.co.uk>.
5548	CONFIG: add MASQUERADE_DOMAIN(domain list) to extend the list of
5549		sender domains that will be replaced with the masquerade name.
5550		These domains will not be treated as local, but if mail passes
5551		through with sender addresses in those domains they will be
5552		replaced by the masquerade name.  These can also be specified
5553		in a file using MASQUERADE_DOMAIN_FILE(filename).
5554	CONFIG: add FEATURE(masquerade_envelope) to masquerade the envelope
5555		as well as the header.  Substantial improvements to this
5556		code were contributed by Per Hedeland.
5557	CONFIG: add MAILER(phquery) to define a new "ph" mailer; this can be
5558		accessed from a mailertable to do CCSO ph lookups.  Contributed
5559		by Kimmo Suominen.
5560	CONFIG: add MAILER(cyrus) to define a new Cyrus mailer; this can be
5561		used to define cyrus and cyrusbb mailers (for IMAP support).
5562		Contributed by John Gardiner Myers of Carnegie Mellon.
5563	CONFIG: add confUUCP_MAILER to select default mailer to use for
5564		UUCP addressing.  Suggested by Tom Moore of AT&T GIS.
5565	NEW FILES:
5566		cf/cf/cs-hpux10.mc
5567		cf/cf/cs-solaris2.mc
5568		cf/cf/cyrusproto.mc
5569		cf/cf/generic-bsd4.4.mc
5570		cf/cf/generic-hpux10.mc
5571		cf/cf/generic-hpux9.mc
5572		cf/cf/generic-osf1.mc
5573		cf/cf/generic-solaris2.mc
5574		cf/cf/generic-sunos4.1.mc
5575		cf/cf/generic-ultrix4.mc
5576		cf/cf/huginn.cs.mc
5577		cf/domain/berkeley-only.m4
5578		cf/domain/generic.m4
5579		cf/feature/bestmx_is_local.m4
5580		cf/feature/local_procmail.m4
5581		cf/feature/masquerade_envelope.m4
5582		cf/feature/smrsh.m4
5583		cf/feature/stickyhost.m4
5584		cf/feature/use_ct_file.m4
5585		cf/m4/cfhead.m4
5586		cf/mailer/cyrus.m4
5587		cf/mailer/mail11.m4
5588		cf/mailer/phquery.m4
5589		cf/mailer/procmail.m4
5590		cf/ostype/amdahl-uts.m4
5591		cf/ostype/bsdi2.0.m4
5592		cf/ostype/hpux10.m4
5593		cf/ostype/irix5.m4
5594		cf/ostype/isc4.1.m4
5595		cf/ostype/ptx2.m4
5596		cf/ostype/unknown.m4
5597		contrib/bsdi.mc
5598		contrib/mailprio
5599		contrib/rmail.oldsys.patch
5600		mail.local/mail.local.0
5601		makemap/makemap.0
5602		smrsh/README
5603		smrsh/smrsh.0
5604		smrsh/smrsh.8
5605		smrsh/smrsh.c
5606		src/Makefiles/Makefile.CSOS
5607		src/Makefiles/Makefile.EWS-UX_V
5608		src/Makefiles/Makefile.HP-UX.10
5609		src/Makefiles/Makefile.IRIX.5.x
5610		src/Makefiles/Makefile.IRIX64
5611		src/Makefiles/Makefile.ISC
5612		src/Makefiles/Makefile.KSR
5613		src/Makefiles/Makefile.NEWS-OS.4.x
5614		src/Makefiles/Makefile.NEWS-OS.6.x
5615		src/Makefiles/Makefile.NEXTSTEP
5616		src/Makefiles/Makefile.NonStop-UX
5617		src/Makefiles/Makefile.Paragon
5618		src/Makefiles/Makefile.SCO.3.2v4.2
5619		src/Makefiles/Makefile.SunOS.5.3
5620		src/Makefiles/Makefile.SunOS.5.4
5621		src/Makefiles/Makefile.SunOS.5.5
5622		src/Makefiles/Makefile.UNIX_SV.4.x.i386
5623		src/Makefiles/Makefile.uts.systemV
5624		src/Makefiles/Makefile.UX4800
5625		src/aliases.0
5626		src/mailq.0
5627		src/mime.c
5628		src/newaliases.0
5629		src/sendmail.0
5630		test/t_seteuid.c
5631	RENAMED FILES:
5632		cf/cf/alpha.mc =>		cf/cf/s2k-osf1.mc
5633		cf/cf/chez.mc =>		cf/cf/chez.cs.mc
5634		cf/cf/hpux-cs-exposed.mc =>	cf/cf/cs-hpux9.mc
5635		cf/cf/osf1-cs-exposed.mc =>	cf/cf/cs-osf1.mc
5636		cf/cf/s2k.mc =>			cf/cf/s2k-ultrix4.mc
5637		cf/cf/sunos4.1-cs-exposed.mc =>	cf/cf/cs-sunos4.1.mc
5638		cf/cf/ultrix4.1-cs-exposed.mc => cf/cf/cs-ultrix4.mc
5639		cf/cf/vangogh.mc =>		cf/cf/vangogh.cs.mc
5640		cf/domain/Berkeley.m4 =>	cf/domain/Berkeley.EDU.m4
5641		cf/domain/cs-exposed.m4 =>	cf/domain/CS.Berkeley.EDU.m4
5642		cf/domain/eecs-hidden.m4 =>	cf/domain/EECS.Berkeley.EDU.m4
5643		cf/domain/s2k.m4 =>		cf/domain/S2K.Berkeley.EDU.m4
5644		cf/ostype/hpux.m4 =>		cf/ostype/hpux9.m4
5645		cf/ostype/irix.m4 =>		cf/ostype/irix4.m4
5646		cf/ostype/ultrix4.1.m4 =>	cf/ostype/ultrix4.m4
5647		src/Makefile.* =>		src/Makefiles/Makefile.*
5648		src/Makefile.AUX =>		src/Makefiles/Makefile.A-UX
5649		src/Makefile.BSDI =>		src/Makefiles/Makefile.BSD-OS
5650		src/Makefile.DGUX =>		src/Makefiles/Makefile.dgux
5651		src/Makefile.RISCos =>		src/Makefiles/Makefile.UMIPS
5652		src/Makefile.SunOS.4.0.3 =>	src/Makefiles/Makefile.SunOS.4.0
5653	OBSOLETED FILES:
5654		cf/cf/cogsci.mc
5655		cf/cf/cs-exposed.mc
5656		cf/cf/cs-hidden.mc
5657		cf/cf/hpux-cs-hidden.mc
5658		cf/cf/knecht.mc
5659		cf/cf/osf1-cs-hidden.mc
5660		cf/cf/sunos3.5-cs-exposed.mc
5661		cf/cf/sunos3.5-cs-hidden.mc
5662		cf/cf/sunos4.1-cs-hidden.mc
5663		cf/cf/ultrix4.1-cs-hidden.mc
5664		cf/domain/cs-hidden.m4
5665		contrib/rcpt-streaming
5666		src/Makefiles/Makefile.SunOS.5.x
5667
56688.6.13/8.6.12	1996/01/25
5669	SECURITY: In some cases it was still possible for an attacker to
5670		insert newlines into a queue file, thus allowing access to
5671		any user (except root).
5672	CONFIG: no changes -- it is not a bug that the configuration
5673		version number is unchanged.
5674
56758.6.12/8.6.12	1995/03/28
5676	Fix to IDENT code (it was getting the size of the reply buffer
5677		too small, so nothing was ever accepted).  Fix from several
5678		people, including Allan Johannesen, Shane Castle of the
5679		Boulder County Information Services, and Jeff Smith of
5680		Warwick University (all arrived within a few hours of
5681		each other!).
5682	Fix a problem that could cause large jobs to run out of
5683		file descriptors on systems that use vfork() rather
5684		than fork().
5685
56868.6.11/8.6.11	1995/03/08
5687	The ``possible attack'' message would be logged more often
5688		than necessary if you are using Pine as a user agent.
5689	The wrong host would be reported in the ``possible attack''
5690		message when attempted from IDENT.
5691	In some cases the syslog buffer could be overflowed when
5692		reporting the ``possible attack'' message.  This can
5693		cause denial of service attacks.  Truncate the message
5694		to 80 characters to prevent this problem.
5695	When reading the IDENT response a loop is needed around the
5696		read from the network to ensure that you don't get
5697		partial lines.
5698	Password entries without any shell listed (that is, a null
5699		shell) wouldn't match as "ok".  Problem noted by
5700		Rob McMahon.
5701	When running BIND 4.9.x a problem could occur because the
5702		_res.options field is initialized differently than it
5703		was historically -- this requires that sendmail call
5704		res_init before it tweaks any bits.
5705	Fix an incompatibility in openxscript() between the file open mode
5706		and the stdio mode passed to fdopen.  This caused UnixWare
5707		2.0 to have conniptions.  Fix from Martin Sohnius of
5708		Novell Labs Europe.
5709	Fix problem with static linking of local getopt routine when
5710		using GNU's ld command.  Fix from John Kennedy of
5711		Cal State Chico.
5712	It was possible to turn off privacy flags.  Problem noted by
5713		*Hobbit*.
5714	Be more paranoid about writing files.  Suggestions by *Hobbit*
5715		and Liudvikas Bukys.
5716	MAKEMAP: fixes for 64 bit machines (DEC Alphas in particular)
5717		from Spider Boardman.
5718	CONFIG: No changes (version number only, to keep it in sync
5719		with the binaries).
5720
57218.6.10/8.6.10	1995/02/10
5722	SECURITY: Diagnose bogus values to some command line flags that
5723		could allow trash to get into headers and qf files.
5724	Validate the name of the user returned by the IDENT protocol.
5725		Some systems that really dislike IDENT send intentionally
5726		bogus information.  Problem pointed out by Michael Bushnell
5727		of the Free Software Foundation.  Has some security
5728		implications.
5729	Fix a problem causing error messages about DNS problems when
5730		the host name contained a percent sign to act oddly
5731		because it was passed as a printf-style format string.
5732		In some cases this could cause core dumps.
5733	Avoid possible buffer overrun in returntosender() if error
5734		message is quite long.  From Fletcher Mattox of the
5735		University of Texas.
5736	Fix a problem that would silently drop "too many hops" error
5737		messages if and only if you were sending to an alias.
5738		From Jon Giltner of the University of Colorado and
5739		Dan Harton of Oak Ridge National Laboratory.
5740	Fix a bug that caused core dumps on some systems if -d11.2 was
5741		set and e->e_message was null.  Fix from Bruce Nagel of
5742		Data General.
5743	Fix problem that can still cause df files to be left around
5744		after "hop count exceeded" messages.  Fix from Andrew
5745		Chang and Shau-Ping Lo of SunSoft.
5746	Fix a problem that can cause buffer overflows on very long
5747		user names (as might occur if you piped to a program
5748		with a lot of arguments).
5749	Avoid returning an error and re-queueing if the host signature
5750		is null; this can occur on addresses like ``user@.''.
5751		Problem noted by Wesley Craig and the University of
5752		Michigan.
5753	Avoid possible calls to malloc(0) if MCI caching is turned
5754		off.  Bug fix from Pierre David of the Laboratoire
5755		Parallelisme, Reseaux, Systemes et Modelisation (PRiSM),
5756		Universite de Versailles - St Quentin, and Jacky
5757		Thibault.
5758	Make a local copy of the line being sent via senttolist() -- in
5759		some cases, buffers could get trashed by map lookups
5760		causing it to do unexpected things.  This also simplifies
5761		some of the map code.
5762	CONFIG: No changes (version number only, to keep it in sync
5763		with the binaries).
5764
57658.6.9/8.6.9	1994/04/19
5766	Do all mail delivery completely disconnected from any terminal.
5767		This provides consistency with daemon delivery and
5768		may have some security implications.
5769	Make sure that malloc doesn't get called with zero size,
5770		since that fails on some systems.  Reported by Ed
5771		Hill of the University of Iowa.
5772	Fix multi-line values for $e (SMTP greeting message).  Reported
5773		by Mike O'Connor of Ford Motor Company.
5774	Avoid syserr if no NIS domain name is defined, but the map it
5775		is trying to open is optional.  From Win Bent of USC.
5776	Changes for picky compilers from Ed Gould of Digital Equipment.
5777	Hesiod support for UDB from Todd Miller of the University of
5778		Colorado.  Use "hesiod" as the service name in the U
5779		option.
5780	Fix a problem that failed to set the "authentic" host name (that
5781		is, the one derived from the socket info) if you called
5782		sendmail -bs from inetd.  Based on code contributed by
5783		Todd Miller (this problem was also reported by Guy Helmer
5784		of Dakota State University).  This also fixes a related
5785		problem reported by Liudvikas Bukys of the University of
5786		Rochester.
5787	Parameterize "nroff -h" in all the Makefiles so people with
5788		variant versions can use them easily.  Suggested by
5789		Peter Collinson of Hillside Systems.
5790	SMTP "MAIL" commands with multiple ESMTP parameters required two
5791		spaces between parameters instead of one.  Reported by
5792		Valdis Kletnieks of Virginia Tech.
5793	Reduce the number of system calls during message collection by
5794		using global timeouts around the collect() loop.  This
5795		code was contributed by Eric Wassenaar.
5796	If the initial hostname name gathering results in a name
5797		without a dot (usually caused by NIS misconfiguration)
5798		and BIND is compiled in, directly access DNS to get
5799		the canonical name.  This should make life easier for
5800		Solaris systems.  If it still can't be resolved, and
5801		if the name server is listed as "required", try again
5802		in 30 seconds.  If that also fails, exit immediately to
5803		avoid bogus "config error: mail loops back to myself"
5804		messages.
5805	Improve the "MAIL DELETED BECAUSE OF LACK OF DISK SPACE" error
5806		message to explain how much space was available and
5807		sound a bit less threatening.  Suggested by Stan Janet
5808		of the National Institute of Standards and Technology.
5809	If mail is delivered to an alias that has an owner, deliver any
5810		requested return-receipt immediately, and strip the
5811		Return-Receipt-To: header from the subsequent message.
5812		This prevents a certain class of denial of service
5813		attack, arguably gives more reasonable semantics, and
5814		moves things more towards what will probably become a
5815		network standard.  Suggested by Christopher Davis of
5816		Kapor Enterprises.
5817	Add a "noreceipts" privacy flag to turn off all return receipts
5818		without recompiling.
5819	Avoid printing ESMTP parameters as part of the error message
5820		if there are errors during parsing.  This change is
5821		purely cosmetic.
5822	Avoid sending out error messages during the collect phase of
5823		SMTP; there is an MVS mailer from UCLA that gets
5824		confused by this.  Of course, I think it's their bug....
5825	Check for the $j macro getting undefined, losing a dot, or getting
5826		lost from $=w in the daemon before accepting a connection;
5827		if it is, it dumps state, prints a LOG_ALERT message,
5828		and drops core for debugging.  This is an attempt to
5829		track down a bug that I thought was long since gone.
5830		If you see this, please forward the log fragment to
5831		sendmail@sendmail.ORG.
5832	Change OLD_NEWDB from a #ifdef to a #if so it can be turned off
5833		with -DOLD_NEWDB=0 on the command line.  From Christophe
5834		Wolfhugel.
5835	Instead of trying to truncate the listen queue for the server
5836		SMTP port when the load average is too high, just close
5837		the port completely and reopen it later as needed.
5838		This ensures that the other end gets a quick "connection
5839		refused" response, and that the connection can be
5840		recovered later.  In particular, some socket emulations
5841		seem to get confused if you tweak the listen queue
5842		size around and can never start listening to connections
5843		again.  The down side is that someone could start up
5844		another daemon process in the interim, so you could
5845		have multiple daemons all not listening to connections;
5846		this could in turn cause the sendmail.pid file to be
5847		incorrect.  A better approach might be to accept the
5848		connection and give a 421 code, but that could break
5849		other mailers in mysterious ways and have paging behavior
5850		implications.
5851	Fix a glitch in TCP-level debugging that caused flag 16.101 to
5852		set debugging on the wrong socket.  From Eric Wassenaar.
5853	When creating a df* temporary file, be sure you truncate any
5854		existing data in the file -- otherwise system crashes
5855		and the like could result in extra data being sent.
5856	DOC: Replace the CHANGES-R5-R8 readme file with a paper in the
5857		doc directory.  This includes some additional
5858		information.
5859	CONFIG: change UUCP rules to never add $U! or $k! on the front
5860		of recipient envelope addresses.  This should have been
5861		handled by the $&h trick, but broke if people were
5862		mixing domainized and UUCP addresses.  They should
5863		probably have converted all the way over to uucp-uudom
5864		instead of uucp-{new,old}, but the failure mode was to
5865		loop the mail, which was bad news.
5866	Portability fixes:
5867		Newer BSDI systems (several people).
5868		Older BSDI systems from Christophe Wolfhugel.
5869		Intergraph CLIX, from Paul Southworth of CICNet.
5870		UnixWare, from Evan Champion.
5871		NetBSD from Adam Glass.
5872		Solaris from Quentin Campbell of the University of
5873			Newcastle upon Tyne.
5874		IRIX from Dean Cookson and Bill Driscoll of Mitre
5875			Corporation.
5876		NCR 3000 from Kevin Darcy of Chrysler Financial Corporation.
5877		SunOS (it has setsid() and setvbuf() calls) from
5878			Jonathan Kamens of OpenVision Technologies.
5879		HP-UX from Tor Lillqvist.
5880	New Files:
5881		src/Makefile.CLIX
5882		src/Makefile.NCR3000
5883		doc/changes/Makefile
5884		doc/changes/changes.me
5885		doc/changes/changes.ps
5886
58878.6.8/8.6.6	1994/03/21
5888	SECURITY: it was possible to read any file as root using the
5889		E (error message) option.  Reported by Richard Jones;
5890		fixed by Michael Corrigan and Christophe Wolfhugel.
5891
58928.6.7/8.6.6	1994/03/14
5893	SECURITY: it was possible to get root access by using weird
5894		values to the -d flag.  Thanks to Alain Durand of
5895		INRIA for forwarding me the notice from the bugtraq
5896		list.
5897
58988.6.6/8.6.6	1994/03/13
5899	SECURITY: the ability to give files away on System V-based
5900		systems proved dangerous -- don't run as the owner
5901		of a :include: file on a system that allows giveaways.
5902		Unfortunately, this also applies to determining a
5903		valid shell.
5904	IMPORTANT: Previous versions weren't expiring old connections
5905		in the connection cache for a long time under some
5906		circumstances.  This could result in resource exhaustion,
5907		both at your end and at the other end.  This checks the
5908		connections for timeouts much more frequently.  From
5909		Doug Anderson of NCSC.
5910	Fix a glitch that snuck in that caused programs to be run as
5911		the sender instead of the recipient if the mail was
5912		from a local user to another local user.  From
5913		Motonori Nakamura of Kyoto University.
5914	Fix "wildcard" on /etc/shells matching -- instead of looking
5915		for "*", look for "/SENDMAIL/ANY/SHELL/".  From
5916		Bryan Costales of ICSI.
5917	Change the method used to declare the "statfs" availability;
5918		instead of HASSTATFS and/or HASUSTAT with a ton of
5919		tweaking in conf.c, there is a single #define called
5920		SFS_TYPE which takes on one of six values (SFS_NONE
5921		for no statfs availability, SFS_USTAT for the ustat(2)
5922		syscall, SFS_4ARGS for a four argument statfs(2) call,
5923		and SFS_VFS, SFS_MOUNT, or SFS_STATFS for a two argument
5924		statfs(2) call with the declarations in <sys/vfs.h>,
5925		<sys/mount.h>, or <sys/statfs.h> respectively).
5926	Fix glitch in NetInfo support that could return garbage if
5927		there was no "/locations/sendmail" property.  From
5928		David Meyer of the University of Virginia.
5929	Change HASFLOCK from defined/not-defined to a 0/1 definition
5930		to allow Linux to turn it off even though it is a
5931		BSD-like system.
5932	Allow setting of "ident" timeout to zero to turn off the ident
5933		protocol entirely.
5934	Make 7-bit stripping local to a connection (instead of to a
5935		mailer); this allows you to specify that SMTP is a
5936		7-bit channel, but revert to 8-bit should it advertise
5937		that it supports 8BITMIME.  You still have to specify
5938		mailer flag 7 to get this stripping at all.
5939	Improve makesendmail script so it handles more cases automatically.
5940	Tighten up restrictions on taking ownership of :include: files
5941		to avoid problems on systems that allow you to give away
5942		files.
5943	Fix a problem that made it impossible to rebuild the alias
5944		file if it was on a read-only file system.  From
5945		Harry Edmon of the University of Washington.
5946	Improve MX randomization function.  From John Gardiner Myers
5947		of CMU.
5948	Fix a minor glitch causing a bogus message to be printed (used
5949		%s instead of %d in a printf string for the line number)
5950		when a bad queue file was read.  From Harry Edmon.
5951	Allow $s to remain NULL on locally generated mail.  I'm not
5952		sure this is necessary, but a lot of people have complained
5953		about it, and there is a legitimate question as to whether
5954		"localhost" is legal as an 822-style domain.
5955	Fix a problem with very short line lengths (mailer L= flag) in
5956		headers.  This causes a leading space to be added onto
5957		continuation lines (including in the body!), and also
5958		tries to wrap headers containing addresses (From:, To:,
5959		etc) intelligently at the shorter line lengths.  Problem
5960		Reported by Lars-Johan Liman of SUNET Operations Center.
5961	Log the real user name when logging syserrs, since these can have
5962		security implications.  Suggested by several people.
5963	Fix address logging of cached connections -- it used to always
5964		log the numeric address as zero.  This is a somewhat
5965		bogus implementation in that it does an extra system
5966		call, but it should be an inexpensive one.  Fix from
5967		Motonori Nakamura.
5968	Tighten up handling of short syslog buffers even more -- there
5969		were cases where the outgoing relay= name was too long
5970		to share a line with delay= and mailer= logging.
5971	Limit the overhead on split envelopes to one open file descriptor
5972		per envelope -- previously the overhead was three
5973		descriptors.  This was in response to a problem reported
5974		by P{r (Pell) Emanuelsson.
5975	Fixes to better handle the case of unexpected connection closes;
5976		this redirects the output to the transcript so the info
5977		is not lost.  From Eric Wassenaar.
5978	Fix potential string overrun if you macro evaluate a string that
5979		has a naked $ at the end.  Problem noted by James Matheson
5980		<jmrm@eng.cam.ac.uk>.
5981	Make default error number on $#error messages 553 (``Requested
5982		action not taken: mailbox name not allowed'') instead of
5983		501 (``Syntax error in parameters or arguments'') to
5984		avoid bogus "protocol error" messages.
5985	Strip off any existing trailing dot on names during $[ ... $]
5986		lookup.  This prevents it from ending up with two dots
5987		on the end of dot terminated names.  From Wesley Craig
5988		of the University of Michigan and Bryan Costales of ICSI.
5989	Clean up file class reading so that the debugging information is
5990		more informative.  It hadn't been using setclass, so you
5991		didn't see the class items being added.
5992	Avoid core dump if you are running a version of sendmail where
5993		NIS is compiled in, and you specify an NIS map, but
5994		NIS is not running.  Fix from John Oleynick of
5995		Rutgers.
5996	Diagnose bizarre case where res_search returns a failure value,
5997		but sets h_errno to a success value.
5998	Make sure that "too many hops" messages are considered important
5999		enough to send an error to the Postmaster (that is, the
6000		address specified in the P option).  This fix should
6001		help problems that cause the df file to be left around
6002		sometimes -- unfortunately, I can't seem to reproduce
6003		the problem myself.
6004	Avoid core dump (null pointer reference) on EXPN command; this
6005		only occurred if your log level was set to 10 or higher
6006		and the target account was an alias or had a .forward file.
6007		Problem noted by Janne Himanka.
6008	Avoid "denial of service" attacks by someone who is flooding your
6009		SMTP port with bad commands by shutting the connection
6010		after 25 bad commands are issued.  From Kyle Jones of
6011		UUNET.
6012	Fix core dump on error messages with very long "to" buffers;
6013		fmtmsg overflows the message buffer.  Fixed by trimming
6014		the to address to 203 characters.  Problem reported by
6015		John Oleynick.
6016	Fix configuration for HASFLOCK -- there were some spots where
6017		a #ifndef was incorrectly #ifdef.  Pointed out by
6018		George Baltz of the University of Maryland.
6019	Fix a typo in savemail() that could cause the error message To:
6020		lists to be incorrect in some places.  From Motonori
6021		Nakamura.
6022	Fix a glitch that can cause duplicate error messages on split
6023		envelopes where an address on one of the lists has a
6024		name server failure.  Fix from Voradesh Yenbut of the
6025		University of Washington.
6026	Fix possible bogus pointer reference on ESMTP parameters that
6027		don't have an ``=value'' part.
6028	CNAME loops caused an error message to be generated, but also
6029		re-queued the message.  Changed to just re-queue the
6030		message (it's really hard to just bounce it because
6031		of the weird way the name server works in the presence
6032		of CNAME loops).  Problem noted by James M.R.Matheson
6033		of Cambridge University.
6034	Avoid giving ``warning: foo owned process doing -bs'' messages
6035		if they use ``MAIL FROM:<foo>'' where foo is their true
6036		user name.  Suggested by Andreas Stolcke of ICSI.
6037	Change the NAMED_BIND compile flag to be a 0/1 flag so you can
6038		override it easily in the Makefile -- that is, you can
6039		turn it off using -DNAMED_BIND=0.
6040	If a gethostbyname(...) of an address with a trailing dot fails,
6041		try it without the trailing dot.  This is because if
6042		you have a version of gethostbyname() that falls back
6043		to NIS or the /etc/hosts file it will fail to find
6044		perfectly reasonable names that just don't happen to
6045		be dot terminated in the hosts file.  You don't want to
6046		strip the dot first though because we're trying to ensure
6047		that country names that match one of your subdomains get
6048		a chance.
6049	PRALIASES: fix bogus output on non-null-terminated strings.
6050		From Bill Gianopoulos of Raytheon.
6051	CONFIG: Avoid rewriting anything that matches $w to be $j.
6052		This was in code intended to only catch the self-literal
6053		address (that is, [1.2.3.4], where 1.2.3.4 is your
6054		IP address), but the code was broken.  However, it will
6055		still do this if $M is defined; this is necessary to
6056		get client configurations to work (sigh).  Note that this
6057		means that $M overrides :mailname entries in the user
6058		database!  Problem noted by Paul Southworth.
6059	CONFIG: Fix definition of Solaris help file location.  From
6060		Steve Cliffe <steve@gorgon.cs.uow.edu.au>.
6061	CONFIG: Fix bug that broke news.group.USENET mappings.
6062	CONFIG: Allow declaration of SMTP_MAILER_MAX, FAX_MAILER_MAX,
6063		and USENET_MAILER_MAX to tweak the maximum message
6064		size for various mailers.
6065	CONFIG: Change definition of USENET_MAILER_ARGS to include argv[0]
6066		instead of assuming that it is "inews" for consistency
6067		with other mailers.  From Michael Corrigan of UC San Diego.
6068	CONFIG: When mail is forwarded to a LOCAL_RELAY or a MAIL_HUB,
6069		qualify the address in the SMTP envelope as user@{relay|hub}
6070		instead of user@$j.  From Bill Wisner of The Well.
6071	CONFIG: Fix route-addr syntax in nullrelay configuration set.
6072	CONFIG: Don't turn off case mapping of user names in the local
6073		mailer for IRIX.  This was different than most every other
6074		system.
6075	CONFIG: Avoid infinite loops on certainly list:; syntaxes in
6076		envelope.  Noted by Thierry Besancon
6077		<besancon@excalibur.ens.fr>.
6078	CONFIG: Don't include -z by default on uux line -- most systems
6079		don't want it set by default.  Pointed out by Philippe
6080		Michel of Thomson CSF.
6081	CONFIG: Fix some bugs with mailertables -- for example, if your
6082		host name was foo.bar.ray.com and you matched against
6083		".ray.com", the old implementation bound %1 to "bar"
6084		instead of "foo.bar".  Also, allow "." in the mailertable
6085		to match anything -- essentially, take over SMART_HOST.
6086		This also moves matching of explicit local host names
6087		before the mailertable so they don't have to be special
6088		cased in the mailertable data.  Reported by Bill
6089		Gianopoulos of Raytheon; the fix for the %1 binding
6090		problem was contributed by Nicholas Comanos of the
6091		University of Sydney.
6092	CONFIG: Don't include "root" in class $=L (users to deliver
6093		locally, even if a hub or relay exists) by default.
6094		This is because of the known bug where definition of
6095		both a LOCAL_RELAY and a MAIL_HUB causes $=L to ignore
6096		both and deliver into the local mailbox.
6097	CONFIG: Move up bitdomain and uudomain handling so that they
6098		are done before .UUCP class matching; uudomain was
6099		reported as ineffective before.  This also frees up
6100		diversion 8 for future use.  Problem reported by Kimmo
6101		Suominen.
6102	CONFIG: Don't try to convert dotted IP address (e.g., [1.2.3.4])
6103		into host names.  As pointed out by Jonathan Kamens,
6104		these are often used because either the forward or reverse
6105		mapping is broken; this translation makes it broken again.
6106	DOC: Clarify $@ and $: in the Install & Op Guide.  From Kimmo
6107		Suominen.
6108	Portability fixes:
6109		Unicos from David L. Kensiski of Sterling Software.
6110		DomainOS from Don Lewis of Silicon Systems.
6111		GNU m4 1.0.3 from Karst Koymans of Utrecht University.
6112		Convex from Kimmo Suominen <kim@tac.nyc.ny.us>.
6113		NetBSD from Adam Glass <glass@sun-lamp.cs.berkeley.edu>.
6114		BSD/386 from Tony Sanders of BSDI.
6115		Apollo from Eric Wassenaar.
6116		DGUX from Doug Anderson.
6117		Sequent DYNIX/ptx 2.0 from Tim Wright of Sequent.
6118	NEW FILES:
6119		src/Makefile.DomainOS
6120		src/Makefile.PTX
6121		src/Makefile.SunOS.5.1
6122		src/Makefile.SunOS.5.2
6123		src/Makefile.SunOS.5.x
6124		src/mailq.1
6125		cf/ostype/domainos.m4
6126		doc/op/Makefile
6127		doc/intro/Makefile
6128		doc/usenix/Makefile
6129
61308.6.5/8.6.5	1994/01/13
6131	Security fix:  /.forward could be owned by anyone (the test
6132		to allow root to own any file was backwards).  From
6133		Bob Campbell at U.C. Berkeley.
6134	Security fix: group ids were not completely set when programs
6135		were invoked.  This caused programs to have group
6136		permissions they should not have had (usually group
6137		daemon instead of their own group).  In particular,
6138		Perl scripts would refuse to run.
6139	Security: check to make sure files that are written are not
6140		symbolic links (at least under some circumstances).
6141		Although this does not respond to a specific known
6142		attack, it's just a good idea.  Suggested by
6143		Christian Wettergren.
6144	Security fix: if a user had an NFS mounted home directory on
6145		a system with a restricted shell listed in their
6146		/etc/passwd entry, they could still execute any
6147		program by putting that in their .forward file.
6148		This fix prevents that by insisting that their shell
6149		appear in /etc/shells before allowing a .forward to
6150		execute a program or write a file.  You can disable
6151		this by putting "*" in /etc/shells.  It also won't
6152		permit world-writable :include: files to reference
6153		programs or files (there's no way to disable this).
6154		These behaviors are only one level deep -- for
6155		example, it is legal for a world-writable :include:
6156		file to reference an alias that writes a file, on
6157		the assumption that the alias file is well controlled.
6158	Security fix: root was not treated suspiciously enough when
6159		looking into subdirectories.  This would potentially
6160		allow a cracker to examine files that were publicly
6161		readable but in a non-publicly searchable directory.
6162	Fix a problem that causes an error on QUIT on a cached
6163		connection to create problems on the current job.
6164		These are typically unrelated, so errors occur in
6165		the wrong place.
6166	Reset CurrentLA in sendall() -- this makes sendmail queue
6167		runs more responsive to load average, and fixes a
6168		problem that ignored the load average in locally
6169		generated mail.  From Eric Wassenaar.
6170	Fix possible core dump on aliases with null LHS.  From
6171		John Orthoefer of BB&N.
6172	Revert to using flock() whenever possible -- there are just
6173		too many bugs in fcntl() locking, particularly over
6174		NFS, that cause sendmail to fail in perverse ways.
6175	Fix a bug that causes the connection cache to get confused
6176		when sending error messages.  This resulted in
6177		"unexpected close" messages.  It should fix itself
6178		on the following queue run.  Problem noted by
6179		Liudvikas Bukys of the University of Rochester.
6180	Include $k in $=k as documented in the Install & Op Guide.
6181		This seems odd, but it was documented....  From
6182		Michael Corrigan of UCSD.
6183	Fix problem that caused :include:s from alias files to be
6184		forced to be owned by root instead of daemon
6185		(actually DefUid).  From Tim Irvin.
6186	Diagnose unrecognized I option values -- from Mortin Forssen
6187		of the Chalmers University of Technology.
6188	Make "error" mailer work consistently when there is no error
6189		code associated with it -- previously it returned OK
6190		even though there was a real problem.  Now it assumes
6191		EX_UNAVAILABLE.
6192	Fix bug that caused the last header line of messages that had
6193		no body and which were terminated with EOF instead of
6194		"." to be discarded.  Problem noted by Liudvikas Bukys.
6195	Fix core dump on SMTP mail to programs that failed -- it tried
6196		to go to a "next MX host" when none existed, causing
6197		a core dump.  From der Mouse at McGill University.
6198	Change IDENTPROTO from a defined/not defined to a 0/1 switch;
6199		this makes it easier to turn it off (using
6200		-DIDENTPROTO=0 in the Makefile).  From der Mouse.
6201	Fix YP_MASTER_NAME store to use the unupdated result of
6202		gethostname() (instead of myhostname(), which tries
6203		to fully qualify the name) to be consistent with
6204		SunOS.  If your hostname is unqualified, this fixes
6205		transfers to slave servers.  Bug noted by Keith
6206		McMillan of Ameritech Services, Inc.
6207	Fix Ultrix problem: gethostbyname() can return a very large
6208		(> 500) h_length field, which causes the sockaddr
6209		to be trashed.  Use the size of the sockaddr instead.
6210		Fix from Bob Manson of Ohio State.
6211	Don't assume "-a." on host lookups if NAMED_BIND is not
6212		defined -- this confuses gethostbyname on hosts
6213		file lookups, which doesn't understand the trailing
6214		dot convention.
6215	Log SMTP server subprocesses that die with a signal instead
6216		of from a clean exit.
6217	If you don't have option "I" set, don't assume that a DNS
6218		"host unknown" message is authoritative -- it
6219		might still be found in /etc/hosts.
6220	Fix a problem that would cause Deferred: messages to be sent
6221		as the subject of an error message, even though the
6222		actual cause of a message was more severe than that.
6223		Problem noted by Chris Seabrook of OSSI.
6224	Fix race condition in DBM alias file locking.  From Kyle
6225		Jones of UUNET.
6226	Limit delivery syslog line length to avoid bugs in some
6227		versions of syslog(3).  This adds a new compile time
6228		variable SYSLOG_BUFSIZE.  From Jay Plett of Princeton
6229		University, which is in turn derived from IDA.
6230	Fix quotes inside of comments in addresses -- previously
6231		it insisted that they be balanced, but the 822 spec
6232		says that they should be ignored.
6233	Dump open file state to syslog upon receiving SIGUSR1 (for
6234		debugging).  This also evaluates ruleset 89, if set
6235		(with the null input), and logs the result.  This
6236		should be used sparingly, since the rewrite process
6237		is not reentrant.
6238	Change -qI, -qR, and -qS flags to be case-insensitive as
6239		documented in the Bat Book.
6240	If the mailer returned EX_IOERR or EX_OSERR, sendmail did not
6241		return an error message and did not requeue the message.
6242		Fix based on code from Roland Dirlewanger of
6243		Reseau Regional Aquarel, Bordeaux, France.
6244	Fix a problem that caused a seg fault if you got a 421 error
6245		code during some parts of connection initialization.
6246		I've only seen this when talking to buggy mailers on
6247		the other end, but it shouldn't give a seg fault in
6248		any case.  From Amir Plivatsky.
6249	Fix core dump caused by a ruleset call that returns null.
6250		Fix from Bryan Costales of ICSI.
6251	Full-Name: field was being ignored.  Fix from Motonori Nakamura
6252		of Kyoto University.
6253	Fix a possible problem with very long input lines in setproctitle.
6254		From P{r Emanuelsson.
6255	Avoid putting "This is a warning message" out on return receipts.
6256		Suggested by Douglas Anderson.
6257	Detect loops caused by recursive ruleset calls.  Suggested by
6258		Bryan Costales.
6259	Initialize non-alias maps during alias rebuilds -- they may be
6260		needed for parsing.  Problem noted by Douglas Anderson.
6261	Log sender address even if no message was collected in SMTP
6262		(e.g., if all RCPTs failed).  Suggested by Motonori
6263		Nakamura.
6264	Don't reflect the owner-list contents into the envelope sender
6265		address if the value contains ", :, /, or | (to avoid
6266		illegal addresses appearing there).
6267	Efficiency hack for toktype macro -- from Craig Partridge of
6268		BB&N.
6269	Clean up DNS error printing so that a host name is always
6270		included.
6271	Remember to set $i during queue runs.  Reported by Stephen
6272		Campbell of Dartmouth University.
6273	If the environment variable HOSTALIASES is set, use it during
6274		canonification as the name of a file with per-user host
6275		translations so that headers are properly mapped.  Reported
6276		by Anne Bennett of Concordia University.
6277	Avoid printing misleading error message if SMTP mailer (not
6278		using [IPC]) should die on a core dump.
6279	Avoid incorrect diagnosis of "file 1 closed" when it is caused
6280		by the other end closing the connection.  From
6281		Dave Morrison of Oracle.
6282	Improve several of the error messages printed by "mailq"
6283		to include a host name or other useful information.
6284	Add NetInfo preliminary support for NeXT systems.  From Vince
6285		DeMarco.
6286	Fix a glitch that sometimes caused :include:s that pointed to
6287		NFS filesystems that were down to give an "aliasing/
6288		forwarding loop broken" message instead of queueing
6289		the message for retry.  Noted by William C Fenner of
6290		the NRL Connection Machine Facility.
6291	Fix a problem that could cause a core dump if the input sequence
6292		had (or somehow acquired) a \231 character.
6293	Make sure that route-addrs always have <angle brackets> around
6294		them in non-SMTP envelopes (SMTP envelopes already do
6295		this properly).
6296	Avoid weird headers on unbalanced punctuation of the form:
6297		``Joe User <user)'' -- this caused reference to the
6298		null macro.  Fix from Rick McCarty of IO.COM.
6299	Fix a problem that caused an alias "user: user@local.host" to
6300		not have the QNOTREMOTE bit set; this caused configs
6301		to act as if FEATURE(notsticky) was defined even when
6302		it was not.  The effect of the problem was to make it
6303		very hard to to set up satellite sites that had a few
6304		local accounts, with everything else forwarded to a
6305		corporate hub.  Reported by Detlef Drewanz of the
6306		University of Rostock and Mark Frost of NCD.
6307	Change queuing to not call rulesets 3, {1 or 2}, 4 on header
6308		addresses.  This is more efficient (fewer name server
6309		calls) and fixes certain unusual configurations, such
6310		as those that have ruleset 4 do something that is
6311		non-idempotent unless a mailer-specific ruleset did
6312		something else.  Problem reported by Brian J. Coan
6313		of the Institute for Global Communications.
6314	Fix the "obsolete argument" routine in main to better understand
6315		new arguments.  For example, if you used ``sendmail
6316		-C config -v -q'' it would choke on the -q because
6317		the -C would stop looking for old-format arguments.
6318	Fix the code that was intended to allow two users to forward their
6319		mail to the same program and have them appear unique.
6320	Portability fixes for:
6321		SCO UNIX from Murray Kucherawy.
6322		SCO Open Server 3.2v4 from Philippe Brand.
6323		System V Release 4 from Rick Ellis and others.
6324		OSF/1 from Steve Campbell.
6325		DG/UX from Ben Mesander of the USGS and Bryan Curnutt
6326			of Stoner Associates.
6327		Motorola SysV88 from Kevin Johnson of Motorola.
6328		Solaris 2.3 from Casper H.S. Dik of the University
6329			of Amsterdam and John Caruso of University
6330			of Maryland.
6331		FreeBSD from Ollivier Robert.
6332		NetBSD from Adam Glass.
6333		TitanOS from Kate Hedstrom of Rutgers University.
6334		Irix from Bryan Curnutt.
6335		Dynix from Jim Davis of the University of Arizona.
6336		RISC/os.
6337		Linux from John Kennedy of California State University
6338			at Chico.
6339		Solaris 2.x from Tony Boner of the U.S. Air Force.
6340		NEXTSTEP 3.x from Vince DeMarco.
6341		HP-UX from various people.  NOTA BENE:  the location
6342			of the config file has moved to /usr/lib
6343			to match the HP-UX version of sendmail.
6344	CONFIG: Don't do any recipient rewriting on relay mailer;
6345		since this is intended only for internal use, the
6346		usual RFC 821/822/1123 rules can be relaxed.  The
6347		main point of this is to avoid munging (ugh) UUCP
6348		addresses when relaying internally.
6349	CONFIG: fix typo in mailer/uucp.m4 that mutilates list:;
6350		syntax addresses delivered via UUCP.  Solution
6351		provided by Peter Wemm.
6352	CONFIG: fix thumb-fumble in default UUCP relaying in ruleset
6353		zero; it caused double @ signs in addresses.  From
6354		Irving Reid of the University of Toronto.
6355	CONFIG: Portability fixes for SCO Unix 3.2 with TCP/IP 1.2.1
6356		from Markku Toijala of ICL Personal Systems Oy.
6357	CONFIG: Add trailing "." on pseudo-domains for consistency;
6358		this fixes a problem (noted by Al Whaley of Sunnyside)
6359		that made it hard to recognize your own pseudodomain
6360		names.
6361	CONFIG: catch "@host" syntax errors (i.e., null local-parts)
6362		rather than letting them get "local configuration
6363		error"s.  Problem noted by John Gardiner Myers.
6364	CONFIG: add uucp-uudom mailer variant, based on code posted
6365		by Spider Boardman <spider@Orb.Nashua.NH.US>; this
6366		has uucp-dom semantics but old UUCP syntax.  This
6367		also permits "uucp-old" as an alias for "uucp" and
6368		"uucp-new" as a synonym for "suucp" for consistency.
6369	CONFIG: add POP mailer support (from Kimmo Suominen
6370		<kim@grendel.lut.fi>).
6371	CONFIG: drop CSNET_RELAY support -- CSNET is long gone.
6372	CONFIG: fix bug caused with domain literal addresses (e.g.,
6373		``[128.32.131.12]'') when FEATURE(allmasquerade)
6374		was set; it would get an additional @masquerade.host
6375		added to the address.  Problem noted by Peter Wan
6376		of Georgia Tech.
6377	CONFIG: make sure that the local UUCP name is in $=w.  From
6378		Jim Murray of Stratus.
6379	CONFIG: changes to UUCP rewriting to simulate IDA-style "V"
6380		mailer flag.  Briefly, if you are sending to host
6381		"foo", then it rewrites "foo!...!baz" to "...!baz",
6382		"foo!baz" remains "foo!baz", and anything else has
6383		the local name prepended.
6384	CONFIG: portability fixes for HP-UX.
6385	DOC: several minor problems fixed in the Install & Op Guide.
6386	MAKEMAP: fix core dump problem on lines that are too long or
6387		which lack newline.  From Mark Delany.
6388	MAILSTATS: print sums of columns (total messages & kbytes
6389		in and out of the system).  From Tom Ferrin of UC
6390		San Francisco Computer Graphics Lab.
6391	SIGNIFICANT USER- OR SYSAD-VISIBLE CHANGES:
6392		On HP-UX, /etc/sendmail.cf has been moved to
6393			/usr/lib/sendmail.cf to match HP sendmail.
6394		Permissions have been tightened up on world-writable
6395			:include: files and accounts that have shells
6396			that are not listed in /etc/shells.  This may
6397			cause some .forward files that have worked
6398			before to start failing.
6399		SIGUSR1 dumps some state to the log.
6400	NEW FILES:
6401		src/Makefile.DGUX
6402		src/Makefile.Dynix
6403		src/Makefile.FreeBSD
6404		src/Makefile.Mach386
6405		src/Makefile.NetBSD
6406		src/Makefile.RISCos
6407		src/Makefile.SCO
6408		src/Makefile.SVR4
6409		src/Makefile.Titan
6410		cf/mailer/pop.m4
6411		cf/ostype/bsdi1.0.m4
6412		cf/ostype/dgux.m4
6413		cf/ostype/dynix3.2.m4
6414		cf/ostype/sco3.2.m4
6415		makemap/Makefile.dist
6416		praliases/Makefile.dist
6417
64188.6.4/8.6.4	1993/10/31
6419	Repair core-dump problem (write to read-only memory segment)
6420		if you fall back to the return-to-Postmaster case in
6421		savemail.  Problem reported by Richard Liu.
6422	Immediately diagnose bogus sender addresses in SMTP.  This
6423		makes quite certain that crackers can't use this
6424		class of attack.
6425	Reliability Fix:  check return value from fclose() and fsync()
6426		in a few critical places.
6427	Minor problem in initsys() that reversed a condition for
6428		redirecting the output channel on queue runs.  It's
6429		not clear this code even does anything.  From Eric
6430		Wassenaar of the Dutch National Institute for Nuclear
6431		and High-Energy Physics.
6432	Fix some problems that caused queue runs to do "too much work",
6433		such as double-reading the Errors-To: header.  From
6434		Eric Wassenaar.
6435	Error messages on writing the temporary file (including the
6436		data file) were getting suppressed in SMTP -- this
6437		fix causes them to be properly reported.  From Eric
6438		Wassenaar.
6439	Some changes to support AF_UNIX sockets -- this will only
6440		really become relevant in the next release, but some
6441		people need it for local patches.  From Michael
6442		Corrigan of UC San Diego.
6443	Use dynamically allocated memory (instead of static buffers)
6444		for macros defined in initsys() and settime(); since
6445		these can have different values depending on which
6446		envelope they are in.  From Eric Wassenaar.
6447	Improve logging to show ctladdr on to= logging; this tells you
6448		what uid/gid processes ran as.
6449	Fix a problem that caused error messages to be discarded if
6450		the sender address was unparseable for some reason;
6451		this was supposed to fall back to the "return to
6452		postmaster" case.
6453	Improve aliaswait backoff algorithm.
6454	Portability patches for Linux (8.6.3 required another header
6455		file) (from Karl London) and SCO UNIX.
6456	CONFIG: patch prog mailer to not strip host name off of envelope
6457		addresses (so that it matches local again).  From
6458		Christopher Davis.
6459	CONFIG: change uucp-dom mailer so that "<>" translates to $n;
6460		this prevents uux from seeing lines with null names like
6461		``From   Sat Oct 30 14:55:31 1993''.  From Motonori
6462		Nakamura of Kyoto University.
6463	CONFIG: handle <list:;> syntax correctly.  This isn't legal, but
6464		it shouldn't fail miserably.  From Motonori Nakamura.
6465
64668.6.2/8.6.2	1993/10/15
6467	Put a "successful delivery" message in the transcript for
6468		addresses that get return-receipts.
6469	Put a prominent "this is only a warning" message in warning
6470		messages -- some people don't read carefully enough
6471		and end up sending the message several times.
6472	Include reason for temporary failure in the "warning" return
6473		message.  Currently, it just says "cannot send for
6474		four hours".
6475	Fix the "Original message received" time generated for
6476		returntosender messages.  It was previously listed as
6477		the current time.  Bug reported by Eric Hagberg of
6478		Cornell University Medical College.
6479	If there is an error when writing the body of a message,
6480		don't send the trailing dot and wait for a response
6481		in sender SMTP, as this could cause the connection to
6482		hang up under some bizarre circumstances.  From Eric
6483		Wassenaar.
6484	Fix some server SMTP synchronization problems caused when
6485		connections fail during message collection.  From
6486		Eric Wassenaar.
6487	Fix a problem that can cause srvrsmtp to reject mail if the
6488		name server is down -- it accepts the RCPT but rejects
6489		the DATA command.  Problem reported by Jim Murray of
6490		Stratus.
6491	Fix a problem that can cause core dumps if the config file
6492		incorrectly resolves to a null hostname.  Reported by
6493		Allan Johannesen of WPI.
6494	Non-root use of -C flag, dangerous -f flags, and use of -oQ
6495		by non-root users were not put into
6496		X-Authentication-Warning:s as intended because the
6497		config file hadn't set the PrivacyOptions yet.  Fix
6498		from Sven-Ove Westberg of the University of Lulea.
6499	Under very odd circumstances, the alias file rebuild code
6500		could get confused as to whether a database was
6501		open or not.
6502	Check "vendor code" on the end of V lines -- this is
6503		intended to provide a hook for vendor-specific
6504		configuration syntax.  (This is a "new feature",
6505		but I've made an exception to my rule in a belief
6506		that this is a highly exceptional case.)
6507	Portability fixes for DG/UX (from Douglas Anderson of NCSC),
6508		SCO Unix (from Murray Kucherawy), A/UX, and OSF/1
6509		(from Jon Forrest of UC Berkeley)
6510	CONFIG: fix ``mailer:host'' form of UUCP relay naming.
6511
65128.6.1/8.6	1993/10/08
6513	Portability fixes for A/UX and Encore UMAX V.
6514	Fix error message handling -- if you had a name server down
6515		causing an error during parsing, that message was never
6516		propagated to the queue file.
6517
65188.6/8.6		1993/10/05
6519	Configuration cleanup: make it easier to undo IDENTPROTO in
6520		conf.h (other systems have the same bug).
6521	If HASGETDTABLESIZE and _SC_OPEN_MAX are both defined, assume
6522		getdtablesize() instead of sysconf(); a disturbingly
6523		large number of systems defined _SC_OPEN_MAX in the
6524		header files but don't have the syscall.
6525	Another patch to really truly ignore MX records in getcanonname
6526		if trymx == FALSE.
6527	Fix problem that caused the "250 IAA25499 Message accepted for
6528		delivery" message to be omitted if there was an error
6529		in the header of the message (e.g., a bad Errors-To:
6530		line).  Pointed out by Michael Corrigan of UCSD.
6531	Announce name of host we are chatting when we get errors; this
6532		is an IDA-ism suggested by Christophe Wolfhugel.
6533	Portability fixes for Alpha OSF/1 (from Anthony Baxter of the
6534		Australian Artificial Intelligence Institute), SCO Unix
6535		(from Murray Kucherawy of Hookup Communication Corp.),
6536		NeXT (from Vince DeMarco and myself), Linux (from
6537		Karl London <karl@borg.demon.co.uk>), BSDI (from
6538		Christophe Wolfhugel, and SVR4 on Dell (from Kimmo
6539		Suominen), AUX 3.0 on Macintosh, and ANSI C compilers.
6540	Some changes to get around gcc optimizer bugs.  From Takahiro
6541		Kanbe.
6542	Fix error recovery in queueup if another tf file of the same
6543		name already exists.  Problem stumbled over by Bill
6544		Wisner of The Well.
6545	Output YP_MASTER_NAME and YP_LAST_MODIFIED without null bytes.
6546		Problem noted by Keith McMillan of Ameritech Services.
6547	Deal with group permissions properly when opening .forward and
6548		:include: files.  This relaxes the 8.1C restrictions
6549		slightly more.  This includes proper setting of groups
6550		when reading :include: files, allowing you to read some
6551		files that you should be able to read but have previously
6552		been denied unless you owned them or they had "other"
6553		read permission.
6554	Make certain that $j is in $=w (after the .cf is read) so that
6555		if the user is forced to override some silly system,
6556		MX suppression will still work.
6557	Fix a couple of efficiency problems where newstr was double-
6558		calling expensive routines.  In at least one case, it
6559		wasn't guaranteed that they would always return the
6560		same result.  Problem noted by Christophe Wolfhugel.
6561	Fix null pointer dereference in putoutmsg -- only on an error
6562		condition from a non-SMTP mailer.  From Motonori
6563		Nakamura.
6564	Macro expand "C" line class definitions before scanning so that
6565		"CX $Z" works.
6566	Fix problem that caused error message to be sent while still
6567		trying to send the original message if the connection
6568		is closed during a DATA command after getting an error
6569		on an RCPT command (pretty obscure).  Problem reported
6570		by John Myers of CMU.
6571	Fix reply to NOOP to be 250 instead of 200 -- this is a long
6572		term bug.
6573	Fix a nasty bug causing core dumps when returning the "warning:
6574		cannot deliver for N hours -- will keep trying" message;
6575		it only occurred if you had PostmasterCopy set and
6576		only on some architectures.  Although sendmail would
6577		keep trying, it would send error messages on each
6578		queue interval.  This is an important fix.
6579	Allow u and g options to take user and group names respectively.
6580	Don't do a chdir into the queue directory in -bt mode to make
6581		ruleset testing a bit easier.
6582	Don't allow users to turn off logging (using -oL) on the command
6583		line -- command line can only raise, not lower, logging
6584		level.
6585	Set $u to the original recipient on the SMTP transaction or on
6586		the command line.  This is only done if there is exactly
6587		one recipient.  Technically, this does not meet the
6588		specs, because it does not guarantee a domain on the
6589		address.
6590	Fix a problem that dumped error messages on bad addresses if
6591		you used the -t flag.  Problem noted by Josh Smith of
6592		Harvey Mudd College.
6593	Given an address such as ``<foo> <bar>'', auto-quote the first
6594		``<foo>'' part, giving ``"<foo>" <bar>''.  This is to
6595		avoid the problem of people who use angle brackets in
6596		their full name information.
6597	Fix a null pointer dereference if you set option "l", have
6598		an Errors-To: header in the message, and have Errors-To:
6599		defined in the config file H lines.  From J.R. Oldroyd.
6600	Put YPCOMPAT on #ifdef NIS instead -- it's one less thing to get
6601		wrong when compiling.  Suggested by Rick McCarty of TI.
6602	Fix a problem that could pass negative SIZE parameter if the
6603		df file got lost; this would cause servers to always
6604		give a temporary failure, making the problem even worse.
6605		Problem noted by Allan Johannesen of WPI.
6606	Add "ident" timeout (one of the "r" option selectors) for IDENT
6607		protocol timeouts (30s default).  Requested by Murray
6608		Kucherawy of HookUp Communication Corp. to handle bogus
6609		PC TCP/IP implementations.
6610	Change $w default definition to be just the first component of
6611		the domain name on config level 5.  The $j macro defaults
6612		to the FQDN; $m remains as before.  This lets well-behaved
6613		config files use any of the short, long, or subdomain
6614		names.
6615	Add makesendmail script in src to try to automate multi-architecture
6616		builds.  I know, this is sub-optimal, but it is still
6617		helpful.
6618	Fix very obscure race condition that can cause a queue run to
6619		get a queue file for an already completed job.  This
6620		problem has existed for years.  Problem noted by the
6621		long suffering Allan Johannesen of WPI.
6622	Fix a problem that caused the raw sender name to be passed to
6623		udbsender instead of the canonified name -- this caused
6624		it to sometimes miss records that it should have found.
6625	Relax check of name on HELO packet so that a program using -bs
6626		that claims to be itself works properly.
6627	Restore rewriting of $: part of address through 2, R, 4 in
6628		buildaddr -- this requires passing a lot of flags to get
6629		it right.  Unlike old versions, this ONLY rewrites
6630		recipient addresses, not sender addresses.
6631	Fix a bug that caused core dumps in config files that cannot
6632		resolve /file/name style addresses.  Fix from Jonathan
6633		Kamens of OpenVision Technologies.
6634	Fix problem with fcntl locking that can cause error returns to
6635		be lost if the lock is lost; this required fully
6636		queueing everything, dropping the envelope (so errors
6637		would get returned), and then re-reading the queue from
6638		scratch.
6639	Fix a problem that caused aliases that redefine an otherwise
6640		true address to still send to the original address
6641		if and only if the alias failed in certain bizarre
6642		ways (e.g, if they pointed at a list:; syntax address).
6643		Problem pointed out by Jonathan Kamens.
6644	Remove support for frozen configuration files.  They caused
6645		more trouble than it was worth.
6646	Fix problem that can cause error messages to get ignored when
6647		using both -odb and -t flags.  Problem noted by Rob
6648		McNicholas at U.C. Berkeley.
6649	Include all "normal" variations on hostname in $=w.  For example,
6650		if the host name is vangogh.cs.berkeley.edu, $=w will
6651		contain vangogh, vangogh.cs, and vangogh.cs.berkeley.edu.
6652	Add "restrictqrun" privacy flag -- without this, anyone can run
6653		the queue.
6654	Reset SmtpPhase global on initial connection creation so that
6655		messages don't come out with stale information.
6656	Pass an "ext" argument to lockfile so that error/log messages
6657		will properly reflect the true filename being locked.
6658	Put all [...] address forms into $=w -- this eliminates the need
6659		for MAXIPADDR in conf.h.  Suggested by John Gardiner
6660		Myers of CMU.
6661	Fix a bug that can cause qf files to be left around even after
6662		an SMTP RSET command.  Problem and fix from Michael
6663		Corrigan.
6664	Don't send a PostmasterCopy to errors when the Precedence: is
6665		negative.  Error reports still go to the envelope
6666		sender address.
6667	Add LA_SHORT for load averages.
6668	Lock sendmail.st file when posting statistics.
6669	Add "SendBufSize" and "RcvBufSize" suboptions to "O" option to
6670		set the size of the TCP send and receive buffers; if you
6671		run over a slow slip line you may need to set these down
6672		(although it would be better to fix the SLIP implementation
6673		so that it's not necessary to recompile every program
6674		that does bulk data transfer).
6675	Allow null defaults on $( ... $) lookups.  Problem reported by
6676		Amir Plivatsky.
6677	Diagnose crufty S and V config lines.  This resulted from an
6678		observation that some people were using the SITE macro
6679		without the SITECONFIG macro first, which was causing
6680		bogus config files that were not caught.
6681	Fix makemap -f flag to turn off case folding (it was turning it
6682		on instead).  THIS IS A USER VISIBLE CHANGE!!!
6683	Fix a problem that caused multiple error messages to be sent if
6684		you used "sendmail -t -oem -odb", your system uses fcntl
6685		locking, and one of the recipient addresses is unknown.
6686	Reset uid earlier in include() so that recursive .forwards or
6687		:include:s don't use the wrong uid.
6688	If file descriptor 0, 1, or 2 was closed when sendmail was
6689		called, the code to recover the descriptor was broken.
6690		This sometimes (only sometimes) caused problems with the
6691		alias file.  Fix from Motonori Nakamura.
6692	Fix a problem that caused aliaswait to go into infinite recursion
6693		if the @:@ metasymbol wasn't found in the alias file.
6694	Improve error message on newaliases if database files cannot be
6695		opened or if running with no database format defined.
6696	Do a better estimation of the size of error messages when NoReturn
6697		is set.  Problem noted by P{r (Pell) Emanuelsson.
6698	Fix a problem causing the "c" option (don't connect to expensive
6699		mailers) to be ignored in SMTP.  Problem noted and the
6700		solution suggested by Robert Elz of The University of
6701		Melbourne.
6702	Improve connection caching algorithm by passing "[host]" to
6703		hostsignature, which strips the square brackets and
6704		returns the real name.  This allows mailertable entries
6705		to match regular entries.
6706	Re-enable Return-Receipt-To: -- people seem to want this stupid
6707		feature, even if it doesn't work right.
6708	Catch and log attempts to try the "wiz" command in server SMTP.
6709		This also ups the log level from LOG_NOTICE to LOG_CRIT.
6710	Be more generous at assigning $z to the home directory -- do this
6711		for programs that are specified through a .forward file.
6712		Fix from Andrew Chang of Sun Microsystems.
6713	Always save a fatal error message in preference to a non-fatal
6714		error message so that the "subject" line of return
6715		messages is the best possible.
6716	CONFIG: reduce the number of quotes needed to quote configuration
6717		parameters with commas: two quotes should work now, e.g.,
6718		define(ALIAS_FILE, ``/etc/aliases,/etc/aliases.local'').
6719	CONFIG: class $=Z is a set of UUCP hosts that use uucp-dom
6720		connections (domain-ized UUCP).
6721	CONFIG: fix bug in default maps (-o must be before database file
6722		name).  Pointed out by Christophe Wolfhugel.
6723	CONFIG: add FEATURE(nodns) to state that we are not relying on
6724		DNS.  This would presumably be used in UUCP islands.
6725	CONFIG: add OSTYPE(nextstep) and OSTYPE(linux).
6726	CONFIG: log $u in Received: line.  This is in technical violation
6727		of the standards, since it doesn't guarantee a domain
6728		on the address.
6729	CONFIG: don't assume "m" in local mailer flags -- this means that
6730		if you redefine LOCAL_MAILER_FLAGS you will have to include
6731		the "m" flag should you want it.  Apparently some Solaris 2.2
6732		installations can't handle multiple local recipients.
6733		Problem noted by Josh Smith.
6734	CONFIG: add confDOMAIN_NAME to set $j (if undefined, $j defaults).
6735	CONFIG: change default version level from 4 to 5.
6736	CONFIG: add FEATURE(nullclient) to create a config file that
6737		forwards all mail to a hub without ever looking at the
6738		addresses in any detail.
6739	CONFIG: properly strip mailer: information off of relays when
6740		used to change .BITNET form into %-hack form.
6741	CONFIG: fix a problem that caused infinite loops if presented
6742		with an address such as "!foo".
6743	CONFIG: check for self literal (e.g., [128.32.131.12]) even if
6744		the reverse "PTR" mapping is broken.  There's a better
6745		way to do this, but the change is fairly major and I
6746		want to hold it for another release.  Problem noted by
6747		Bret Marquis.
6748
67498.5/8.5		1993/07/23
6750	Serious bug: if you used a command line recipient that was unknown
6751		sendmail would not send a return message (it was treating
6752		everything as though it had an SMTP-style client that
6753		would do the return itself).  Problem noted by Josh Smith.
6754	Change "trymx" option in getcanonname() to ignore all MX data,
6755		even during a T_ANY query.  This actually didn't break
6756		anything, because the only time you called getcanonname
6757		with !trymx was if you already knew there were no MX
6758		records, but it is somewhat cleaner.  From Motonori
6759		Nakamura.
6760	Don't call getcanonname from getmxrr if you already know there
6761		are no DNS records matching the name.
6762	Fix a problem causing error messages to always include "The
6763		original message was received ... from localhost".
6764		The correct original host information is now included.
6765	Previous change to cf/sh/makeinfo.sh doesn't port to Ultrix (their
6766		version of "test" doesn't have the -x flag).  Change it
6767		to use -f instead.  From John Myers.
6768	CONFIG: 8.4 mistakenly set the default SMTP-style mailer to
6769		esmtp -- it should be smtp.
6770	CONFIG: send all relayed mail using confRELAY_MAILER (defaults
6771		to "relay" (a variant of "smtp") if MAILER(smtp) is used,
6772		else "suucp" if MAILER(uucp) is used, else "unknown");
6773		this cleans up the configs somewhat.  This fixes a serious
6774		problem that caused route-addrs to get mistaken as relays,
6775		pointed out by John Myers.  WARNING: this also causes
6776		the default on SMART_HOST to change from "suucp" to
6777		"relay" if you have MAILER(smtp) specified.
6778
67798.4/8.4		1993/07/22
6780	Add option `w'.  If you receive a message that comes to you because
6781		you are the best (lowest preference) target of an MX, and
6782		you haven't explicitly recognized the source MX host in
6783		your .cf file, this option will cause you to try the target
6784		host directly (as if there were no MX for it at all).  If
6785		`w' is not set, this case is a configuration error.
6786		Beware: if `w' is set, senders may get bogus errors like
6787		"message timed out" or "host unknown" for problems that
6788		are really configuration errors.  This option is
6789		disrecommended, provided only for compatibility with
6790		UIUC sendmail.
6791	Fix a problem that caused the incoming socket to be left open
6792		when sendmail forks after the DATA command.  This caused
6793		calling systems to wait in FIN_WAIT_2 state until the
6794		entire list was processed and the child closed -- a
6795		potentially prodigious amount of time.  Problem noted
6796		by Neil Rickert.
6797	Fix problem (created in 6.64) that caused mail sent to multiple
6798		addresses, one of which was a bad address, to completely
6799		suppress the sending of the message.  This changes
6800		handling of EF_FATALERRS somewhat, and adds an
6801		EF_GLOBALERRS flag.  This also fixes a potential problem
6802		with duplicate error messages if there is a syntax error
6803		in the header of a message that isn't noticed until late
6804		in processing.  Original problem pointed out by Josh Smith
6805		of Harvey Mudd College.  This release includes quite a bit
6806		of dickering with error handling (see below).
6807	Back out SMTP transaction if MAIL gets nested 501 error.  This
6808		will only hurt already-broken software and should help
6809		humans.
6810	Fix a problem that broke aliases when neither NDBM nor NEWDB were
6811		compiled in.  It would never read the alias file.
6812	Repair unbalanced `)' and `>' (the "open" versions are already
6813		repaired).
6814	Logging of "done" in dropenvelope() was incorrect: it would
6815		log this even when the queue file still existed.  Change
6816		this to only log "done" (at log level 11) when the
6817		queue file is actually removed.  From John Myers.
6818	Log "lost connection" in server SMTP at log level 20 if there
6819		is no pending transaction.  Some senders just close the
6820		connection rather than sending QUIT.
6821	Fix a bug causing getmxrr to add a dot to the end of unqualified
6822		domains that do not have MX records -- this would cause
6823		the subsequent host name lookup to fail.  The problem
6824		only occurred if you had FEATURE(nocanonify) set.
6825		Problem noted by Rick McCarty of Texas Instruments.
6826	Fix invocation of setvbuf when passed a -X flag -- I had
6827		unwittingly used an ANSI C extension, and this caused
6828		core dumps on some machines.
6829	Diagnose self-destructive alias loops on RCPT as well as EXPN.
6830		Previously it just gave an empty send queue, which
6831		then gave either "Need RCPT (recipient)" at the DATA
6832		(confusing, since you had given an RCPT command which
6833		returned 250) or just dropped the email, depending on
6834		whether you were running VERBose mode.  Now it usually
6835		diagnoses this case as "aliasing/forwarding loop broken".
6836		Unfortunately, it still doesn't adequately diagnose
6837		some true error conditions.
6838	Add internal concept of "warning messages" using 6xx codes.
6839		These are not reported only to Postmaster.  Unbalanced
6840		parens, brackets, and quotes are printed as 653 codes.
6841		They are always mapped to 5xx codes before use in SMTP.
6842	Clean up error messages to tell both the actual address that
6843		failed and the alias they arose from.  This makes it
6844		somewhat easier to diagnose problems.  Difficulty noted
6845		by Motonori Nakamura.
6846	Fix a problem that inappropriately added a ctladdr to addresses
6847		that shouldn't have had one during a queue run.  This
6848		caused error messages to be handled differently during
6849		a queue run than a direct run.
6850	Don't print the qf name and line number if you get errors during
6851		the direct run of the queue from srvrsmtp -- this was
6852		just extra stuff for users to crawl through.
6853	Put command line flags on second line of pid file so you can
6854		auto-restart the daemon with all appropriate arguments.
6855		Use "kill `head -1 /etc/sendmail.pid`" to stop the
6856		daemon, and "eval `tail -1 /etc/sendmail.pid`" to
6857		restart it.
6858	Remove the ``setuid(getuid())'' in main -- this caused the
6859		IDENT daemon to screw up.  This required that I change
6860		HASSETEUID to HASSETREUID and complicate the mode
6861		changing somewhat because both Ultrix and SunOS seem
6862		to have a bug causing seteuid() to set the saved uid
6863		as well as the effective.  The program test/t_setreuid.c
6864		will test to see if your implementation of setreuid(2)
6865		is appropriately functional.
6866	The FallBackMX (option V) handling failed to properly identify
6867		fallback to yourself -- most of the code was there,
6868		but it wasn't being enabled.  Problem noted by Murray
6869		Kucherawy of the University of Waterloo.
6870	Change :include: open timeout from ETIMEDOUT to an internal
6871		code EOPENTIMEOUT; this avoids adding "during SmtpPhase
6872		with CurHostName" in error messages, which can be
6873		confusing.  Reported by Jonathan Kamens of OpenVision
6874		Technologies.
6875	Back out setpgrp (setpgid on POSIX systems) call to reset the
6876		process group id.  The original fix was to get around
6877		some problems with recalcitrant MUAs, but it breaks
6878		any call from a shell that creates a process group id
6879		different from the process id.  I could try to fix
6880		this by diddling the tty owner (using tcsetpgrp or
6881		equivalent) but this is too likely to break other
6882		things.
6883	Portability changes:
6884		Support -M as equivalent to -oM on Ultrix -- apparently
6885			DECnet calls sendmail with -MrDECnet -Ms<HOST> -bs
6886			instead of using standard flags.  Oh joy.  This
6887			behavior reported by Jon Giltner of University
6888			of Colorado.
6889		SGI IRIX  -- this includes several changes that should
6890			help other strict ANSI compilers.
6891		SCO Unix -- from Murray Kucherawy of HookUp Communication
6892			Corporation.
6893		Solaris running the Sun C compiler (which despite the
6894			documentation apparently doesn't define
6895			__STDC__ by default).
6896		ConvexOS from Eric Schnoebelen of Convex.
6897		Sony NEWS workstations and Omron LUNA workstations from
6898			Motonori Nakamura.
6899	CONFIG: add confTRY_NULL_MX_LIST to set option `w'.
6900	CONFIG: delete `C' and `e' from default SMTP mailers flags;
6901		several people have made a good argument that this
6902		creates more problems than it solves (although this
6903		may prove painful in the short run).
6904	CONFIG: generalize all the relays to accept a "mailer:host"
6905		format.
6906	CONFIG: move local processing in ruleset 0 into a new ruleset
6907		98 (8 on old sendmail).  Domain literal [a.b.c.d]
6908		addresses are also passed through this ruleset.
6909	CONFIG: if neither SMART_HOST nor MAILER(smtp) were defined,
6910		internet-style addresses would "fall off the end" of
6911		ruleset zero and be interpreted as local -- however,
6912		the angle brackets confused the recursive call.
6913		These are now diagnosed as "Unrecognized host name".
6914	CONFIG: USENET rules weren't included in S0 because of a mistaken
6915		ifdef(`_MAILER_USENET_') instead of
6916		ifdef(`_MAILER_usenet_').  Problem found by Rein Tollevik
6917		of SINTEF RUNIT, Oslo.
6918	CONFIG: move up LOCAL_RULE_0 processing so that it happens very
6919		early in ruleset 0; this allows .mc authors to bypass
6920		things like the "short circuit" code for local addresses.
6921		Prompted by a comment by Bill Wisner of The Well.
6922	CONFIG: add confSMTP_MAILER to define the mailer used (smtp or
6923		esmtp) to send SMTP mail.  This allows you to default
6924		to esmtp but use a mailertable or other override to
6925		deal with broken servers.  This logic was pointed out
6926		to me by Bill Wisner.  Ditto for confLOCAL_MAILER.
6927	Changes to cf/sh/makeinfo.sh to make it portable to SVR4
6928		environments.  Ugly as sin.
6929
69308.3/8.3		1993/07/13
6931	Fix setuid problems introduced in 8.2 that caused messages
6932		like "Cannot create qfXXXXXX: Invalid argument"
6933		or "Cannot reopen dfXXXXXX: Permission denied".  This
6934		involved a new compile flag "HASSETEUID" that takes
6935		the place of the old _POSIX_SAVED_IDS -- it turns out
6936		that the POSIX interface is broken enough to break
6937		some systems badly.  This includes some fixes for
6938		HP-UX.  Also fixes problems where the real uid is
6939		not reset properly on startup (from Neil Rickert).
6940	Fix a problem that caused timed out messages to not report the
6941		addresses that timed out.  Error messages are also more
6942		"user friendly".
6943	Drop required bandwidth on connections from 64 bytes/sec to
6944		16 bytes/sec.
6945	Further Solaris portability changes -- doesn't require the BSD
6946		compatibility library.  This also adds a new
6947		"HASGETDTABLESIZE" compile flag which can be used if
6948		you want to use getdtablesize(2) instead of sysconf(2).
6949		These are loosely based on changes from David Meyer at
6950		University of Oregon.  This now seems to work, at least
6951		for quick test cases.
6952	Fix a problem that can cause duplicate error messages to be
6953		sent if you are in SMTP, you send to multiple addresses,
6954		and at least one of those addresses is good and points
6955		to an account that has a .forward file (whew!).
6956	Fix a problem causing messages to be discarded if checkcompat()
6957		returned EX_TEMPFAIL (because it didn't properly mark
6958		the "to" address).  Problem noted by John Myers.
6959	Fix dfopen to return NULL if the open failed; I was depending
6960		on fdopen(-1) returning NULL, which isn't the case.  This
6961		isn't serious, but does result in weird error diagnoses.
6962		From Michael Corrigan.
6963	CONFIG: add UUCP_MAX_SIZE M4 macro to set the maximum size of
6964		messages sent through UUCP-family mailers.  Suggested
6965		by Bill Wisner of The Well.
6966	CONFIG: if both MAILER(uucp) and MAILER(smtp) are specified,
6967		include a "uucp-dom" mailer that uses domain-style
6968		addressing.  Suggested by Bill Wisner.
6969	CONFIG: Add LOCAL_SHELL_FLAGS and LOCAL_SHELL_ARGS to match
6970		LOCAL_MAILER_FLAGS and LOCAL_MAILER_ARGS.  Suggested by
6971		Christophe Wolfhugel.
6972	CONFIG: Add OSTYPE(aix3).  From Christophe Wolfhugel.
6973
69748.2/8.2		1993/07/11
6975	Don't drop out on config file parse errors in -bt mode.
6976	On older configuration files, assume option "l" (use Errors-To
6977		header) for back compatibility.  NOTE:  this DOES NOT
6978		imply an endorsement of the Errors-To: header in any way.
6979	Accept -x flag on AIX-3 as well as OSF/1.  Why, why, why???
6980	Don't log errors on EHLO -- it isn't a "real" error for an old
6981		SMTP server to give an error on this command, and
6982		logging it in the transcript can be confusing.  Fix
6983		from Bill Wisner.
6984	IRIX compatibility changes provided by Dan Rich
6985		<drich@sandman.lerc.nasa.gov>.
6986	Solaris 2 compatibility changes.  Provided by Bob Cunningham
6987		<bob@kahala.soest.hawaii.edu>, John Oleynick
6988		<juo@klinzhai.rutgers.edu>
6989	Debugging: -d17 was overloaded (hostsignature and usersmtp.c);
6990		move usersmtp (smtpinit and smtpmailfrom) to -d18 to
6991		match the other flags in that file.
6992	Flush transcript before fork in mailfile().  From Eric Wassenaar.
6993	Save h_errno in mci struct and improve error message display.
6994		Changes from Eric Wassenaar.
6995	Open /dev/null for the transcript if the create of the xf file
6996		failed; this avoids at least one possible null pointer
6997		reference in very weird cases.  From Eric Wassenaar.
6998	Clean up statistics gathering; it was over-reporting because of
6999		forks.  From Eric Wassenaar.
7000	Fix problem that causes old Return-Path: line to override new
7001		Return-Path: line (conf.c needs H_FORCE to avoid
7002		re-using old value).  From Motonori Nakamura.
7003	Fix broken -m flag in K definition -- even if -m (match only)
7004		was specified, it would still replace the key with the
7005		value.  Noted by Rick McCarty of Texas Instruments.
7006	If the name server timed out over several days, no "timed out"
7007		message would ever be sent back.  The timeout code
7008		has been moved from markfailure() to dropenvelope()
7009		so that all such failures should be diagnosed.  Pointed
7010		out by Christophe Wolfhugel and others.
7011	Relax safefile() constraints: directories in an include or
7012		forward path must be readable by self if the controlling
7013		user owns the entry, readable by all otherwise (e.g.,
7014		when reading your .forward file, you have to own and
7015		have X permission in it; everyone needs X permission in
7016		the root and directories leading up to your home);
7017		include files must be readable by anyone, but need not
7018		be owned by you.
7019	If _POSIX_SAVED_IDS is defined, setuid to the owner before
7020		reading a .forward file; this gets around some problems
7021		on NFS mounts if root permission is not exported and
7022		the user's home directory isn't x'able.
7023	Additional NeXT portability enhancements from Axel Zinser.
7024	Additional HP-UX portability enhancements from Brian Bullen.
7025	Add a timeout around SMTP message writes; this assumes you can
7026		get throughput of at least 64 bytes/second.  Note that
7027		this does not impact the "datafinal" default, which
7028		is separate; this is just intended to work around
7029		network clogs that will occur before the final dot
7030		is sent.  From Eric Wassenaar.
7031	Change map code to set the "include null" flag adaptively --
7032		it initially tries both, but if it finds anything
7033		matching without a null it never tries again with a
7034		null and vice versa.  If -N is specified, it never
7035		tries without the null and creates new maps with a
7036		null byte.  If -O is specified, it never tries with
7037		the null (for efficiency).  If -N and -O are specified,
7038		you get -NO (get it?) lookup at all, so this would
7039		be a bad idea.  If you don't specify either -N or -O,
7040		it adapts.
7041	Fix recognition of "same from address" so that MH submissions
7042		will insert the appropriate full name information;
7043		this used to work and got broken somewhere along the
7044		way.
7045	Some changes to eliminate some unnecessary SYSERRs in the
7046		log.  For example, if you lost a connection, don't
7047		bother reporting that fact on the connection you lost.
7048	Add some "extended debugging" flags to try to track down
7049		why we get occasional problems with file descriptor
7050		one being closed when execing a mailer; it seems to
7051		only happen when there has been another error in the
7052		same transaction.  This requires XDEBUG, defined
7053		by default in conf.h.
7054	Add "-X filename" command line flag, which logs both sides of
7055		all SMTP transactions.  This is intended ONLY for
7056		debugging bad implementations of other mailers; start
7057		it up, send a message from a mailer that is failing,
7058		and then kill it off and examine the indicated log.
7059		This output is not intended to be particularly human
7060		readable.  This also adds the HASSETVBUF compile
7061		flag, defaulted on if your compiler defines __STDC__.
7062	CONFIG: change SMART_HOST to override an SMTP mailer.  If you
7063		have a local net that should get direct connects, you
7064		will need to use LOCAL_NET_CONFIG to catch these hosts.
7065		See cf/README for an example.
7066	CONFIG: add LOCAL_MAILER_ARGS (default: `mail -d $u') to handle
7067		sites that don't use the -d flag.
7068	CONFIG: hide recipient addresses as well as sender addresses
7069		behind $M if FEATURE(allmasquerade) is specified; this
7070		has been requested by several people, but can break
7071		local aliases.  For example, if you mail to "localalias"
7072		this will be rewritten as "localalias@masqueradehost";
7073		although initial delivery will work, replies will be
7074		broken.  Use it sparingly.
7075	CONFIG: add FEATURE(domaintable).  This maps unqualified domains
7076		to qualified domains in headers.  I believe this is
7077		largely equivalent to the IDA feature of the same name.
7078	CONFIG: use $U as UUCP name instead of $k.  This permits you
7079		to override the "system name" as your UUCP name --
7080		in particular, to use domain-ized UUCP names.  From
7081		Bill Wisner of The Well.
7082	CONFIG: create new mailer "esmtp" that always tries EHLO
7083		first.  This is currently unused in the config files,
7084		but could be used in a mailertable entry.
7085
70868.1C/8.1B	1993/06/27
7087	Serious security bug fix: it was possible to read any file on
7088		the system, regardless of ownership and permissions.
7089	If a subroutine returns a fully qualified address, return it
7090		immediately instead of feeding it back into rewriting.
7091		This fixes a problem with mailertable lookups.
7092	CONFIG: fix some M4 frotz (concat => CONCAT)
7093
70948.1B/8.1A	1993/06/12
7095	Serious bug fix: pattern matching backup algorithm stepped by
7096		two tokens in classes instead of one.  Found by Claus
7097		Assmann at University of Kiel, Germany.
7098
70998.1A/8.1A	1993/06/08
7100	Another mailertable fix....
7101
71028.1/8.1		1993/06/07
7103	4.4BSD freeze.  No semantic changes.
7104